WO2010105851A1 - Probe compound for detecting and isolating enzymes and means and methods using the same - Google Patents

Probe compound for detecting and isolating enzymes and means and methods using the same Download PDF

Info

Publication number
WO2010105851A1
WO2010105851A1 PCT/EP2010/001770 EP2010001770W WO2010105851A1 WO 2010105851 A1 WO2010105851 A1 WO 2010105851A1 EP 2010001770 W EP2010001770 W EP 2010001770W WO 2010105851 A1 WO2010105851 A1 WO 2010105851A1
Authority
WO
WIPO (PCT)
Prior art keywords
metabolite
component
transition metal
histidine
probe compound
Prior art date
Application number
PCT/EP2010/001770
Other languages
French (fr)
Inventor
Peter N. Golyshin
Olga V. Golyshina
Kenneth N. Timmis
Tatyana Chernikova
Agnes Waliczek
Manuel Ferrer
Ana Beloqui
Maria E. Guazzaroni
Jose M. Vieites
Florencio Pazos
Antonio Lopez De Lacey
Victor M. Fernandez
Original Assignee
Helmholtz-Zentrum für Infektionsforschung GmbH
Institute Of Catalysis (Csic)
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Helmholtz-Zentrum für Infektionsforschung GmbH, Institute Of Catalysis (Csic) filed Critical Helmholtz-Zentrum für Infektionsforschung GmbH
Priority to EP10715096.3A priority Critical patent/EP2408927B1/en
Priority to US13/257,383 priority patent/US20120231972A1/en
Priority to ES10715096.3T priority patent/ES2449581T3/en
Publication of WO2010105851A1 publication Critical patent/WO2010105851A1/en

Links

Classifications

    • GPHYSICS
    • G01MEASURING; TESTING
    • G01NINVESTIGATING OR ANALYSING MATERIALS BY DETERMINING THEIR CHEMICAL OR PHYSICAL PROPERTIES
    • G01N33/00Investigating or analysing materials by specific methods not covered by groups G01N1/00 - G01N31/00
    • G01N33/48Biological material, e.g. blood, urine; Haemocytometers
    • G01N33/50Chemical analysis of biological material, e.g. blood, urine; Testing involving biospecific ligand binding methods; Immunological testing
    • G01N33/53Immunoassay; Biospecific binding assay; Materials therefor
    • G01N33/536Immunoassay; Biospecific binding assay; Materials therefor with immune complex formed in liquid phase
    • G01N33/542Immunoassay; Biospecific binding assay; Materials therefor with immune complex formed in liquid phase with steric inhibition or signal modification, e.g. fluorescent quenching
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12QMEASURING OR TESTING PROCESSES INVOLVING ENZYMES, NUCLEIC ACIDS OR MICROORGANISMS; COMPOSITIONS OR TEST PAPERS THEREFOR; PROCESSES OF PREPARING SUCH COMPOSITIONS; CONDITION-RESPONSIVE CONTROL IN MICROBIOLOGICAL OR ENZYMOLOGICAL PROCESSES
    • C12Q1/00Measuring or testing processes involving enzymes, nucleic acids or microorganisms; Compositions therefor; Processes of preparing such compositions
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12QMEASURING OR TESTING PROCESSES INVOLVING ENZYMES, NUCLEIC ACIDS OR MICROORGANISMS; COMPOSITIONS OR TEST PAPERS THEREFOR; PROCESSES OF PREPARING SUCH COMPOSITIONS; CONDITION-RESPONSIVE CONTROL IN MICROBIOLOGICAL OR ENZYMOLOGICAL PROCESSES
    • C12Q1/00Measuring or testing processes involving enzymes, nucleic acids or microorganisms; Compositions therefor; Processes of preparing such compositions
    • C12Q1/34Measuring or testing processes involving enzymes, nucleic acids or microorganisms; Compositions therefor; Processes of preparing such compositions involving hydrolase

Definitions

  • the present invention relates to a probe compound for detecting and isolating enzymes, to a method for producing the probe compound, to means for detecting enzymes and means for isolating enzymes, to a method for producing the means for detecting and isolating enzymes, and to a method for detecting and isolating enzymes using the same.
  • the present invention relates to a probe compound that can comprise any substrate or metabolite of an enzymatic reaction in addition to an indicator component, such as, for example, a fluorescence dye, or the like.
  • the present invention relates to means for detecting enzymes in form of an array.
  • the array according to the present invention comprises any number of probe compounds of the invention which each comprise a different metabolite of interconnected metabolites representing the central pathways in all forms of life.
  • the probe compound and the array of the invention can be used for detecting specific enzyme-substrate interactions associated with the corresponding substrate (s) or metabolite (s) , which allows to identify substrate-specific enzymatic activity in a sample.
  • the present invention relates to a method for detecting enzymes involving the application of cell extracts or the like to the array of the invention which leads to reproducible enzymatic reactions with the substrates. These specific enzymatic reactions trigger the indicator (e.g. a fluorescence signal) and bind the enzymes to the respective cognate substrates.
  • the invention relates to means for isolating enzymes in form of nanoparticles coated with the probe compound of the invention. The immobilisation of the cognate substrates or metabolites on the surface of nanoparticles by means of the probe compounds allows capturing and isolating the respective enzyme, e.g. for subsequent sequencing.
  • the probe compound of the invention provides two new aspects: first, that only an active protein (enzyme) triggers the indicator signal, and second, that the active protein subsequently binds to the probe compound .
  • 'array' refers to a collection of a large number of different test compounds preferably arranged in a planar plane, e.g. by attachment on a flat surface, such as a glass slide surface, or by occupying special compartments or wells provided on a plate, such as a micro-titre plate.
  • the test compounds which are also referred to as probes, probe compounds or probe molecules, are usually bound or immobilised on the flat surface or to the walls of a compartment, respectively.
  • arrays allow for the rapid, simultaneous testing of all probe molecules with respect to their interaction with an analyte or a mixture of analytes in a sample.
  • the analytes of the sample are often referred to as target molecules.
  • the advantage of a planar array over a test (assay) having immobilised probe molecules on mobile elements, such as, for example, beads, is that in an array the chemical structure and/or the identity of the immobilised probe molecules is precisely defined by their location in the array surface.
  • a specific local test signal which is produced, for example, by an interaction between the probe molecule and the analyte molecule, can accordingly be immediately assigned to a type of molecule or to a probe molecule.
  • biochips As evidence of an interaction between a probe molecule and an analyte molecule, it is also possible to use the enzymatic conversion of the probe by the biomolecule, with the result that a local test signal can also disappear and accordingly serves as direct evidence. Particularly in miniaturised form, arrays having biological probe molecules are also known as "biochips".
  • the surface of the microarray having the bound probe molecules is brought into contact, over its entire area, with the solution of the analyte molecules from a sample. Then, the solution is usually removed after a predetermined incubation time. Alternatively, appropriate amounts of the sample solution are filled into the respective compartments (wells) of the array.
  • a signal is generated at the location of the probe molecule. That signal can either be produced directly, for example by binding of a fluoresence-labelled biomolecule, or can be generated in further treatments with detection reagents, for example in the form of an optical or radioactive signal.
  • detection reagents for example in the form of an optical or radioactive signal.
  • nucleic acid arrays of DNA fragments, cDNAs, RNAs, PCR products, plasmids, bacteriophages and synthetic PNA oligomers which are selected by means of hybridisation, with formation of a double- strand molecule, to give complementary nucleic acid analytes .
  • protein arrays of antibodies, proteins expressed in cells or phage fusion proteins (phage display) play an important part.
  • compound arrays of synthetic peptides, analogues thereof, such as peptoids, oligocarbamates or generally organic chemical compounds are known, which are selected, for example, by means of binding to affinitive protein analytes or other analytes by means of enzymatic reaction.
  • arrays of chimaeras and conjugates of the said probe molecules have been described.
  • DNA microarray technology has a vast potential for improving the understanding of microbial systems.
  • Microarray-based genomic technology is a powerful tool for viewing the expression of thousands of genes simultaneously in a single experiment. While this technology was initially designed for transcriptional profiling of a single species, its applications have been dramatically extended to environmental applications in recent years.
  • the use of microarrays to profile metagenomic libraries may also offer an effective approach for characterizing many clones rapidly. As an example, a fosmid library was obtained and further arrayed on a glass slide. This format is referred to as a metagenome microarray (MGA) .
  • MMA metagenome microarray
  • the ⁇ probe' and ⁇ target' concept is a reversal of those of general cDNA and oligonucleotide microarrays : targets (fosmid clones) are spotted on a slide and a specific gene probe is labelled and used for hybridization.
  • targets fosmid clones
  • This format of microarray may offer an effective metagenome -screening approach for identifying clones from metagenome libraries rapidly without the need of laborious procedures for screening various target genes.
  • Microarrays for expression profiling can be divided into two broad categories, microarrays based on the deposition of preassembled DNA probes (cDNA microarrays) and those based on in situ synthesis of oligonucleotide probes (e.g. Affymetrix arrays, oligonucleotide microarrays) .
  • Applications employing DNA microarrays include, for example, the characterization of microbial communities from environmental samples such as soil and water.
  • Various types of DNA microarrays have been applied to study the microbial diversity of various environments. Those include, for example, oligonucleotides, cDNA (PCR amplified DNA fragments) , and whole genome DNA.
  • nucleic acid-based micro-arrays One of the major problems associated with nucleic acid-based micro-arrays is derived from the short half-life of mRNA, and that mRNA in bacteria and archaea usually comprise only a small fraction of total RNA. Moreover, the study of the gene expression from an environmental sample using DNA microarrays is a challenging task. First, the sensitivity may often be a part of the problem in PCR-based cDNA microarrays, since only- genes from populations contributing to more than 5% of the community DNA can be detected. Second, samples often contain a variety of environmental contaminants that affects the quality of RNA and DNA hybridization and makes it difficult to extract undegraded mRNA.
  • the specificity of the extraction method plays a central role and should vary depending on the site of sampling, as there must be sufficient discrimination between probes.
  • the peptide arrays are the most popular.
  • peptides with different chemical composition are synthesised and immobilized on glass slides.
  • the peptides may also contain a marker, such as a fluorescence dye marker (e.g. a fluorescent cyanine dye known under the name ' Cy3 ' ) , but here the detection method is only based on the lowered fluorescence obtained with a protein bound to the molecule.
  • a fluorescence dye marker e.g. a fluorescent cyanine dye known under the name ' Cy3 '
  • Another array alternative is to bind proteins to a slide.
  • Such system is usually not based on the detection of a fluorescence signal, but rather on the utilization of surface Plasmon resonance. This system has been exploited for the analysis of molecular interactions, i.e. protein- protein or molecule-protein interactions.
  • the present invention is therefore based on the object of providing a novel probe compound, which allows for the testing of a reactive interaction of an enzyme with a small molecule or enzymatic substrate.
  • the probe compound should allow for the easy linkage of all small molecules or substrates necessary for the life functions of an organism or communities living in a habitat (biocoenosis) .
  • a plurality of probe compounds should allow for the construction of a ' reactome array 1 or microarray which allows for the testing of all life supporting enzymatic reactions of an organism or community simultaneosly .
  • the probe compound should provide a highly sensitive, accurate, reproducible, and robust high- throughput tool for a genome-wide analysis of the metabolic status of an organism or community.
  • the term "genome-wide analysis” means an analysis that is independent of genome sequence.
  • the probe compound should also allow for use in the isolation of an enzyme so that said enzyme may be further analysed or identified in a subsequent step.
  • the probe compound should also allow for the identification of small molecules, substrates and/or metabolites which are metabolised by an organism or community, thus allowing the identification of biologic pathways or the direct comparison of the reactomes of different organisms, which might be applied in the search for new targets for drug- screening .
  • the object of the invention is solved by a probe compound comprising a transition metal complex and a reactive component comprising a test component and an indicator component, wherein the test component and the indicator component are linked to form the reactive component, and wherein the reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex.
  • the probe compound of the invention provides a means for testing of a reactive interaction of an enzyme with a small molecule or enzymatic substrate.
  • the probe compound may be readily used in combination with all small molecules or substrates necessary for the life functions of an organism or communities living in a habitat
  • the probe compound provides a highly sensitive, accurate, reproducible, and robust high- throughput tool for a genome-wide analysis of the metabolic status of an organism or community. It allows the fast and reliable detection of a substrate specific enzyme interaction. Moreover, the probe compound may be readily used to detect the involvement of one enzymatic substrate in different metabolic pathways. Moreover, the probe compound provides a means to immobilise a substrate-specific enzyme, which can be advantageously used to isolate this enzyme from a sample.
  • the object of the invention is solved by a probe compound for detecting specific enzyme -substrate interactions comprising a transition metal complex and a reactive component of general formula (X) :
  • His represents a histidine residue
  • TC represents a test component
  • IC represents an indicator component
  • each of L H i s - ⁇ c/ L ⁇ c-ic and Li C -Hi S independently represents optional linker components, wherein the reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex by the two histidine residues.
  • a preferred embodiment of the probe compound of the invention can be illustrated by the following general formula (1) :
  • the present invention relates to a probe compound that can comprise any substrate or metabolite of an enzymatic reaction in addition to an indicator component, such as, for example, a fluorescence dye, or the like.
  • the probe compound of the invention provides two new aspects: first, that only an active protein (enzyme) triggers the indicator signal, and second, that the active protein subsequently binds to the probe compound.
  • the object of the invention is also solved by a method for preparing the probe compound of the invention.
  • the inventive method provides a versatile method for preparing all embodiments of the probe compound.
  • the method of the invention can be used for the identical and reproducible production of probe compounds comprising different enzymatic substrates, which allows for the ready use in automatic processes, such as parallel synthesis or the like.
  • the object is also solved by an array which comprises a plurality of different probe compounds of the invention.
  • the array (which is sometimes referred to as "reactome array” in the following) can be used for the simultaneous detection of all reactive interactions between the probe compounds and analyte molecules (enzymes) from a sample.
  • the array also provides a fast and reliable way to detect all metabolic pathways active in an organism or community, and may be used advantageously for an activity-based, annotation- independent procedure for the global assessment of cellular responses.
  • the array can include a number of interconnected metabolites representing central pathways in all forms of life. The application of cell extracts to the array leads to reproducible enzymatic reactions with substrates that trigger the indicator signal and bind enzymes to cognate substrates.
  • the invention also provides a method for producing an array according to the invention, which allows for a versatile, fast and reproducible production of arrays according to the invention .
  • an isolation means comprising a probe compound according to the invention and a nanoparticle, preferably a magnetic nanoparticle .
  • the isolation means according to the invention allows for the substrate specific interaction and binding of an enzyme which can then be isolated by means, such as, for example, filtration, gravitation force (centrifugation) , an external magnetic force, or the like.
  • the invention also provides a method for producing an isolation means according to the invention. The immobilisation of the cognate substrates or metabolites on the surface of nanoparticles by means of the probe compounds allows capturing and isolating the respective enzyme, e.g. for subsequent sequencing.
  • the object is solved by a method for detecting enzymes using the probe compound according to the invention, or the array according to the invention, as well as by a method for isolating enzymes, using the isolation means according to the invention.
  • Figure 1 shows a schematic overview of the array strategy, including a summary of the four major steps in the construction and analysis of arrays.
  • Steps 1 and 2 extensive data and synthetic mining effort to produce a library of metabolites than can be arrayed on glass slides in a spatially-addressable manner;
  • steps 3 nad 4 detection and analysis of enzymatic reactions following application of cell lysates to the array, and metabolic reconstructions.
  • Figure 2 shows an overview of the array strategy, including a summary of the four major steps in the construction of metabolite complexes.
  • Fig. 3 illustrates the reactome strategy.
  • the generic structure of reactome metabolites involves three linked components, the enzyme substrate-metabolite, the quenched dye, and the linker used to immobilize the complex on the array or on nanoparticles .
  • the substrate-metabolite is linked to the quenched dye though a labile nitrogen bond, and both the dye and the substrate are anchored to the Co (II) -containing poly (A) linker by histidine 'tags' .
  • Figure 4 shows Dose-response curves determined with pure E. coli ⁇ -Gal and Cy3-linked X-GaI.
  • A Substrate dose response with fixed amount of ⁇ -Gal (5 ng/ml) ;
  • B ⁇ -Gal dose response with fixed amount of Cy3 -modified X-GaI (2.52 pmol/ml) .
  • normalized intensity values and fit curves were scaled relative to the maximum asymptotic values of the fit.
  • FIG. 5 shows the Receiver Operating Characteristic (ROC) curve of the array.
  • the ROC shows the capacity of the array to discriminate compounds potentially metabolised by P. putida from those which are not metabolised.
  • the "true positive rate” (TRP) is plotted on the Y-axis against the
  • FRP false positive rate
  • Figure 6 shows an overall comparison of metabolites transformed by lysates of the three communities KOL, VUL and L'A.
  • A Pairwise comparisons of the compounds metabolized by lysates of the KOL, VUL and L'A metagenome libraries.
  • B Overall comparison of compounds metabolized by the three libraries.
  • C Pairwise comparisons of the compounds metabolized by lysates of the individual metagenome libraries and that of P. putida.
  • Figure 7 shows dose-response curves determined with purified P. putida KT2440 proteins (A) and metagenomic proteins (B) . Left and right figures represent protein and molecule dose responses. Results shown are the average of three independent assays, and were corrected for background signal. Results are not fitted to any model.
  • the spotting process was carried out using a MicroGrid II micro-arrayer (Biorobotics) by spotting 0.25 nL droplets of SMs-Cy3 solutions (spot size 400 ⁇ m diameter with concentrations ranging from 0 to 0.25 pmol/ml) and further arrayed with 60 ⁇ l of a solution of pure enzyme (from 16 to 90 ng/ml in PBS buffer, depending on the enzyme used) (left column) or by spotting 0.25 nL droplets of SMs-Cy3 solution (spot size 400 ⁇ m diameter with concentration of 0.4 pmol/ml) and further arrayed with 60 ⁇ l of solution of pure enzyme at different concentrations (from 0 to 6000 ⁇ g/ml in PBS buffer) .
  • Figure 8 summarizes the major steps used for the construction of metabolite complexes corresponding to the 26 different synthetic methods.
  • Abbreviations used are as follows: 1,8-BDN ( 1 , 8 -bis- (dimethylamino) -naphthalene) ; REBr (hybrid halogenase/dehalogenase; MeOH (methanol) , (E) compound (Cy3 intermediate containing histidine and linkers) .
  • Figure 9 shows representative molecules of the different synthetic methods used to link metabolites with histidine and the dye molecule.
  • the present invention provides a probe compound comprising a transition metal complex and a reactive component comprising a test component and an indicator component, wherein the test component and the indicator component are linked to form the reactive component, and wherein the reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex.
  • the probe compound of the invention thus comprises the following components: a transition metal complex and a reactive component.
  • the reactive component in turn comprises the following components: a test component and an indicator component, which are linked to form the reactive component. Further, the reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex.
  • a preferred embodiment of the probe compound of the invention can be illustrated by the following general formula (1) :
  • LMC-IC - IC wherein AC represents an optional anchoring component, MC represents the transition metal complex, TC represents the test component, IC represents the indicator component, and L AC - M c, L M c- ⁇ c/ L TC -I C and L MC-IC each independently represents an optional linker moiety between the respective components indicated by the subscripts.
  • the probe compound for detecting specific enzyme -substrate interactions comprises a transition metal complex and a reactive component of general formula (X) :
  • His represents a histidine residue
  • TC represents a test component
  • IC represents an indicator component
  • each of L H i S - ⁇ c, L ⁇ c-ic and L IC -His independently represents optional linker components, wherein the reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex by the two histidine residues.
  • the term "linked” means that two components are connected with each other by means of at least one chemical bond, preferably by one, two, or three chemical bonds, and most preferred by exactly one chemical bond.
  • a chemical bond indicates any chemical bond known in the art, such as, for example, an ionic bond, a covalent bond, including a single bond, a double bond, a triple bond, or another suitable multiple bond, and a hydrogen bond, and the like.
  • the chemical bond between the individual components is a covalent single bond.
  • the "link" or chemical bond between two components is a direct bond between the two components; but it may also comprise a suitable linker atom or molecule, if necessary.
  • one or both of the components to be linked will have to be activated in order to allow for the formation of a chemical bond or link.
  • the procedures and means to be applied for such activation and formation of chemical bonds are standard knowledge of the field, and any skilled person will immediately know how to proceed.
  • the term “component” is used to indicate the respective parts of the probe compound which are characterised by their respective function as determined in the following.
  • component is meant to refer to a specified part or moiety of a molecule, which is identified by its function within this molecule.
  • indicator component refers to a part or moiety of the molecule, which comprises a signal-generating function, e.g. a fluorescence dye or the like, that allows for indicating the location of the probe compound.
  • test component refers to a part or moiety of the molecule, which comprises a substrate or metabolite, thus being the site of enzymatic interaction with the probe compound.
  • the respective components are linked by chemical bonds to form the molecule, i.e. the probe compound.
  • component is used with the meaning of “part” or “moiety” of one compound or molecule, and not to refer to individual members of a multi -molecule system.
  • the terms “component”, “part” and “moiety” may be used alternatively with this meaning.
  • component will also be used to refer to the respective molecules before they are reacted to form the respective part (component) of the probe compound, or after they are released from the probe compound, respectively.
  • component will also be used to refer to the respective molecules before they are reacted to form the respective part (component) of the probe compound, or after they are released from the probe compound, respectively.
  • a chemical bond can be a hydrogen bond, an ionic bond or a covalent bond, including a bond between a transition metal atom and its surrounding ligand atoms in a coordination compound (also referred to as "coordination bond” in the following) .
  • the chemical bond(s) between the components of the probe molecule are covalent bonds, further preferred covalent single bonds, wherein the bond(s) between the reactive component and the transition metal complex preferably are coordination bonds.
  • the probe compound of the invention is required to have bonds between the transition metal complex and the reactive component, as well as between the test component and the indicator component forming the reactive component.
  • the respective components may also be linked by additional bonds, as long as such bonds do not hinder the function of the probe compound.
  • the reactive component may be linked to the transition metal complex by at least one coordination bond formed between the test component moiety of the reactive component and the central metal atom of the transition metal complex and by at least one coordination bond formed between the indicator component moiety of the reactive component and the central metal atom of the transition metal complex.
  • the reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex by exactly one coordination bond formed between the test component moiety of the reactive component and the central metal atom of the transition metal complex and by exactly one coordination bond formed between the indicator component moiety of the reactive component and the central metal atom of the transition metal complex.
  • the respective coordination bonds can be direct bonds between the metal atom and a suitable atom of the test or indicator components, or a bond formed via a suitable linker moiety, which is linked to the test and/or indicator component, respectively.
  • a preferred linker moiety is a histidine residue.
  • test component is used for the part or component of the probe compound which comprises a substrate or metabolite.
  • substrate and “metobolite” refer to any molecule capable of specific interaction with the active site of an enzyme.
  • the substrate or metabolite is comprised in the test component in such a manner that its characteristic structure and/or functional groups necessary for interaction with the active site of an enzyme are maintained within the test component. Therefore, the substrate or metabolite is preferably linked to the other components of the probe compound at positions of the substrate or metabolite molecule, which are not involved in enzyme -substrate interaction.
  • test component refers to the component comprising both the substrate and the spacer moiety.
  • the test component may be linked to the probe compound by chemical bonds involving positions, i.e. atoms or functional groups, of the substrate or metabolite and/or an optional spacer or linker moiety.
  • test component is preferably used to indicate a component comprising a so-called "small organic molecule” that can interact with an enzyme.
  • small organic molecule refers to a molecule comprising of carbon and hydrogen atoms, optionally including nitrogen, oxygen, phosphorous, sulfur, and/or halogen (F, Cl, Br, I) atoms, and having a molecular weight of 5000 Da or less, preferably of 2000 Da or less.
  • the test component comprises a known substrate of at least one enzyme.
  • the test component can also comprise a pseudo-substrate or inhibitor of a known enzyme.
  • the test component may also comprise a molecule suspected to interact with the active site of an enzyme.
  • the test component may also comprise a small organic molecules for the search for pharmaceutical active ingredients.
  • the "test component” does not comprise a polymeric compound based on nucleic acids, such as DNA, cDNA, RNA, or the like, or a polymeric compound based on amino acids, such as peptides, proteins, or the like.
  • the test component may comprise at least one nucleic acid and/or amino acid, if necessary.
  • the test component comprises one or two nucleic acids, or one or two amino acids.
  • the test component comprises a polymeric compound, such as a polymeric compound based on natural occurring sugar units or the like, e.g. cellulose or the like.
  • a polymeric compound has a molecular weight of 5000 Da or less, i.e.
  • the test component comprises a polymeric compound based on nucleic acids, such as DNA, cDNA, RNA, or the like, and/or a polymeric compound based on amino acids, such as peptides, proteins, or the like.
  • the test component can be preferably functionalised with a linker component or moiety suitable for binding to the transition metal complex. Such functionalisation is especially advantageous for test components comprising substrates, which do not readily form coordination bonds.
  • the test component is functionalised with a histidine molecule or residue (sometimes referred to as a "His-tag" in the following) .
  • the amino acid histidine was found to be especially versatile, because it may be linked to a test component or indicator component by either its amine function or its carboxylic acid function, while the imidazole ring provides for a good coordination bond to the transition metal atom.
  • a histidine residue may be linked to the substrate or metabolite comprised in the test component or to another part of the test component, either directly or using a suitable linker moiety.
  • a histidine residue may be linked to the dye comprised in the indicator component or to another part of the indicator component, either directly or using a suitable linker moiety.
  • a skilled person will know how to link a histidine residue to the desired site or position of a test or indicator component, whether a special activation and/or linker moiety will be required, as well as the starting materials and conditions necessary therefor, etc.
  • a His-tag has the additional advantage to ensure an identical binding property of all possible substrates to the transition metal complex. Moreover, it was found that a link including a His-tag may be advantageously broken upon enzymatic reaction of a test component comprising a His-tag. Moreover, it was found that by selecting the site of histidine binding to the test component, it is possible to prepare probe compounds which allow for the identification of different metabolic pathways and the enzymes involved therein.
  • indicator component is used to indicate a molecule which can generate a signal, thus indicating the location of the probe molecule, e.g. on an array. That signal can either be produced directly, for example by adsorbance or fluorescence, or can be generated in further treatments with detection reagents, for example in the form of an optical or radioactive signal.
  • the indicator component comprises a dye, further preferred a fluorescence dye.
  • fluorescence dye indicates a molecule showing fluorescence upon irradiation with a suitable light source.
  • an indicator component comprises a fluorescent azo compound or a cyanine compound, or the like.
  • a cyanine compound which is known in the art under the name of "Cy3".
  • the moiety having the fluorescence property is further modified, e.g. by addition of a suitable linker moiety, in order to allow the binding to the test component, and/or to the transition metal complex.
  • a Cy3 dye available as its Cy3-NHS-ester may be reacted with both histidine and a 4 -amino-3 -butyric acid linker to allow for linking with both the transition metal complex and the test component, respectively.
  • An additional linker moiety has the advantage to ensure an identical and reproducible binding to the indicator component and/or the transition metal complex, which allows for the ready use in parallel synthesis or the like.
  • the test component is linked to the indicator component to form the reactive component.
  • the test component is linked to the indicator component by at least one covalent chemical bond, further preferred by one, two, or three covalent bonds, and still further preferred by exactly one covalent bond.
  • a preferred example of such a covalent bond is a carbon-oxygen single bond, which can be formed between the test component and the indicator component by various chemical reactions, such as, for example, a condensation reaction, an addition reaction, an oxidation reaction, and the like.
  • a preferred example is a condensation reaction between a carboxylic acid and an alcohol, or between two alcohols, or an addition reaction wherein the oxygen atom of an alcohol function is added to an aliphatic or aromatic carbon atom, or the like.
  • the link or bond between the test component and the indicator component may also be formed between the test component and a linker moiety previously attached to the indicator component, or vice versa.
  • An additional linker moiety has the advantage to ensure an identical and reproducible binding to the test component, which allows for the ready use in parallel synthesis or the like.
  • the indicator component comprises an amino butyric acid linker moiety, and a bond or link to the test component is formed using the carboxylic acid function of this linker moiety.
  • the link between indicator component and test component comprises a linker moiety comprising an amino butyric acid linker residue attached to the indicator component, the carboxylic acid function of which is linked to another linker moiety comprising a quaternary amine function, which in turn is linked to the test component.
  • linker moiety can be formed, for example, by reacting an indicator component, e.g. a fluorescence dye, first with 4-amino-3-butanoate and then with N,N-dimethylethanolamine .
  • Linking with the test component under formation of a quaternary amine can then be obtained by reacting the so- prepared indicator component having a linker moiety comprising an amino butyric acid residue, the carboxylic acid function of which is esterised by N, N- dimethylethanolamine, with a iodine-containing test component in the presence of 1 , 8-bis- (dimethylamino) - naphthalene, or a similar method.
  • the reactive component comprising the test component and the indicator component, which are linked to each other, optionally by a linker moiety or molecule, is in turn linked to the transition metal complex.
  • the reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex by two, three or four coordination bonds, and further preferred by exactly two coordination bonds. That means that at least one atom of the reactive component is a direct ligand atom of the transition metal atom of the transition metal complex, thus being part of the immediate coordination sphere of the central transition metal atom of the transition metal complex.
  • the term "at least one atom of the reactive component” also includes an atom of a linker moiety, which can optionally be attached to either the test component or the indicator component.
  • a histidine molecule is attached as a linker moiety (His-tag) to the reactive component.
  • the "at least one atom of the reactive component” can also indicate an atom of the His-tag, preferably a nitrogen atom of the imidazole ring system.
  • the reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex by two coordination bonds, wherein one ligand atom is an atom of the test component and the other ligand atom is an atom of the indicator component.
  • the reactive component comprises a His-tag linked to the test component and a His-tag linked to the indicator component.
  • the reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex by two coordination bonds, wherein each bond includes one atom of one of the respective His- tags .
  • a preferred coordination bond between the reactive component and the transition metal complex is a M-O-R-bond, wherein M indicates the transition metal atom and O-R indicates an oxygen atom or function of a molecule R constituting the reactive component.
  • suitable oxygen functions are an alcoholate function (R-O ' ) , a carboxylate function (RCOO " ) , a peroxide function (R-O-O " ), or the like.
  • Another preferred coordination bond between the reactive component and the transition metal complex is a M-N-R-bond, wherein M indicates the transition metal atom and N-R indicates a nitrogen atom or function of a molecule R constituting the reactive component.
  • nitrogen function is an aliphaptic amine function, including a primary, propely and tertiary amine function.
  • the nitrogen atom can also be part of an aromatic or (partially) saturated ring system, such as, for example, a pyrrol, imidazole, diazole or triazole ring, or the like.
  • a specially preferred coordination bond is a coordination bond comprising a nitrogen atom of an imidazole ring, which may be part of a histidine moiety or His-tag.
  • Another preferred coordination bond is a M-S-R or a M-C-R single bond, wherein M indicates the transition metal atom and S and C, respectively, indicate a sulphur or carbon function of a molecule R constituting the reactive component.
  • the transition metal complex preferably comprises at least one transition metal atom and at least one ligand molecule, wherein at least one coordination bond is formed between the ligand molecule and the transition metal atom.
  • the at least one ligand molecule preferably comprises one or more atoms or funtions which can form a coordination bond with a transition metal atom.
  • Preferred examples for atoms or function are an oxygen atom, a nitrogen atom, a phosphorous atom, a sulphur atom, or the like. These atom or functions all can form a coordination bond with a transition metal atom, and are the same as exemplified above.
  • a ligand molecule comprises more than one atom or function that can form a coordination bond with a transition metal atom, further preferred two to eight of such atoms or functions, still further preferred three to five of such atoms or functions, and most preferred four or five of such atoms of functions.
  • the transition metal complex comprises exactly one transition metal atom and exactly one ligand molecule comprising more than one atom or function that can form a coordination bond with a transition metal atom.
  • transition metal atom is used to indicate the central transition metal atom of the transition metal complex, which is linked to both the , ligand molecule (s) and the reactive component by coordination bonds as defined above.
  • transition metal atoms examples include Ti, V, Mn, Fe, Co, Ni, Cu, Zn, Mo, W, Pt, Au, or the like. Preferred examples are Co, Ni, and Cu.
  • the transition metal atom means any transition metal atom irrespective of its oxidation state.
  • the term transition metal ion is also used for a transition metal atom that carries a net charge, which is sometimes referred to as a "transition metal ion" in the art, wherein a formal charge or oxidation state is assigned to the transition metal atom or ion.
  • Preferred oxidation states of transition metal atoms of the present invention are from 0 to +4, preferably +2 to +3, and especially preferred +2.
  • transition metal atoms are Co(II), Ni(II) , and Cu(II) .
  • the coordinating atoms or functions of the ligand molecule may be assigned with a formal charge, wherein preferred charges range from 0 to -2, wherein a charge of 0 or -1 is especially preferred.
  • the term "ligand molecule" refers to a molecule that comprises at least one atom or function which forms a direct coordination bond to the central atom of a transition metal complex, preferably one, two, three, four, five, six, seven, or eight such atoms or functions.
  • probe compound indicates a compound or molecule that can interact with an enzyme (or analyte molecule) in a reactive manner, as outlined in the following.
  • the term 11 interaction with an enzyme in a reactive manner indicates an interaction wherein the reactive component is not only bound to the enzyme, but also transformed in a reaction catalysed by the enzyme (metabolised) .
  • the reaction catalysed by the enzyme can be any reaction catalysed by an enzyme, such as, for example, an oxidation or reduction reaction, an addition reaction, a hydrolytic bond cleaving reaction, an elimination reaction, an isomerisation reaction, or a condensation reaction.
  • the reaction catalysed by the enzyme is a hydrolytic cleaving reaction or an elimination reaction, wherein the enzyme cleaves the link between the test component, or its reaction product, respectively, and the indicator component and/or the transition metal complex.
  • the interaction with the enzyme results in a cleavage of the link between the test component and the transition metal complex by the enzyme, whereupon a reaction product comprising the metabolised test component and the indicator component together is formed.
  • the interaction with the enzyme may also result in a cleavage of both the link between the test component and the transition metal complex and the link between the test component and the indicator component by the enzyme, whereupon more than one reaction products comprising the metabolised test component and/or the indicator component in separate molecules, may be released from the probe compound.
  • the test component is linked to the transition metal complex by a histidine moiety (His-tag)
  • His-tag histidine moiety
  • the reaction product comprising both the test component and the indicator component remains linked to the transition metal complex, and thus to the remainder of the probe compound.
  • the test component or the reaction product thereof may remain bound to the active site of the enzyme, thus immobilising the enzyme to the probe compound, or its reaction product, respectively.
  • the signal characteristic of the indicator component which is triggered by the enzymatic reaction, also remains at the probe compound .
  • reaction product comprising the indicator component indicates a compound or molecule based on the indicator component or test component, respectively, which is metabolised and/or released by the corresponding reaction catalysed by the enzyme.
  • the interaction with the enzyme results in a cleavage of the both the link between the test component and the transition metal complex and the link between the test component and the indicator component by the enzyme, whereupon a reaction product comprising the metabolised test component, or more than one reaction products comprising the metabolised test component and/or the indicator component in separate molecules, may be released from the probe compound.
  • a reaction product comprising the metabolised test component or more than one reaction products comprising the metabolised test component and/or the indicator component in separate molecules, may be released from the probe compound.
  • the test component is linked to the transition metal complex by a histidine moiety (His-tag)
  • His-tag histidine moiety
  • the reaction product comprising the indicator component is not released from the probe compound, i.e. the reaction product comprising the indicator component remains part of the probe compound, or its reaction product, respectively.
  • the indicator component is linked to the transition metal complex by a histidine moiety (His-tag)
  • Histidine remains linked to both the transition metal complex and the indicator component upon enzymatic cleavage of the link between the test component and the indicator component .
  • the reaction product comprising the indicator component remains linked to the transition metal complex, and thus to the remainder of the probe compound.
  • the signal characteristic of the indicator component which is triggered by the enzymatic reaction, also remains at the probe compound .
  • the reaction product comprising the test component is not released from the probe compound.
  • the test component is linked to the transition metal complex by a histidine moiety (His-tag)
  • His-tag histidine moiety
  • the reaction product comprising both the test component and the indicator component remains linked to the transition metal complex, and thus to the remainder of the probe compound.
  • the test component or the reaction product thereof may remain bound to the active site of the enzyme, thus immobilising the enzyme to the probe compound, or its reaction product, respectively.
  • the signal characteristic of the indicator component which is triggered by the enzymatic reaction, also remains at the probe compound .
  • the interaction of the probe compound with an enzyme results in the cleavage of both the links between transition metal complex and the reactive component as well as the link between the test component and the indicator component.
  • This in turn exposes the transition metal atom which then ligates the enzyme, which can be used to immobilize the enzyme on an array spot or the like.
  • the released indicator component has a changed binding situation which may preferably result in the generation of a signal.
  • the probe compound of the present invention allows for the detection of enzyme concentrations which are as low as 1.5 ng/ml protein or 2.5 pmol/ml substrate, respectively.
  • the probe compound of the invention advantageously allows for the testing of a reactive interaction of an enzyme with a small molecule or enzymatic substrate.
  • the presence of the central transition metal complex further allows to provide a probe compound wherein all small molecules or substrates necessary for the life functions of an organism or communities living in a habitat can be readily included.
  • Information about substrates that are involved in one or more metabolic reactions and about the enzymes involved in the corresponding metabolic reactions may be found, for example, in the Kyoto Encyclopedia of Genes and Genomes (KEGG Database) , the University of Minnesota Biocatalysis and Biodegration Database (UM-BBD) , PubMed, or the like.
  • the probe compound of the invention was shown to be highly versatile for the identification of the reactive interaction with any small molecule or substrate tested so far.
  • the key characteristic of the probe compound is that a productive reaction with a cognate enzyme releases the indicator component, producing a detectable signal, e.g. a fluorescent signal, and simultaneously results in the capture of the reacting enzyme through coordination with the transition metal complex.
  • a productive reaction with a cognate enzyme releases the indicator component, producing a detectable signal, e.g. a fluorescent signal, and simultaneously results in the capture of the reacting enzyme through coordination with the transition metal complex.
  • Nonproductive interactions of proteins with the probe compound such as, for example, binding without chemical reaction, do not lead to the release of the indicator component and the associated production of a detectable signal.
  • An example of this reactional behaviour is shown in Figure 3.
  • the probe compound provides a highly sensitive, accurate, reproducible, and robust high-throughput tool for a genome- wide analysis of the metabolic status of an organism or community.
  • the complete reactome i.e. the complement of metabolic reactions of an organism
  • the transition metal complex comprises a cobalt or copper atom, and most preferred a cobalt atom. It was found that a cobalt or copper complex shows an advantageous binding property to all reactive components of interest, thus allowing for a most versatile use of the probe component of the invention. Especially preferred is a cobalt complex wherein the central cobalt atom is assigned a formal oxidation state of +2.
  • the transition metal complex comprises a multidentate ligand molecule, i.e. a ligand molecule comprising two or more ligand atoms bound to the central transition metal atom.
  • the transition metal complex comprises a multidentate ligand molecule comprising two, three, four, five, or six ligand atoms bound to the central transition metal atom.
  • the transition metal complex comprises a multidentate ligand molecule whose coordinating ligand atoms do not occupy all possible coordination positions of the central transition metal atom.
  • a preferred ligand molecule for a central cobalt atom should provide three, four, or five coordinating ligand atoms, especially preferred four coordinating ligand atoms.
  • a preferred example for a ligand molecule is a molecule comprising at least one coordinating nitrogen atom, such as, for example, a nitrogen atom of an aliphatic amine function, and at least one coordinating oxygen atom, such as, for example, an oxygen of a carboxilic acid function.
  • a preferred example for a ligand molecule comprises nitrotriacetic acid.
  • a ligand molecule based on nitrotriacetic acid will occupy four of the five or six potential coordination or binding positions, thus leaving one or two free binding positions for binding of the reactive component.
  • a person skilled in the art will readily know which other ligand molecules exhibit similar properties and thus can also be used in the present invention.
  • the transition metal complex comprises an anchoring component.
  • anchoring component indicates a molecule or function that can be used to attach the probe compound to a solid surface, or to another component or molecule, or the like.
  • the transition metal complex, and thereby the whole probe compound can be attached to any suitable solid surface, or component or ' molecule, known in the art.
  • suitable solid surfaces may be porous surfaces, such as, for example, paper or cellulose substrates or the like, or non-porous surfaces, such as, for example, glass surfaces, or surfaces of polymeric materials, such as a surface of polycarbonate, or the like.
  • the anchoring component can be used to attach the probe compound to the surface of a glass slide in order to form an array thereon.
  • the anchoring component can be used to attach the reactive compound to another component, such as, for example, a nanoparticle .
  • the anchoring component may be any molecule or function known in the art which has the desired function to allow for the attachment to a solid surface, another component or molecule, or the like. A person skilled in the art will readily know which molecule or function should be used for a desired attachment .
  • the anchoring component comprises a polymeric compound, further preferred a polymeric compound of a biomolecule.
  • a specially preferred anchoring component comprises a poly A chain, i.e. a polymer of adenosin. Any poly A chain known in the art may be used.
  • the poly A chain has a molecular weight of from 10 kDa to 150 kDa, further preferred of from 50 kDa to 120 kDa, and most preferred of about 100 kDa.
  • a poly A chain is known in the art for binding to glass surfaces, activated silica, or the like.
  • a poly A chain can be easily attached to a glass surface or the like, which might be optionally activated, and polymerised thereon using UV radiation according to standard protocols.
  • the anchoring component comprises at least one thiol function, which allows for the attachment to metal clusters, such as, for example, gold nanoparticles .
  • metal clusters such as, for example, gold nanoparticles
  • another function which is known to bind to a desired metal cluster or nanoparticle can also be used.
  • a compound which has a carboxylate group or a phosphate group in one moiety and a thiol group in the other moiety is preferably used.
  • a preferred example for an anchoring component comprising thiol functions is an ⁇ - dihydrolipoic acid residue (or a 6 , 8-dithioctic acid residue, TA) .
  • TA ⁇ - dihydrolipoic acid residue
  • the anchoring component is linked to the transition metal complex by a suitable spacer component or moiety, such as, for example, an aliphatic hydrocarbon chain having at least one suitable functional group (s) for linking, such as, for example, a pentyl moiety having an amino group, or the like.
  • a suitable spacer component or moiety such as, for example, an aliphatic hydrocarbon chain having at least one suitable functional group (s) for linking, such as, for example, a pentyl moiety having an amino group, or the like.
  • the anchoring component is directly linked to the transition metal complex.
  • the anchoring component is linked to the transition metal complex by a covalent bond, which is formed between an atom of the anchoring component and the ligand molecule of the transition metal complex.
  • the anchoring component can also be linked to the transition metal complex by a coordination bond, which is formed between an atom of the anchoring component and the central transition metal atom of the transition metal complex.
  • the multidentate ligand of the transition metal complex comprises the anchoring component .
  • the transition metal complex comprises a nitrotriacetic acid Co(II) complex. It was found that the presence of this transition metal complex allows for the most versatile adaptation of the probe compound for the identification of the reactive interaction with any small molecule or substrate tested so far.
  • a preferred transition metal complex comprising an anchoring component is provided by using the compound N ⁇ ,N ⁇ -bis- (carboxymethyl) -L- lysine, or (S) -N- (5-amino-l-carboxypentyl) -imino-diacetic acid, respectively, as a ligand molecule for forming a cobalt (II) complex.
  • the aminopentyl residue which is attached to one of the acetic acid groups of the ligand molecule, constitutes an anchoring component or a spacer moiety for attaching another anchoring component.
  • the amine function of this anchoring component itself can be readily used to attach the transition metal complex, and thus the whole probe compound, to another component or molecule, such as, for example, a nanoparticle .
  • this anchoring component can also be used to further attach a polymeric chain, such as, for example, a poly A chain, which can be used to attach the transition metal complex, and thus the whole probe compound, to a solid surface, such as, for example, a glass slide, in order to advantageously manufacture an array comprising corresponding probe compounds .
  • a polymeric chain such as, for example, a poly A chain
  • a solid surface such as, for example, a glass slide
  • probe compound indicates a compound or molecule that can be immobilised on a supporting base by the anchoring component .
  • the indicator component comprises a fluorescence dye, further preferred a fluorescent azo compound or a cyanine compound, examples of which are known in the art under the names of "Cy3" or "Cy5" or the like.
  • a fluorescence dye further preferred a fluorescent azo compound or a cyanine compound, examples of which are known in the art under the names of "Cy3" or "Cy5" or the like.
  • the corresponding hardware available commercially, such as, for example, wave-length optimised reader apparatuses, corresponding software solutions, and the like.
  • the present invention can easily be adopted to other indicator components and/or detection systems, if required. A person skilled in the art will also know how to carry out such adaptation.
  • the test component comprises a known substrate, a metabolite, a pseudo-substrate, or an inhibitor of an enzyme.
  • the test component comprises a molecule identified as a substrate of at least one metabolic reaction in the Kyoto Encyclopedia of Genes and Genomes (KEGG Database) , the University of Minnesota Biocatalysis and Biodegration Database (UM-BBD) , PubMed, or the like.
  • the test component comprises a compound selected from the group listed in Table 1, 2 and 3, respectively.
  • test component may also comprise additional metabolites characteristic of microbial metabolic activities not yet assigned or included in these databases, as well as
  • the transition metal complex is represented by the N ⁇ ,N ⁇ -bis- (carboxymethyl) -L-lysine cobalt (II) complex, which may further comprise an anchoring component comprising a poly A chain or a 6, 8-dithioctic acid (TA) linked to the free amine function of the ligand molecule.
  • an indicator component comprises a Cy3 fluorescent dye, which comprises a histidine moiety (His-tag) for linking to the transition metal complex and a aminobutyric acid moiety as an optional linker moiety for linking to the test component.
  • the test component may comprise any enzymatic substrate or other suitable small organic molecule, for example, one of the substrates listed in Table 1.
  • the test component is linked to the indicator component via the optional aminobutyric acid linker moiety and further comprises a histidine moiety (His-tag) for linking to the transition metal complex.
  • His-tag histidine moiety
  • the link between the test component and the indicator component further comprises a quaternary amine function.
  • the so-formed reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex by two coordination bonds, one of which comprises the His-tag linked to the test component, while the other comprises the His-tag of the indicator component. It was surprisingly found that, if the reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex, the characteristic fluorescence activity of the indicator component is no longer observed. In other words, the probe compound remains silent with respect to the characteristic fluorescence signal. This would result in a dark spot in an assay or array position. When the probe compound is brought into contact with an enzyme having a function specific to the test component or substrate comprised in the probe compound, the test component or substrate is metabolised. It was surprisingly found that this enzymatic reaction has two effects.
  • the probe compound allows for the unambiguous detection of the specific enzymatic reaction by flurescence detection. Moreover, the probe compound allows for an immobilisation of the substrate-specific enzyme, which can be advantageously used to isolate this enzyme from a sample.
  • a probe compound of the invention comprising a Cy3 dye
  • the fluorescence dye is quenched, i.e. does no longer emit its characteristic fluorescence signal, if the reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex to form the probe compound of the invention.
  • the dye emits its characteristic fluorescence signal and cannot be used to detect productive enzymatic reactions. Only when a productive enzymatic reaction occurs between an enzyme and the probe compound of the invention, the dye is released and the fluorescence is observed.
  • This behaviour of the probe compound of the invention is the major difference to standard systems such as the labelling of proteins with a dye or DNA with a dye to produce protein arrays or DNA arrays, respectively, because the dye is permanently fluorescent in those cases.
  • AC represents an optional anchoring component, preferably poly A or TA
  • MC represents the N ⁇ ,N ⁇ -bis- (carboxymethyl) -L-lysine cobalt (II) complex
  • TC represents the test component
  • IC represents the fluorescence dye Cy3
  • His-tag represents a histidine moiety as described above
  • L AC - M c and L TC -ic each represent optional linker moieties between the respective components indicated by the subscripts.
  • the L ⁇ c -ic linker moiety comprises a quartenary amine function.
  • the present invention also provides a method for preparing the probe compound.
  • the method for preparing the probe compound of the invention comprises the following steps :
  • a transition metal complex by reacting a suitable salt of a transition metal with a desired ligand molecule, optionally comprising an anchoring component.
  • a suitable salt of a transition metal with a desired ligand molecule, optionally comprising an anchoring component.
  • the appropriate conditions of solvent, pH, temperature and the like can be chosen according to known procedures.
  • the thus-obtained transition metal complex can be further purified by standard procedures, such as, for example, filtration, re-crystallisation, or the like.
  • N ⁇ ,N ⁇ -bis- (carboxymethyl) - L-lysine is reacted with cobalt (II) chloride to form the corresponding complex.
  • an anchoring component may also be incorporated at this stage.
  • the above cobalt (II) complex of the N ⁇ ,N ⁇ -bis- ( carboxymethyl) -L-lysine ligand may be reacted with a suitably activated poly A chain or with 6 , 8-dithioctic acid, or the like.
  • a substrate molecule to be incorporated in the test component is coupled to an indicator component, optionally including a linker moiety.
  • an indicator component optionally including a linker moiety.
  • either one or both of the test component and indicator component is previously transferred into an activated form suitable for coupling, according to standard techniques.
  • the appropriate conditions of solvent, pH, temperature and the like can be chosen according to known procedures.
  • a Cy3 dye available as its Cy3-NHS-ester may be reacted with a 4 -amino-3 -butyric acid linker to allow for linking with the test component.
  • a linker moiety between the test component and the indicator component comprises a quaternary amine function (a quartenary ammonium nitrogen atom) .
  • the thus-obtained reactive component can be further purified by standard procedures, such as, for example, filtration, re-crystallisation, or the like.
  • test component and/or the indicator component is functionalised with a moiety suitable for binding to the transition metal complex, either before or after formation of the reactive component.
  • a moiety suitable for binding to the transition metal complex is especially advantageous for indicator components or test components, which do not readily form coordination bonds.
  • the test component and/or the indicator component is functionalised with a histidine molecule (sometimes referred to as a "His- tag" in the following) .
  • His-tag has the additional advantage to ensure an identical binding property of all possible test components (substrates) and/or indicator components (dyes) to the transition metal complex.
  • the so-prepared reactive component comprising the test component and the indicator component is linked to the transition metal complex to form the probe compound according to the present invention.
  • the appropriate conditions of solvent, pH, temperature and the like can be chosen according to known procedures. If necessary, the thus-obtained probe compound can be further purified by standard procedures, such as, for example, filtration, re-crystallisation, or the like.
  • the method comprises the steps a) , c) and e) , and the optional steps b) and/or d) , if desired.
  • the optional steps b) and d) can be carried out at any stage of the method.
  • step d) may be carried out before step c) , or subsequent to step b)
  • step b) may be carried out before step a) , subsequent to step a) , or subsequent to step e) , respectively.
  • the individual steps are carried out in the order of steps a) , b) , d) , c, and e) .
  • the steps may be carried out in the order of steps b) , a) , c) , d) , and e) , or in the order of steps a) , d) , c) , e) , and b) .
  • a person skilled in the art will know which order and conditions are most suitable for the respective task.
  • the step for linking the indicator component to the test component and/or the step for linking the histidine residue to the test component involves an activation of the test component by specific halogenation with iodine (I) .
  • iodine iodine
  • a selected position (atom or group) of the substrate or metabolite component comprised in the test component is selectively halogenated with iodine. This can be done by standard chemical reactions or enzymatically .
  • the halogenated position allows for substitution reactions replacing the iodine atom by the corresponding component or residue .
  • the present invention also provides an array for detecting enzymes comprising a plurality of different probe compounds according to the invention.
  • the array comprises a plurality of different probe compounds according to the invention (sometimes referred to as library of probe compounds in the following) , i.e. probe compounds according to the invention which differ at least with respect to the test component comprised therein.
  • the probe compounds only differ with respect to the test component comprised therein.
  • a plurality of different probe compounds can be prepared using automatic procedures, for example, parallel synthesis protocols and apparatuses, or the like.
  • the term "comprising a plurality of different probe compounds" means at least two different probe compounds, and may comprise up to several thousands different probe compounds.
  • apparatuses and protocols which are known and commercially available at the moment, allow the standard production of arrays based on glass slides wherein from 5000 to 15000 different probe compounds may be deposited on a single glass slide by micro-spotting techniques, or the like. In a preferred embodiment, about 2500 different probe compounds are included in the array (cf . example) .
  • the array may be constructed using a plate providing separate compartments or wells, such as, for example, a micro- titre plate, which is commercially available with, e.g., 384 wells, or different numbers of wells.
  • a complete array may comprise one or more slides or plates depending on the actual number of probe compounds included in the array, as well as on the density available on the respective medium.
  • an array comprises more than one copy of a library of probe compounds on one or more supports.
  • a library or sub-library of probe compounds may be provided in duplicate or triplicate on one support or slide.
  • the plurality of probe compounds is attached to a planar surface of a suitable support or carrier.
  • a support may be any support used in the art, preferred examples of which are glass surfaces, preferably of glass slides, surfaces of polymeric materials, such as polyacetate surfaces, or the like, or surfaces of cellulose or paper materials, or the like.
  • the probe compounds are provided with a suitable anchoring component.
  • a preferred anchoring component known from the art is a poly A chain or tail, which can be readily attached onto a glass surface or the like following standard protocols using irradiation by UV light.
  • the probe compounds do not necessarily require an anchoring component because they can be held in the respective wells without attachment to the wall .
  • probe compounds are attached to the walls of a well of a well plate. Therefor, all methods known in the art may be used.
  • the array of the invention (which is sometimes referred to as "reactome array”) can be used for the simultaneous detection of reactive interactions between the probe compounds and all analyte molecules (enzymes) from a sample.
  • the array provides a solution to the problem of the identification of metabolites and the enzymes involved in their transformation.
  • the array provides a fast and reliable way to detect all metabolic pathways active in an organism or community, and may be used advantageously for an activity-based, annotation- independent procedure for the global assessment of cellular responses.
  • the invention also provides a method for producing an array according to the invention.
  • An array may be produced using well plates, such as commercially micro-titre plates, wherein each probe compound of the plurality of different probe compounds according to the invention is filled into an individual well, together with appropriate amounts of solvent, cofactors, cations, supplements, or the like, which are known or predicted to be required for the expected enzyme reaction.
  • the filling of the wells may be carried out automatically, e.g. by a suitable robotic apparatus, or the like.
  • the array is preferably produced using different probe compounds, which all comprise the same anchoring component.
  • the different probe compounds having an anchoring component are then arranged onto an appropriate support surface, e.g. the surface of a glass slide, and subsequently bound thereto with the anchoring component .
  • the arranging and binding of the different probe components may be carried out automatically, e.g. using a suitable robotic apparatus, or the like, and following established procedures and protocols.
  • different probe compounds comprising a poly A chain as an anchoring component are spotted onto a glass slide by using a robotic apparatus, and subsequent fixation is achieved by cross- linking the poly A tails according to an established protocol using UV radiation.
  • several other methods for arranging and fixing the different probe molecules onto a suitable support surface are known in the art . Using the method of the invention allows for a versatile, fast and reproducible production of arrays according to the invention.
  • the invention also provides an isolation means comprising a nanoparticle and a probe compound according to the invention.
  • a probe compound is preferably provided with a suitable anchoring component and attached to a nanoparticle.
  • nanoparticle means a particle having a maximum dimension of less than 500 nm, preferably of less than 300 nm, and most preferred of about 100 nm.
  • a minimum dimension is about 10 nm, preferably about 50 nm.
  • a maximum or minimum dimension of a nanoparticle refers to the diameter in the case of a spherical nanoparticle. Examples for suitable nanoparticles are known in the art, as well as methods for producing the same, or anchoring components for linking the probe compound to the same.
  • the probe compound may be linked to any nanoparticle known in the art, preferably a magnetic nanoparticle.
  • a nanoparticle comprises one or more metallic elements, including the transition metal elements.
  • Preferred examples of nanoparticles comprise metallic elements, either pure metallic elements, such as, for example gold nanoparticles, or alloys comprising different metallic elements, or oxides of metallic elements, such as, for example, iron oxides, or the like.
  • Preferred oxidic nanoparticles may comprise silicon, e.g. in form of silicon oxide.
  • preferred nanoparticles may also have a layered structure, e.g.
  • a nanoparticle has a magnetic property.
  • a preferred anchoring component for linking a probe molecule to a magnetic gold nanoparticle is 6 , 8-dithioctic acid or ⁇ -dihydrolipoic acid, respectively, which advantageously may be linked to a transition metal complex comprising the cobalt (II) complex of N ⁇ ,N ⁇ -bis- (carboxymethyl) -L-lysine (ANTA-Co(II)) by forming an amide bond between the carboxylic acid function of the 6 , 8-dithioctic acid and the amine function of the ligand molecule.
  • a transition metal complex comprising the cobalt (II) complex of N ⁇ ,N ⁇ -bis- (carboxymethyl) -L-lysine (ANTA-Co(II)
  • the isolation means according to the invention allows for the substrate specific interaction and binding of an enzyme which can then be isolated by means of filtration, gravitation force (centrifugation) , an external magnetic force in case of a magnetic nanoparticle, or the like. It was found that, owing to the substrate specific binding of an enzyme by the probe compound, the isolation means of the invention allows for the directed isolation of an enzyme because of its substrate specificity.
  • the invention also provides a method for producing a isolation means according to the invention.
  • a probe compound comprising a suitable anchoring component is prepared according to the method of producing a probe compound according to the invention, and subsequently attached to a suitable nanoparticle prepared according to known methods.
  • the probe compound is attached to a magnetic nanoparticle.
  • the method according to the invention provides an easy access to an isolation means having specific binding sites for an enzyme.
  • the invention also provides a method for detecting enzymes in a substrate specific manner, using the probe compound according to the invention or the array according to the invention.
  • An array comprising a plurality of different probe compounds is prepared according to the method of the invention.
  • the array can preferably comprise more than one copy of the respective library of probe compounds, either by providing the library on one support or slide in duplicate or triplicate or in more copies, or by providing more than one support or slide comprising identical sets or libraries of probe compounds.
  • the array is then brought in contact with a sample comprising the analyte molecules, i.e. the enzymes whose substrate specific activity is to be tested. This step is also referred to as incubation with a sample.
  • a sample in the context of the method includes any kind of solution of analyte molecules
  • enzymes that can enter into an enzymatic reaction with the probe compounds on the array.
  • biological samples obtained from the lysis of cells of bacteria, archeae, or higher organisms, but also from biological fluids such as blood, serum, secretions, lymph, dialysate, liquor, sap, body fluid from insects, worms, maggots, etc.
  • extraction from natural sources such as biopsies, animal and plant organs or parts, cell, insect, worm, bacteria, microbe and parasitic matter as well as supernatants of cell cultures and of bacterial, microbial or parasitic cultures.
  • a sample may also be a chemical-synthetic sample containing, for example, synthetic proteins, or the like. After incubation is complete, the sample is removed from the array.
  • the array may be washed one or more times. Then, the array is analysed for the presence of the signal characteristic for the indicator component.
  • a fluorescence signal is read out and processed by a suitable apparatus, which is available in the art. All protocols and procedures known in the art may be used, including automatic processing by robotic apparatuses and the like.
  • the fluorescence signal is preferably measured using a laser scanning system.
  • the method of the invention using the array of the invention allows to assess the complete reactome of an organism or community in one step. That is, all substrate specific enzymatic reactions which are performed within the metabolic pathways necessary for the individual life form(s) is readily accessible. This advantageously allows for the accurate reconstruction of metabolic pathways.
  • the invention also provides a method for isolating enzymes using the isolation means according to the invention.
  • the nanoparticles are used to isolate enzymes which are bound to the isolation means by the probe molecules after the substrate specific enzymatic reaction.
  • the reaction can be carried out under the same conditions as described above for the array of the invention, including all processes and protocols that are known in the art.
  • the isolation means is brought into contact with a sample comprising analyte molecules (enzymes) that can enter into an enzymatic reaction with the probe compounds on the isolation means.
  • the isolation means carrying the enzymes are then isolated by magnetic means or by filtration.
  • the isolated enzymes can then be analysed using standard techniques, such as, for example, sequence analysis, mass spectrometry, or the like.
  • Identification of enzymes whose function is verified by the specific reaction with the probe compound of the invention allows for the detection of metabolic pathways as well as for the correct annotation of unsequenced genes and/or unknown proteins or enzymes.
  • the method can be used to complete the metabolic pathway map of all life forms, as well as specialised parts thereof.
  • the method can also be used to reconstruct the global metabolism of complete communities living in distinct natural (microbial) communities.
  • the method of the invention can be advantageously- used in the search for new drugs, in particular in screening for potential new targets: here the guiding principle is selective toxicity, so the search is for molecular targets in the target organism that do not exist in a human.
  • the method of the invention is also useful for the identification of drugs that are specific for certain pathogens, so that treatment of an infected patient would not result in the elimination of a major part of the body flora, as is currently the case with common broad spectrum antibiotics, and all the negative consequences of this that ensue.
  • Using the array to obtain reactome profiles of the representatives of the major phyla of life allows their comparison and identification of individual reactions/enzymes that are specific for each branch or clusters of branches. Some of these phylum-specific functions will be known already, but others may be new: such metabolic reactions/enzymes may then serve as newly- discovered targets for drug screening.
  • the comparison of the human reactome with the composite reactome of bacteria and archaea may identify new targets for broad spectrum antibiotics, or the comparison of the reactomes of the various bacterial phyla may reveal potential targets specific for individual phyla, such as those to which, e.g., Neissseria, Pseudomonas, Mycobacterium, Vibrio, Staph,
  • Strep, Pneumo, coliforms belong, providing a route to more specific, narrow spectrum antibiotics.
  • the comparison of reactomes of photosynthetic organisms may identify new targets for herbicides specific for, e.g., moss, or algae, or monocots, or dicots etc. that would allow the development of new generation anti-moss treatments that would not affect other plants, anti -algal treatments not active against other plants, etc., etc.
  • the comparison of the reactomes of insect vectors of disease (mosquito, black fly, etc) with those of other insects, humans etc. could identify vector-specific targets.
  • the present invention provides a versatile tool for obtaining information on the reactomes of all major branches of the tree of life which can be advantageously used in future drug development.
  • the selective inhibition of pathogens there become available a lot of applications involving the selective inhibition of specific microbial populations, either because they are known to be problematic, or simply to test experimentally their contribution to a particular process (e.g. the role of a particular GI tract organism in a particular GI physiological role, like folate production, the role of a particular rhizosphere organism in protection from fungal infections, etc.) .
  • the array provides the means of identifying phylum-specific metabolic targets for inhibitors that, in turn, can be used to inhibit specifically those phyla in microbial communities to assess their role in a particular process.
  • the use of the reactome array of the invention for identifying new targets can be applied from human medicine to agriculture to dental medicine to shipping (anti-algal compounds to prevent algal fouling; anti- sulphate reducer compounds to prevent corrosion of steel) to construction (e.g. anti-sulphate reducer compounds to prevent corrosion of steel) , etc., and to research tools (agonists/antagonists for all manner of selected life forms) .
  • the present invention provides a procedure to measure on an array, enzymatic activities of cells against many of the standard substrates and metabolites that characterize life, plus other substrates of interest . Because of the chemical design of the substrates of the array, the array provides the identity of the reaction, the reaction products and, in a subsequent step, the enzyme itself. It therefore links a substrate/metabolite with its cognate enzyme. The reactome array thus forges a thus far missing link between metabolome and genome. Since many of the metabolites on the array are connected in pathways, it is also possible to reconstruct the metabolic network operating in any organism without any prior genomic information.
  • the use of the array to investigate the reactome of a microbial community is particularly interesting.
  • the array represents a new possibility to have a metabolic overview of an entire community, without perturbing it in any way prior to preparation of the community lysate for analysis. And, in cases where it is difficult to obtain sufficient biomass for direct analysis, it is even possible to obtain a small molecule microarray analysis of a metagenomic library of a
  • halogenase/dehalogenase which is a rather small enzyme, may be of interest in the field of energy production.
  • a novel reBr halogenase/dehalogenase i.e. a multifunctional ⁇ / ⁇ - hydrolase, was mined from a metagenome library of a microbial community in seawater contamined with petroleum hydrocarbons, with a novel hydrolytic phenotype, namely the cleavage of both 'common' p-nitrophenyl (pNP) esters and haloalkanoates, and weak activity towards haloalkanes (paper in preparation, SEQ. ID. NOS. 57 to 59) .
  • This halogenase/dehalogenase enzyme was found to be useful for the introduction of iodine into the test component in the syntheses of the probe compounds of the present invention.
  • a physico-chemical analysis of habitats is rather selective in terms of the parameters measured, detection limits defined by the instruments used, and usually does not discriminate between bioavailable and non-bioavailable levels, whereas the array scores most of the metabolic potential of the cell or community in relation to the prevailing conditions and bioavailable fraction of compounds
  • another application of the array is the habitat characterization by metabolic profiling.
  • This type of application can also be used in diagnosis of diseases/intake of drugs/toxic substances that influence metabolic activities of the microbial flora, through reactome analysis of faecal/skin biota, forensic analyses of diverse types (e.g. groundwater pollution), prospecting (e.g. for natural gas seeps that indicate underlying reservoirs) , detection of manufacturing sites of illegal substances, etc.
  • NMR spectra of all compounds were recorded at 600, 500, 400, or 300 MHz, using Varian 1-600, Varian 1-500, Varian M-400, Varian M-300, and Bruker Biospin 300 instruments.
  • 1 H NMR chemical shifts were reported relative to residual CHCl 3 (7.26 ppm) .
  • 13 C NMR data were recorded at 125, 100, or 75 MHz, using Varian 1-500, Varian M-400, or Bruker Biospin 300 MHz instruments, respectively.
  • 13 C NMR chemical shifts are reported relative to the central line of CDCl 3 (77.0 ppm) .
  • polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis under denaturing conditions SDS-PAGE: 10%, v/v
  • SDS-PAGE 10%, v/v
  • a Mini-PROTEAN cell apparatus Bio-Rad
  • protein bands were blotted to a polyvinylidene difluoride (PVDF) membrane.
  • PVDF polyvinylidene difluoride
  • the PVDF membrane was stained with Coomassie Brilliant Blue R-250, after which the bands of the proteins were cut out and processed for N- terminal amino acid sequencing.
  • the peptide sequences were initially scored against blastp nr to identify the best hits among full-length proteins, and then converted into coding sequences and screened for potential protein encoding genes (PEGs) via tblastn and tblastx search (F. Stephen et al . , Nucleic Acids Res 25, 3389 (1997)) against the comprehensive non-redundant database sourced from the nucleotide (nr/nt) collection, reference genomic sequences (refseq_genomic) , whole genome shotgun reads (wgs) and environmental samples
  • Bacterial strains culture, and growth conditions.
  • E. coli DH5F' was used as a recipient for pGEMT plasmid (Promega) constructs containing cloned PCR fragments of P. putida KT2440 encoding hypothetical proteins and metagenomic proteins.
  • E. coli TOPlO Invitrogen was used as a recipient for pCCFOS vector (EPICENTRE) constructs.
  • E. coli cultures were grown in Luria-Bertani (LB) medium and incubated at 37°C on an orbital platform operating at 200 rpm.
  • cultures were supplemented with the following antibiotics: ampicillin (100 ⁇ g/ml) , nalidixic acid (10 ⁇ g/ml) and chloramphenicol (12.5 ⁇ g/ml) .
  • P. putida KT2440 was grown in M9 minimal medium with 15 mM succinate as carbon source in 100-ml flasks shaken at 30 0 C and 150 rpm from an initial turbidity at 600 nm of 0.02 to a final value of 0.7+0.05. Samples (3 ml) were removed, the cells harvested by centrifugation at 4°C, and the cell pellets were washed with 20 mM Hepes pH 7.0 before storing at -20 0 C until use.
  • EXAMPLE 3 EXAMPLE 3 :
  • the general reactome strategy comprises five stages for array construction and protein-SMs transformation detection as follows (cf . Figures 1 to 3) .
  • the resulting derivatives were dissolved at different concentrations from 0.5 to 100 nM (six concentrations) in dimethyl sulfoxide (DMSO) and stored at -70 0 C until use in 384-well microtiter plates. Each well also contained cofactors, cations and supplements known or predicted to be required for efficient transformations.
  • DMSO dimethyl sulfoxide
  • Each well also contained cofactors, cations and supplements known or predicted to be required for efficient transformations.
  • the 2483 SMs included in this study, together with the position of modification with Cy3 are given in Tables 1 and 2. These procedures were also used to synthesize Cy3 -modified X-GaI (obtained from Boehringer Mannheim) , which was used as substrate for the ⁇ -galactosidase of E. coli (provided also by Boehringer Mannheim) .
  • Proteins reacting with specific metabolites were identified by incubating a protein extract with metabolite-coated gold nano-particles, followed by protein sequencing of the captured proteins, reverse translation of the sequences into gene sequences, cloning of the corresponding genes, hyper- expression of the genes, and purification and characterization of the corresponding proteins.
  • the amino-nitrilotriacetic-Co (II) complex was formed by reaction of NR,NR-b ⁇ s (carboxymethyl) -L-lysine hydrate (ANTA, Fluka) with an excess of cobalt (II) chloride (Sigma) in 20 mM HEPES in aqueous solution (36) . Excess cobalt was precipitated by increasing the pH to 10, and the precipitate was removed by filtration through a 0.2 ⁇ m membrane (PTFE, Amicon) .
  • PTFE 0.2 ⁇ m membrane
  • Cyanine dye was linked via a histidine tag and a flexible linker through which the dye is linked to the Co(II) complex and the metabolite, respectively. Briefly, a histidine molecule was firstly incorporated to the Cy3 dye by enzymatic acidolysis of Cy3 NHS (a succinimidyl ester, GE Healthcare) with histidine and immobilized Lewatit lipase ELl (37) from a cow rumen metagenome (37.39 mol% incorporation of histidine in 24 h, at a ratio 1 histidine: 4 NHS ester) .
  • Cy3 NHS a succinimidyl ester, GE Healthcare
  • the Cy3-His was joined to a 4-amino-3- butyric acid linker. Briefly, the linker was dissolved in 0.1 M sodium borate buffer pH 8.5 and Cy3-His dissolved in a small amount of neutral water was added in aliquots until equimolar concentrations were reached. After incubation for 2 hours at room temperature, the labeled product was purified by reverse phase HPLC on a Chemcobond 5C18 ODS column (4.6 x 150 mm) .
  • the primary synthetic challenge involved finding a reaction path from a functionalized core with the highest yield (>26- 90% overall) .
  • the purified metabolites were characterized by NMR and HPLC and were found to be 90% pure,- yields were >20%.
  • a number of standard strategies were employed, and new ones developed for the synthesis of compound libraries synthesized on solid supports or by parallel synthesis using separate reaction vessels.
  • the full spectrum of synthesis methods used in the present study (as well as NMR and high resolution mass spectra) will be available to the community on our web server (http://biology.bangor.ac.uk/people/staff/025123) and are briefly described in Table 1, together with metabolite synthesis strategies.
  • SMs were directly purified from pure cultures using preparative HPLC (Waters 2795 XE) .
  • the purity of each SM was confirmed by NMR and mass determination (see Table 1) .
  • SMs were reconstituted and diluted in PBS buffer, DMSO or a mixture of both, accordingly to their solubility properties, and stored in 384-well microtiter plates at -70 0 C until used.
  • Metabolites were further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag at specific positions (SM-His; see Tables 1 to 3) using solid-solid and solid-liquid phase synthesis.
  • General synthetic methods to incorporate His-tags to different metabolites (SM) are listed in the following.
  • Au-6 , 8-dithioctic acid (TA) clusters were synthesized as described by Abad et al . (Abad et al . in J. Am. Chem. Soc . 127, 5689 (2005)) and used to create Au-TA-ANTA-Co (II) -SMs- Cy3 clusters.
  • the Au-TA clusters were linked to the ANTA-Co (II) -SMs-Cy3 (prepared as described above) by overnight amidation in a single step in the presence of 3 mM N-hydroxysuccinimide (NHS, Fluka) and 3 mM l-ethyl-3- [3 ⁇ - (dimethylamino) propyl] carbodiimide (EDC, Sigma) in 20 mM HEPES buffer (pH 7.5) . Further purification was carried out by ultrafiltration through low-adsorption hydrophilic 30000 NMWL cutoff membranes (regenerated cellulose, Amicon) .
  • NHS N-hydroxysuccinimide
  • EDC 3 mM l-ethyl-3- [3 ⁇ - (dimethylamino) propyl] carbodiimide
  • Synthesis Example 1 provides a complete synthesis of a probe compound comprising 5-bromo-4-chloro-3- indoyl-beta-galactopyranoside (X-GaI) as test component (SM) and Cy3 as indicator component . Both the test component and the indicator component are linked to a transition metal complex comprising cobalt by one histidine linker moiety each. Test component and indicator component are linked by 4 -amino-3 -butyric acid as a linker moiety. The so-prepared probe compound is used for the analysis of the sensitivity of the reactome array.
  • X-GaI 5-bromo-4-chloro-3- indoyl-beta-galactopyranoside
  • Cy3 as indicator component . Both the test component and the indicator component are linked to a transition metal complex comprising cobalt by one histidine linker moiety each. Test component and indicator component are linked by 4 -amino-3 -butyric acid as a linker moiety.
  • nitrilotriacetic-Co (II) complexes The amino-nitrilotriacetic-Co (II) complex was formed by reaction of NR 1 i ⁇ 7R-bis (carboxymethyl) -L-lysine hydrate (ANTA, Fluka) with an excess of cobalt (II) chloride (Sigma) in 20 mM HEPES in aqueous solution (J. M. Abad et al . , J Am Chem Soc 127, 5689 (2005) ) . Excess cobalt was precipitated by increasing the pH to 10, and the precipitate was removed by filtration through a 0.2 ⁇ m membrane (PTFE, Amicon) .
  • PTFE 0.2 ⁇ m membrane
  • Cyanine dye was linked via a histidine tag and a flexible linker through which the dye is linked to the Co(II) complex and the metabolite, respectively.
  • a histidine molecule was firstly incorporated to the Cy3 dye by enzymatic acidolysis of Cy3 NHS (a succinimidyl ester, GE Healthcare) with histidine and immobilized Lewatit lipase ELl (37) from a cow rumen metagenome (37.39 mol% incorporation of histidine in 24 h, at a ratio 1 histidine: 4 NHS ester) .
  • 3-Methyl-2-butanol was used as solvent with a water content of up to 3.2%, and the reaction was carried out at 50-55 0 C.
  • High-performance preparative liquid chromatography was used to analyze and purify the products of the acidolysis reaction.
  • Purified Cy3-His was dissolved in DMSO at a concentration up to 4 M and stored at -70 0 C until use .
  • a histidine molecule was firstly incorporated to the X-GaI by enzymatic esterification of histidine with X-GaI and immobilized Thermomyces lanuginosus lipase ELl (11.2 mol% incorporation of histidine in 24 h, at a ratio 2 histidine : 1 X-GaI) .
  • 3-Methyl-2-butanol was used as solvent with a water content of up to 3.0%, and the reaction was carried out at 45 0 C.
  • High-performance preparative liquid chromatography using nucleosil C18 column using methanol : water as mobile phase was used to analyze and purify the products. Purified X-Gal-His was stored at -20 0 C until use. This method was used to link His molecules to carboxylate containing molecules.
  • the activated Cy3 is reacted with X-Gal-His halide in the presence of a quaternary ammonium salt such as benzyltriethylammonium chloride using 50% aqueous sodium hydroxide as an acid-removing agent (Bull. Chem. Soc . Jpn., 54, 1879 (1981)) .
  • a quaternary ammonium salt such as benzyltriethylammonium chloride
  • 50% aqueous sodium hydroxide as an acid-removing agent
  • the final step in the array development is the incubation of the histidine functionalized Cy3-X-Gal with poly (A) - nitrilotriacetic-Co (II) complexes in 50 mM phosphate buffer, 50 mM NaCl, pH 7.5 for 1 hour at 25 0 C. When required, DMSO was added to increase substrate solubility. The resulting complexes were separated from unbound enzyme molecules by HPLC as described above. To ensure that each SM-Cy3 binds through both of its His residues, 59 NMR was performed, and only derivatives incorporating single SM-Cy3 molecules were purified, and stored in 384 microtiter plates at -70 0 C until used. These molecules were used directly for the construction of the array.
  • the procedure was adapted from J. M. Abad et al . , J Am Chem Soc 127 , 5689 (2005) , where the full synthesis is described.
  • the amino-nitrilotriacetic-Co (II) complex (A) was formed by reaction of NR, iVR-bis (carboxymethyl) -L-lysine hydrate (ANTA, Fluka) (5 g; 19 mmol) with an excess of cobalt (II) chloride (Sigma) (24.7 g; 190 mmol) in 20 mM HEPES in aqueous solution (10 ml total volume) overnight at 25 0 C.
  • a histidine molecule was firstly incorporated to the Cy3 dye by enzymatic transamidolysis of Cy3 NHS (a succinimidyl ester, GE Healthcare) with histidine and immobilized Lewatit lipase ELl (D. Reyes-Duarte et al . , Angew Chem Int Ed Engl 44, 7553 (2005)) from a cow rumen metagenome. All reactions were performed in the dark. Solvents were dried over 3 A molecular sieves for 24 h prior to use.
  • Cy3 NHS 250 mg, 0.344 mmol was dissolved in 5 mL of dimethylsulfoxide (DMSO) and 2-methyl-2-butanol was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL.
  • DMSO dimethylsulfoxide
  • the biocatalyst Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g
  • 3 A molecular sieves 2.5 g were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring.
  • histidine 213 mg; 1.38 mmol was added.
  • the crude product was purified by semipreparative reverse-phase HPLC (Prontosil-AQ, 5 Im, 120 A, 250 • 8 mm column) , and compounds were eluted with acetonitrile (20% -for 5 min, followed by linear gradients to 45% in 5 min, to 50% in 7 min and to 100% in 2 min) in triethylammonium hydrogen carbonate buffer (0.01 M, pH 8.6) at a flow of 3 mL/min. Fractions containing the product (C) (retention time 10.43 min, UV detection at 280 nm and 545 nm) were combined and dried by lyophilisation.
  • the product (C) (101 mg; -37%) was further dissolved in dimethylsulfoxide (DMSO) at a concentration up to 4 M and stored at -70 0 C until use.
  • DMSO dimethylsulfoxide
  • the water solubility of the compound was found to be >0.38 M at room temperature as determined by absorbance .
  • the compound (C) had an extinction coefficient ( ⁇ ) of 130810 1/mol-cm an its ⁇ max 545 nm as determined in 10 mM Tris-HCl at pH 7.4 according to the method of CR. Cantor and I. Tinoco, J " . MoI. Biol. 13, 65 (1965) .
  • Mass spectrometry was used to confirm the structure.
  • HRMS calculated for C 37 O 9 S 2 N 5 H 44 [M + H + ] was 766.2580, found 766.2597. As shown, the result was within of the calculated molecular mass.
  • the 4-amino-3 -butanoate was incorporated to (C) through the sulfonate.
  • Two methods were used. First, sulfonyl chloride his tagged cyanine was firstly prepared from (C) according to J. Sokolowska-Gajda and H. S. Freeman, Dyes and Pigm 14, 35 (1990) . This compound was used for a sulfonamide reaction (R-NH-SO 2 -Cy3) with 4 -amino- 3 -butanoate as described by Z. Wai et al . , The proceeding of the 3rd International Conference on Functional Molecules 167 (2005) .
  • Compound (D) was subjected to direct esterification with N, N-dimethylethanolamine using immobilized Lewatit lipase ELl (D. Reyes-Duarte et al . , Angew Chem Int Ed Engl 44, 7553 (2005)) from a cow rumen metagenome . Briefly, compound (D) (25 mg, 0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of dimethylsulfoxide (DMSO) and 2 -methyl -2 -butanol was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL .
  • DMSO dimethylsulfoxide
  • the biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring. Then, N, N-dimethylethanolamine (25 mg; 0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value (determined by HPLC: 53 mol% in 48 h) , the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2-methyl-2-butanol . The product was recovered by- evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol.
  • the crude product was redisolved in DMSO and further purified by semipreparative reverse-phase HPLC (Prontosil-AQ, 5 Im, 120 A, 250 • 8 mm column equipped with a Prontosil-AQ, 5 Im, 120 A, 33 • 8 mm pre-column, and compounds were eluted with acetonitrile (20% for 5 min, followed by linear gradients to 45% in 5 min, to 50% in 7 min and to 100% in 2 min) in triethylammonium hydrogen carbonate buffer (0.01 M, pH 8.6) at a flow of 3 mL/min.
  • the primary synthetic challenge involved finding a reaction path from a functionalized core with the highest yield (>26- 90% overall) .
  • the purified metabolites were characterized by HPLC and HRMS and were found to be 90% pure; yields were >20%.
  • Table 1 shows a complete description of synthetic and purification methods and commercial suppliers. In case the metabolite was purified from cell extract of an organism, the chromatographic description of the method used for separation and the amount of metabolite per gram of extract are specifically shown.
  • the metabolite array is constituted by thousands of molecules that are modified to link them to a fluorofore (i.e. Cy3 , or possibly any other with similar characteristics) and a histidine molecule.
  • a fluorofore i.e. Cy3 , or possibly any other with similar characteristics
  • the methods include specific halogenation reactions by the action of a promiscuous halogenase, esterification or transesterification or amidation or transamidation reactions by the action of a promiscuous lipase and carbon-carbon bond formation in the presence of the proton sponge 1, 8-bis- (dimethylamino) - napthalene .
  • Figure 8 shows a schematic representation of each of the different general methods used to create the histidine and dye labelled metabolite library synthesis. In this figure a representative metabolite is shown.
  • DMSO dimethylsulfoxide
  • 2M2B (2-methyl-2-butanol)
  • 1,8-BDN (1,8-bis- (dimethylamino) -naphthalene)
  • CH 3 CN acetonitrile
  • ⁇ -KG ⁇ -ketoglutarate
  • HPLC high pressure liquid chromatography
  • ELl-Lewatit immobilized Lewatit lipase ELl from a cow rumen metagenome
  • I-metabolite Iodine containing metabolite
  • E Cy3 intermediate containing histidine and linkers
  • ELl Protein-engineered lipase isolated from cow rumen metagenome ⁇ Angewandte Chemie International Edition (2005) 44: 7553-7557
  • Dehalogenase multifunctional ⁇ / ⁇ - hydrolase mined from a metagenome library of a microbial community in seawater contaminated with petroleum hydrocarbons, with a novel hydrolytic phenotype, namely the cleavage of both ⁇ common' p-nitrophenyl (pNP) esters and haloalkanoates, and weak activity towards haloalkanes (Table 5; SEQ ID Nos .
  • Halogenase this enzyme corresponds to the same dehalogenase described above but it is able to perform halogenation reactions in organic media. The promiscuity of the enzyme can be also seen in the capacity to perform two different reactions. In the presence of the cofactor ⁇ -ketoglutarate the enzyme is able to activate non-activated alkyl groups and in the presence of NADH is able to halogenate activate molecules containing alkenyl groups .
  • Step 3 Formation of Cy3 -labeled metabolite.
  • the corresponding labeled quaternary ammonium metabolite were obtained in the presence of 1,8 -BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . (loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti, R. M. Lemmon, J " Org Chem 22, 228 (1957) with small modifications.
  • the ( general method for the synthesis of quaternary amines is as follows. Reaction mixture (2 ml) contains histidine tagged I-metabolite (0.078 mmol) , 0.78 mmol of (E) and 1,8- BDN at a final concentration of 100 mM in DMSO. The temperature was controlled at 32 0 C.
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 1 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9, wherein Hys and Cy3 are linked to two different sp3 carbon atoms of an alkyl group.
  • the iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via ⁇ -KG.
  • the halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 ⁇ M) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM ⁇ -KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml.
  • phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM ⁇ -KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml.
  • the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi preparative HPLC.
  • I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 0 C until used at a concentration of 10 ⁇ g/ml .
  • HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated two "I" per molecule.
  • I-metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. The incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8-BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . ⁇ loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications.
  • Synthetic method 2 this method is designed to perform direct halogenation to two sp2 carbon atoms (e.g. a carbon atom of an aromatic carbon bond or a carbon atom of an unsaturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. terminal, or within a chain or ring) and further incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) and Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component to those groups - i.e. both components to two different sp2 carbon atoms .
  • two sp2 carbon atoms e.g. a carbon atom of an aromatic carbon bond or a carbon atom of an unsaturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. terminal, or within a chain or ring
  • His black arrow in Figure 9
  • Cy3 grey arrow in Figure 9
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 7 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9, wherein His and Cy3 are linked to two differnt sp2 carbon atoms of an aryl group .
  • I-metabolite The iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via I " as follows.
  • Synthetic method 3 this method is designed to perform direct halogenation to both a sp3 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring) and a sp2 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of an aromatic carbon bond or a carbon atom of an unsaturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. terminal, or within a chain or ring) in the same metablite and further incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) and Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component to those groups - i.e.
  • a sp3 carbon atom e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring
  • a sp2 carbon atom
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr . 8 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9, wherein one of His and Cy3 is linked to a sp3 carbon atom of an methyl group, while the other is linked to an aryl carbon atom.
  • I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 0 C until used at a concentration of 10 ⁇ g/ml .
  • HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule.
  • a second iodide was incorporated via ⁇ -KG.
  • the halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 ⁇ M) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM ⁇ -KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml.
  • histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8-BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et. al . Hoc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon ⁇ loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, to a solution of I-metabolite (concentration range from 0.1 to 2.3 mmol) , histidine (concentration range from 0.44 to 1 mmol), and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 10 mM were added were added, in CH 3 CN (10 ml final volume) . The temperature was controlled at 32 0 C. After incubation (range from 11.52 to 424 min) the product was recovered by evaporating the CH 3 CN. The corresponding product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure.
  • Synthetic method 4 this method is designed to perform direct halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring) to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) through esterification with an OH group of the metabolite - i.e. one component to a sp3 carbon atom and one component to an OH group .
  • a sp3 carbon atom e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring
  • Cy3 grey arrow in Figure 9
  • His black arrow in Figure 9
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 36 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
  • I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -7O 0 C until used at a concentration of 10 ⁇ g/ml .
  • HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule.
  • I -metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. A histidine molecule was incorporated by enzymatic esterification of the previous intermediate and ELl-Lewatit. Solvents were dried over 3 A molecular sieves for 24 h prior to use. Briefly, metabolite (0.344 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL.
  • the biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring. Then, histidine (1.38 mmol) was added. When the conversion to the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol and the crude product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. Fractions containing the product were combined and dried by lyophilisation. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 0 C until used at a concentration of 10 ⁇ g/ml.
  • Synthetic method 5 this method is designed to perform direct esterification through an -OH group and further halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring) to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and His (black arrow in Figure 9) - i.e. both components to two different OH groups.
  • a sp3 carbon atom e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 132 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
  • I-metabolite The metabolite was subjected to transesterification with vinyl acetate using ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring. Then, vinyl acetate (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B.
  • the product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol.
  • the crude product was further purified by semi-preparative HPLC.
  • the product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via ⁇ -KG.
  • the halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 ttiM) , and halogenase (32 ⁇ M) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM ⁇ -KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml.
  • reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC.
  • I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 0 C until used at a concentration of 10 ⁇ g/ml .
  • Synthetic method 6 this method is designed to perform direct halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring) to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) through an NH 2 group of the metabolite - i.e. one component to a sp3 carbon atom and one component to an NH 2 group .
  • a sp3 carbon atom e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring
  • Cy3 grey arrow in Figure 9
  • His black arrow in Figure 9
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite
  • I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 0 C until used at a concentration of 10 ⁇ g/ml .
  • HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule.
  • I -metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. A histidine molecule was incorporated by enzymatic amidation of the previous intermediate and ELl-Lewatit. Solvents were dried over 3 A molecular sieves for 24 h prior to use. Briefly, metabolite (0.344 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL .
  • the biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring. Then, histidine (1.38 mmol) was added. When the conversion to the corresponding amide reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 0 C until used at a concentration of 10 ⁇ g/ml.
  • Synthetic method 7 this method is designed to perform direct esterification through an -OH group and further halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) through an NH 2 group of the metabolite - i.e. one component to an NH 2 group and one component to an OH group .
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 196 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
  • I-metabolite Formation of I-metabolite .
  • the metabolite was subjected to transesterification with vinyl acetate using ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring. Then, vinyl acetate (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B.
  • the product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol.
  • the crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC.
  • the product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via ⁇ -KG.
  • the halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 ⁇ M) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM ⁇ -KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml.
  • reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi-preparative HPLC.
  • I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 0 C until used at a concentration of 10 ⁇ g/ml . 2. Incorporation of histidine. I-metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. A histidine molecule was incorporated by enzymatic amidation of the previous intermediate and ELl-Lewatit. Solvents were dried over 3 A molecular sieves for 24 h prior to use.
  • metabolite (0.344 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL .
  • the biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring.
  • histidine (1.38 mmol) was added.
  • the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B.
  • the crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 0 C until used at a concentration of 10 ⁇ g/ml .
  • Synthetic method 8 this method is designed to perform partial dehalogenation in (fully) halogenated aliphatic compounds, followed by halogenation (iodization) to two different sp3 carbon atoms (e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring) and further incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) and Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component to those sp3 carbon atoms - i.e. both components to two different sp3 carbon atoms after a three-step dehalogenation, esterification and halogenation.
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 1692 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
  • I-metabolite Formation of I-metabolite .
  • the iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via ⁇ -KG prior selective dehalogenation. First, the metabolite (100 ⁇ l of a 100 mM solution in MeOH) was added to 900 ⁇ l in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) and dehalogenase (32 ⁇ M) . Reaction was allowed to proceed at 40 0 C for 5 hours. Then the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product (mixture of partial dehalogenated products) was concentrated by liophilization.
  • the purified intermediate ( 95% pure) was used for a subsequent iodization reaction as follows.
  • the metabolite was subjected to transesterification with vinyl acetate using ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring. Then, vinyl acetate (0.29 mmol) was added.
  • the halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 ⁇ M) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM ⁇ -KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml.
  • Synthetic method 9 this method is designed to perform direct halogenation to a sp2 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of an aromatic carbon bond or a carbon atom of an unsaturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. terminal, or within a chain or ring) and further incorporation of Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component to this group and incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) through an NH 2 group of the metabolite .
  • a sp2 carbon atom e.g. a carbon atom of an aromatic carbon bond or a carbon atom of an unsaturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. terminal, or within a chain or ring
  • Cy3 grey arrow in Figure 9
  • His black arrow in Figure 9
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr . 306 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
  • I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 0 C until used at a concentration of 10 ⁇ g/ml .
  • HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule after purification.
  • I -metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. A histidine molecule was incorporated by enzymatic amidation of the previous intermediate and ELl-Lewatit. Solvents were dried over 3 A molecular sieves for 24 h prior to use. Briefly, metabolite (0.344 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL.
  • the biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring. Then, histidine (1.38 mmol) was added. When the conversion to the corresponding amide reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol and the crude product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. Fractions containing the product were combined and dried by lyophilisation. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70°C until used at a concentration of 10 ⁇ g/ml .
  • Synthetic method 10 this method is designed to perform direct esterification through a -COOH group and further halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) through halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring) .
  • a sp3 carbon atom e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 327 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
  • I-metabolite Formation of I-metabolite .
  • the metabolite was subjected to direct esterification with ethanol using ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring. Then, ethanol (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B.
  • the product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol.
  • the crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC.
  • the product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via ⁇ -KG.
  • the halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 ⁇ M) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM ⁇ -KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml.
  • reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi- preparative HPLC.
  • I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 0 C until used at a concentration of
  • I -metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag.
  • the incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8 -BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . (loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, to a solution of I-metabolite (concentration range from 0.1 to 2.3 mmol) , histidine (concentration range from 0.44 to 1 mmol), and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 10 mM were added, in CH 3 CN (10 ml final volume) .
  • the temperature was controlled at 32 0 C. After incubation (range from 11.52 to 424 min) the product was recovered by evaporating the CH 3 CN. The corresponding product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure.
  • Synthetic method 11 this method is designed to perform direct esterification through a -COOH group and further halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) through an- -OH group of the metabolite.
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr . shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
  • I-metabolite Formation of I-metabolite .
  • the metabolite was subjected to direct esterification with ethanol using ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL . The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring. Then, ethanol (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B.
  • the product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol.
  • the crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC.
  • the product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via ⁇ -KG.
  • the halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 rtiM) , and halogenase (32 ⁇ M) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM ⁇ -KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml.
  • Synthetic method 12 this method is designed to perform direct esterification through two -COOH groups and further halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link them to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) and His (black arrow in Figure 9) components .
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 397 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
  • I-metabolite The metabolite was subjected to direct esterification with ethanol using ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring. Then, ethanol (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B.
  • the product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol.
  • the crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC.
  • the product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via ⁇ -KG.
  • the halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 ⁇ M) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM ⁇ -KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml.
  • Synthetic method 13 this method is designed to perform direct halogenation to a sp2 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of an aromatic carbon bond or a carbon atom of an unsaturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. terminal, or within a chain or ring) and further incorporation of Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and direct amidation through a -COOH group to incorporate the His (black arrow in Figure 9) component .
  • a sp2 carbon atom e.g. a carbon atom of an aromatic carbon bond or a carbon atom of an unsaturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. terminal, or within a chain or ring
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 398 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
  • the biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring. Then, histidine (1.38 mmol) was added. When the conversion to the corresponding amide reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol and the crude product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. Fractions containing the product were combined and dried by lyophilisation. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 0 C until used at a concentration of 10 ⁇ g/ml .
  • Synthetic method 14 this method is designed to perform direct esterification through a -COOH group and further halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) and direct amidation through a NH 2 group to incorporate the His (black arrow in Figure 9) component.
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr . 860 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
  • I-metabolite The metabolite was subjected to direct esterification with ethanol using ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring. Then, ethanol (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B.
  • the product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol.
  • the crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC.
  • the product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via ⁇ -KG.
  • the halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 ⁇ M) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM ⁇ -KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml.
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 543 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
  • I-metabolite Formation of I-metabolite .
  • the metabolite was subjected to transesterification with vinyl acetate using ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL . The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring. Then, vinyl acetate (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B.
  • the product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol.
  • the crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC.
  • the product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via ⁇ -KG.
  • the halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 ⁇ M) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM ⁇ -KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml.
  • Synthetic method 16 this method is designed to perform direct transesterification through a -OH group and further halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) through a -COOH group of the metabolite.
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 1179 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9. 1.
  • Formation of I-metabolite The metabolite was subjected to direct transesterification with vinyl acetate using ELl- Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring.
  • the halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 ⁇ M) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM ⁇ -KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 37 0 C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 0 C until used at a concentration of 10 ⁇ g/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule.
  • metabolite (0.344 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL.
  • the biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring.
  • histidine (1.38 mmol) was added.
  • the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B.
  • the product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol and the crude product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. Fractions containing the product were combined and dried by lyophilisation.
  • I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 0 C until used at a concentration of 10 ⁇ g/ml .
  • Synthetic method 17 this method is designed to perform direct esterification through one -OH group and further halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) and and His (black arrow in Figure 9) components .
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr . 1212 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
  • ELl-Lewatit Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring. Then, vinyl propionate (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol.
  • the crude product was further purified by semi- preparative HPLC.
  • the product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via ⁇ -KG.
  • the halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 ⁇ M) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM ⁇ -KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml.
  • the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC.
  • I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 °C until used at a concentration of 10 ⁇ g/ml .
  • HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated two "I" per molecule.
  • I-metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. The incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8 -BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . Hoc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications.
  • Synthetic method 18 this method is designed to perform direct halogenation to one sp3 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring) and further incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) and Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) components to this moiety
  • one sp3 carbon atom e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 417 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
  • I-metabolite I The iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via ⁇ -KG.
  • the halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 ⁇ M) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM ⁇ -KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 37°C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC.
  • I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 0 C until used at a concentration of 10 ⁇ g/ml .
  • HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule.
  • the corresponding metabolite was used to incorporate an ethyl group throught the reaction with ethyl amine in the presence of 1,8-BDN as described by R.A. Kaufman et al . (loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications.
  • reaction mixture (2 ml) contains I- metabolite I (0.078 mmol) , 0.78 mmol of ethyl amine and 1,8- BDN at a final concentration of 100 mM in DMSO (10 ml final volume) .
  • the temperature was controlled at 32 0 C.
  • the product was recovered by evaporating the CH 3 CN.
  • the labeled product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure.
  • I-metabolite II The iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via ⁇ -KG.
  • the halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 rtiM) , and halogenase (32 ⁇ M) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM ⁇ -KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml.
  • the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC.
  • I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 0 C until used at a concentration of 10 ⁇ g/ml .
  • HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated two "I" per molecule.
  • I-metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag.
  • the incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8-BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman and et al . (loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, to a solution of I-metabolite (concentration range from 0.1 to 2.3 mmol), histidine (concentration range from 0.44 to 1 mmol) , and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 10 mM were added, in CH 3 CN (10 ml final volume) .
  • Synthetic method 19 this method is designed to perform direct esterification through a -COOH group and further halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) and direct halogenation to a sp2 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of an aromatic carbon bond or a carbon atom of an unsaturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. terminal, or within a chain or ring) and further incorporation of His (grey arrow in Figure 9) component
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr . 1332 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
  • I-metabolite The metabolite was subjected to direct esterification with ethanol using ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL . The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring. Then, ethanol (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B.
  • the product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol.
  • the crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC.
  • the product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via ⁇ -KG.
  • the halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 ⁇ M) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM ⁇ -KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml.
  • reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi- preparative HPLC.
  • I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 0 C until used at a concentration of
  • I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 °C until used at a concentration of 10 ⁇ g/ml.
  • HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated two "I" per molecule after the two-step process.
  • I-metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag.
  • the incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8-BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . (loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, to a solution of I-metabolite (concentration range from 0.1 to 2.3 mmol) , histidine (concentration range from 0.44 to 1 mmol), and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 10 mM were added, in CH 3 CN (10 ml final volume) .
  • Synthetic method 20 this method is designed to perform direct halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring) and further incorporation of Cy3 (grey arrow in
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 1790 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
  • I-metabolite Formation of I-metabolite .
  • the iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via ⁇ -KG.
  • the halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 ⁇ M) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM ⁇ -KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml.
  • the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC.
  • I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 0 C until used at a concentration of 10 ⁇ g/ml .
  • HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule.
  • metabolite (0.344 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL.
  • the biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring.
  • histidine (1.38 mmol) was added.
  • the conversion to the corresponding amide reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B.
  • the product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol and the crude product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. Fractions containing the product were combined and dried by lyophilisation. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 0 C until used at a concentration of
  • Synthetic method 21 this method is designed to perform direct esterification through a -COOH group and further halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) and His (grey arrow in Figure 9) components .
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr . 1409 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
  • I-metabolite The metabolite was subjected to direct esterification with ethanol using ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL . The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring. Then, ethanol (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B.
  • the product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol.
  • the crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC.
  • the product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via ⁇ -KG.
  • the halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 ⁇ M) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM ⁇ -KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml.
  • Synthetic method 22 this method is designed to perform direct halogenation to one sp2 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of an aromatic carbon bond or a carbon atom of an unsaturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. terminal, or within a chain or ring) and further incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) and Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) components to this moiety.
  • one sp2 carbon atom e.g. a carbon atom of an aromatic carbon bond or a carbon atom of an unsaturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. terminal, or within a chain or ring
  • His black arrow in Figure 9
  • Cy3 grey arrow in Figure 9
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 1614 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
  • I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 °C until used at a concentration of 10 ⁇ g/ml .
  • HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule.
  • the corresponding metabolite was used to incorporate an ethyl group throught the reaction with ethyl amine in the presence of 1,8 -BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . (loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications.
  • reaction mixture (2 ml) contains I-metabolite (0.078 mmol) , 0.78 mmol of ethyl amine and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 100 mM in DMSO (10 ml final volume) .
  • the temperature was controlled at 32 0 C.
  • the product was recovered by evaporating the CH 3 CN.
  • the labeled product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC.
  • the purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure. 1-3.
  • Formation of I-metabolite II The iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via ⁇ -KG.
  • the halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 ⁇ M) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus
  • histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8-BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . ⁇ loc . cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon ⁇ loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, to a solution of I -metabolite (concentration range from 0.1 to 2.3 mmol), histidine (concentration range from 0.44 to 1 mmol) , and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 10 mM were added, in CH 3 CN (10 ml final volume) . The temperature was controlled at 32 0 C.
  • Synthetic method 23 this method is designed to perform direct halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring) and further incorporation of Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and direct amidation through a -COOH group to link it to His (grey arrow in Figure 9) component.
  • a sp3 carbon atom e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr . 394 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
  • I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 0 C until used at a concentration of 10 ⁇ g/ml .
  • HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule.
  • I -metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. A histidine molecule was incorporated by enzymatic amidation of the previous intermediate and ELl-Lewatit. Solvents were dried over 3 A molecular sieves for 24 h prior to use. Briefly, metabolite (0.344 mmol) was dissolved in 5 rriL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL.
  • the biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring. Then, histidine (1.38 mmol) was added. When the conversion to the corresponding amide reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol and the crude product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. Fractions containing the product were combined and dried by lyophilisation. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 °C until used at a concentration of 10 ⁇ g/ml.
  • Synthetic method 24 this method is designed to perform partial dehalogenation in an halogenated compound, followed by halogenation (iodization) to an alkyl group and further incorporation of Cy3 (grey arrow) component to this alkyl group and direct esterification through one -OH group to link it to His (black arrow) component.
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 1997 shown in Table 1 and Figure 9.
  • I-metabolite Formation of I-metabolite.
  • the iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via ⁇ -KG prior selective dehalogenation. First, the metabolite (100 ⁇ l of a 10 mM solution in MeOH final concentration of 1 mM) was added to 900 ⁇ l in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) and dehalogenase (32 ⁇ M) . Reaction was allowed to proceed at 40 0 C for 5 hours. Then the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product (mixture of partial dehalogenated products) was concentrated by liophilization.
  • phosphate buffer 20 mM, pH 7.8
  • dehalogenase 32 ⁇ M
  • the purified intermediate ( 95% pure) was used for a subsequent iodization reaction as follows.
  • the metabolite was subjected to transesterification with vinyl acetate using ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring. Then, vinyl acetate (0.29 mmol) was added.
  • the halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 ⁇ M) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus
  • I-metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag.
  • the incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8 -BDN as described by R.A. Kaufman et al . ⁇ loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, to a solution of I-metabolite (concentration range from 0.1 to 2.3 mmol) , histidine (concentration range from 0.44 to 1 mmol), and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 10 mM were added were added, in CH 3 CN (10 ml final volume) .
  • the temperature was controlled at 32 0 C. After incubation (range from 11.52 to 424 min) the product was recovered by evaporating the CH 3 CN. The corresponding product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure.
  • Synthetic method 25 this method is designed to perform direct transamidation through one -NH 2 group and further halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) and and His (black arrow in Figure 9) components .
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 1481 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
  • I-metabolite The metabolite was subjected to direct transamidation with vinyl propionate using ELl- Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring. Then, acetate (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding amide reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B.
  • the product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol.
  • the crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC.
  • the product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via ⁇ -KG.
  • the halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 ⁇ M) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM ⁇ -KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml.
  • I -metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag.
  • the incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8 -BDN as described by R.A. Kaufman et al . (loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, to a solution of I-metabolite (concentration range from 0.1 to 2.3 mmol) , histidine (concentration range from 0.44 to 1 mmol) , and 1,8 -BDN at a final concentration of 10 mM were added, in CH 3 CN (10 ml final volume) .
  • the temperature was controlled at 32 0 C. After incubation (range from 11.52 to 424 min) the product was recovered by evaporating the CH 3 CN. The corresponding product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure.
  • Synthetic method 26 this method is designed to perform partial dehalogenation in an halogenated unsaturated compound, followed by halogenation (iodization) to a sp3 carbon atom and further incorporation of Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component to this sp3 carbon atom and direct halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom and further incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) component to this sp3 carbon atom.
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 242 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
  • I-metabolite Formation of I-metabolite .
  • the iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via ⁇ -KG prior selective dehalogenation. First, the metabolite (100 ⁇ l of a 10 mM solution in MeOH final concentration of 1 mM) was added to 900 ⁇ l in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) and dehalogenase (32 ⁇ M) . Reaction was allowed to proceed at 40 °C for 5 hours. Then the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product (mixture of partial dehalogenated products) was concentrated by liophilization.
  • phosphate buffer 20 mM, pH 7.8
  • dehalogenase 32 ⁇ M
  • the purified intermediate ( 95% pure) was used for a subsequent iodization reaction as follows.
  • the metabolite was subjected to transesterification with vinyl acetate using ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 0 C with magnetic stirring. Then, vinyl acetate (0.29 mmol) was added.
  • the halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 ⁇ M) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM ⁇ -KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml.
  • I-metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag.
  • the incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8-BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . (loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, to a solution of I-metabolite (concentration range from 0.1 to 2.3 mmol) , histidine (concentration range from 0.44 to 1 mmol) , and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 10 mM were added, in CH 3 CN (10 ml final volume) .
  • the temperature was controlled at 32 0 C. After incubation (range from 11.52 to 424 min) the product was recovered by evaporating the CH 3 CN. The corresponding product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure.
  • Synthetic method 27 for labelling DNA 1 (5-GAC GCT GCC GAA TTC TGG CTT GCT AGG ACA TCT TTG CCC ACG TTG ACC C- 3) :
  • the substrate contain a mixture of labelled metabolites at different position of the DNA substrate (see attached figure) . Only when an endonuclease cut close to the base where the Cy3 and His are close, the Cy3 is released.
  • the synthetic method includes a direct halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) through an NH 2 group of the metabolite.
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the DNA nucleotide shown in Figure 9.
  • I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 0 C until used at a concentration of 1.5 nmol/ml.
  • HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule per base.
  • I -metabolite obtained is a complex mixture of halogenated molecules in which G, C, A and T bases are halogenated. 2.
  • Incorporation of histidine I -metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. A histidine molecule was incorporated by enzymatic amidation of the previous intermediate and ELl-Lewatit. Solvents were dried over 3 A molecular sieves for 24 h prior to use. Briefly, metabolite (21.8 nmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of
  • histidine linking is mainly performed at the G, C and A bases due to the presence of an amine group through which the histidine is incorporated.
  • I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 0 C until used at a concentration of l.lnmol/ml.
  • the synthetic method When attached to thyamine (T) the synthetic method includes a direct halogenation to sp3 carbon atoms and further incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) and Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component to those sp3 carbon atoms.
  • Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the DNA nucleotide shown in Figure 9.
  • I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 0 C until used at a concentration of 1.5 nmol/ml.
  • HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I” per molecule per G, T and A while incorporated two "I” per thymine (T) .
  • I -metabolite obtained is a complex mixture of halogenated molecules in which G, C, A and T bases are halogenated.
  • I-metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag.
  • the incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8-BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . (loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon ⁇ loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, to a solution of I-metabolite (1.3 nmol), histidine (6.8 nmol), and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 1 ⁇ M were added, in CH 3 CN (1 ml final volume) . The temperature was controlled at 32 0 C.
  • the product was recovered by evaporating the CH 3 CN.
  • the corresponding products were purified by semi -preparative HPLC. Using this method a heterogeneous mixture of products is formed: histidine tags can be incorporated to G, A and C through one position of the the ribose ring or to the two positions of T (one to the ribose and one to the base) . Therefore, the product should be extensively purified by semi -preparative HPLC, to obtain the desired product, namely, that containing the His tag in the pyrimidine ring of thymine (T) .
  • T thymine
  • Synthetic method 28 for labelling DNA 1 3 (5- TGG TCA TCA GGG CTT TAC CTC CCG GAC AAT CCG GAG CTT ACG GAG TAC CTG TAG
  • AGC TTC CTG TGC AAG C- 3 direct halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) through an NH 2 group of the metabolite. Only when an endonuclease cut close to the base where the Cy3 and His are close, the Cy3 is released.
  • the synthetic method includes a direct halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) through an NH 2 group of the metabolite.
  • the synthetic method When attached to thyamine (T) the synthetic method includes a direct halogenation to sp3 carbon atoms and further incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) and Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component to those sp3 carbon atoms.
  • Synthetic method 29 for labelling labelling lambda DNA digested with Sau3AI direct halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) through an NH 2 group of the metabolite (in the G base at the 5'- moiety) .
  • DNA substrate is prepared as follows:
  • I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 °C until used at a concentration of 1.5 nmol/ml.
  • HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I” per molecule per G, T and A while incorporated two "I” per thymine (T) .
  • I -metabolite obtained is a complex mixture of halogenated molecules in which G, C, A and T bases are halogenated.
  • Steps 2 is similar to those described in synthesis 27.
  • Synthetic method 30 for labelling labelling a protein substrate rhodonase: the protein is partially unfolded and then a direct halogenation is performed to the valine, leucine and isoleucine amino acids to link them to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) and His (black arrow in Figure 9) components .
  • Partially unfolded rhodonase was prepared and purified as described elsewhere (Ferrer et al . , MoI. Microbiol . 53, 167- 182 (2005) .
  • the iodide halogenation of protein substrate was performed via ⁇ -KG at the N-terminal position.
  • the halogenase used in this study showed a catalytic core which was accessible to the linearized protein, namely at its N-terminal position.
  • the halogenation reaction contained the protein (1.0 nmol) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (108 ⁇ M) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM ⁇ -KG, in a final volume of 0.5 ml.
  • reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the non-enzymatic reaction components, and the product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC using a Bio- SiI SEC 400 column (Bio-Rad) pre-equilibrated with phosphate buffer. Separation was performed at room temperature at a flow rate of 1 ml min "" ⁇ . The following standards were used to calibrate the gel filtration column and to ensure than the protein substrate and the halogenase proteins are perfectly separated from the reaction mixture: E .
  • Iodide protein was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag.
  • the incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8 -BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . ⁇ loc . cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, to a solution of halogenated protein (1.2 pmol) , histidine (4.2 ⁇ mol) , and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 10 mM were added, in CH 3 CN (10 ml final volume) . The temperature was controlled at 32 0 C.
  • any of the following HPLC purification methods can be used.
  • Prontosil-AQ 5 Im, 120 A, 250 • 8 mm column equipped with a Prontosil-AQ, 5 Im, 120 A, 33 • 8 mm pre- column, and compounds were eluted with acetonitrile (20% for 5 min, followed by linear gradients to 45% in 5 min, to 50% in 7 min and to 100% in 2 min) in triethylammonium hydrogen carbonate buffer (0.01 M, pH 8.6) at a flow of 0.4 to 3 mL/min.
  • Method 3 (standard for medium polar esters) Analytic : using a ternary pump (model 9012, Varian) coupled to a thermostatized (25 0 C) autosampler (model L-2200, VWR International) . The temperature of the column was kept constant at 45 0 C. Detection was performed using a photodiode array detector (ProStar, Varian) in series with an evaporative light scattering detector (ELSD, model
  • the column was a Lichrospher 100 RP8 (4.6 x 125 mm, 5 ⁇ m, Analisis Vinicos) , and the mobile phase was 70:30 (v/v) H 2 0/methanol (H 2 O contained 0.1% of acetic acid) at 1 mL/min for 5 min. Then, a gradient from this mobile phase to 50:50 (v/v) H 2 0/methanol was performed in 5 min, and this eluent was maintained during 15 min.
  • the column was Mediterranea-C18 (4.6 x 150 mm, 5 ⁇ m, Teknokroma, Spain) .
  • the mobile phase was 90:10 (v/v) methanol/H 2 0 (H 2 O contained 0.1% of formic acid) at 1.5 mL/min.
  • Semi -preparative 1 using a system equipped with a Waters Delta 600 pump, a Nucleosil 100-C18 column (250mmxl0 mm) (Sugelabor, Spain) coupled to a precolumn (50mmxl0 mm) packed with the same stationary phase.
  • a differential refractometer (Varian, model 9040) set to 35 0 C and a fraction collector (Waters) were used. Water was the mobile phase (2.4 ml min x ) , and the column temperature was kept constant at 40 0 C.
  • Method 5 (standard for short length esters) Analytic: The pump (Spectra-Physics Inc., Model SP 8810) was coupled to a Nucleosil 100-C18 column (250mmx4.6 mm) (Sugelabor, Spain) . The mobile phase was 80% MeOH: 20% H 2 O at 0.5 ml min 1 . The column was kept constant at 40 0 C. A differential refractometer (Waters, model 2410) was used and set to a constant temperature of 45 0 C.
  • Analytic 1 on a Nucleosil 100-C18 column (250 x 4.6 mm) using isocratic program of 88% A and 12% B in 30 min at a flow rate of 0.3 ml/min.
  • Mobile phase A consisted of 0.1% formic acid while mobile phase B consisted of 0.1% formic acid in a 95:5 acetonitrile/water solution.
  • Diode array detector (DAD) was set at 290 nm.
  • Analytic 1 on a SC125/Lichrospher column (250 x 4.6 mm) .
  • the mobile phase was 0.01% (vol/vol) H 3 PO 4 (87%) and 50% (vol/vol) methanol at 1.0 ml min x .
  • the column was kept constant at 40 0 C.
  • a differential refTactometer Waters, model 2410) was used and set to a constant temperature of 35 0C.
  • Au-6 , 8-dithioctic acid (TA) clusters were synthesized as described by Abad et al . , J Am Chem Soc 127, 5689 (2005) and used to create Au-TA-ANTA-Co (II) -metabolite-Cy3 clusters.
  • the Au-TA clusters were linked to (H) by overnight amidation in a single step in the presence of 3 mM N- hydroxysuccinimide (NHS, Fluka) and 3 mM l-ethyl-3- [3 ⁇ -
  • Step (1) to (5) are described above. Step 6.
  • 5-Bromo-4-chloro-3 -indolyl ⁇ -D-galactopyranoside was provided by Roche Diagnostics (IN, USA) (ref. 10651745001) , further reconstituted and diluted in DMSO, and stored at - 70 0 C until used at a concentration of 100 mg/ml .
  • Step 7 Formation of iodide X-GaI, further incorporation of histidine to iodide-X-Gal and formation of Cy3-labeled X-GaI
  • the iodide halogenation of X-GaI was performed via I " as follows.
  • the reaction mixture was incubated at 37°C with X- GaI (0.080 mmol; 32.69 mg dissolved in 0.1 ml DMSO) , KI (75 mM) , 2 mM NADH, and REBr dehalogenase (4 mg/ml, 100 ⁇ L) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) at a final volume of 0.5 ml.
  • the final volume of DMSO was keep at 20% v/v in order to maintain the solubility of the X-GaI.
  • the purified iodide X-GaI was found to be 95% pure (13.8 g, 26% yield; white solid crystalline powder) .
  • Iodide X-GaI was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 0 C until used at a concentration of 10 mg/ml.
  • HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated two "I" per molecule.
  • Reaction scheme Reaction scheme:
  • Iodide X-GaI was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag.
  • the incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1 , 8-bis- (dimethylamino) -napthalene (Sigma) as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . ⁇ loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon ⁇ loc. cit.) with small modifications.
  • the corresponding product was purified by semipreparative reverse-phase HPLC (Prontosil-AQ, 5 Im, 120 A, 250 • 8 mm column equipped with a Prontosil-AQ, 5 Im, 120 A, 33 • 8 mm pre-column, and compounds were eluted with acetonitrile (20% for 5 min, followed by linear gradients to 45% in 5 min, to 50% in 7 min and to 100% in 2 min) in triethylammonium hydrogen carbonate buffer (0.01 M, pH 8.6) at a flow of 0.4 to 3 mL/min.
  • the purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure (21 mg, 32% yield; white solid crystalline powder) .
  • Reaction mixture (2 ml) contains histidine tagged iodide-X-Gal (0.078 mmol, 53.4 mg) , 0.78 mmol of (E) and 1 , 8-bis- (dimethylamino) -napthalene at a final concentration of 100 mM in DMSO.
  • the temperature was controlled at 32 0 C. After 100 min incubation the product was recovered by evaporating the CH 3 CN.
  • the labeled product was purified by semipreparative reverse-phase HPLC (Prontosil-AQ, 5 Im, 120 A, 250 • 8 mm column equipped with a Prontosil-AQ, 5 Im, 120 A, 33 • 8 mm pre-column, and compounds were eluted with acetonitrile (20% for 5 min, followed by linear gradients to 45% in 5 min, to 50% in 7 min and to 100% in 2 min) in triethylammonium hydrogen carbonate buffer (0.01 M, pH 8.6) at a flow of 0.4 to 3 mL/min.
  • the purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure (47.3 mg, 41% yield; white solid crystalline powder) .
  • Mass spectrometry was used to confirm the structure. HRMS: calculated for C 65 H 82 BrClN 11 Oi 8 S 2 was 1482.4153, [M + H + ] found 1483.4106.
  • MicroGrid II micro-arrayer onto a glass slide, followed by fixation by cross-linking through the poly A tail. Each SM was spotted in triplicate on each slide. Buffer controls were applied for comparison. Sixty ⁇ l of cell lysate at a protein concentration of 0.1 mg/ml in PBS buffer was deposited on the slide and incubated at room temperature for 30 to 180 min. PBS buffer was used as a control. The slide was then washed with PBS and deionized water, dried by standard array slide centrifugation protocol and fluorescence intensities of the spots were measured with a microarray laser scanning system (Axon) set to a pmt of 500 and 100% laser power.
  • Axon microarray laser scanning system
  • Kolguev Island coastal seawater A 200 ml sample of the coastal seawater of Kolguev Island (Barents Sea, Russia) was placed into a 1 L Erlenmeyer flask containing sterile crude oil (Arabian light, 0.5 % (vol/vol) ) and nutrients ([NH4] 2 PO 4 , 0.05% (w/vol)) .
  • Vulcano Island The fosmid library was established from the DNA isolated from the enrichment of microbial community from acidic pool of Porto Levante on Vulcano
  • L'Atalante seawater-brine interface sample (L 1 A) : The brine- seawater interface above hypersaline anoxic basin L'Atalante (Eastern Mediterranean Sea) was sampled during the MedBio2 oceanographic cruise in December 2006 from the depth of 3.431 meters. The 50 mL-samples were placed into sterile 100 ml Hungate bottles containing resazurine (anoxia indicator) , 1 g/L yeast extract and 2 mM 13 C-glucose. The salinity measured immediately after the cast was 180 g/L (NaCl) .
  • P. putida KT2440 the total DNA was extracted with G'NOME DNA Extraction Kit (BIOlOl, Qbiogene) from 100 ml culture of this bacterium grown as described above and was further cloned using Fosmid Library Production Kit (Epicentre) as recommended by the suppliers.
  • EXAMPLE 9 the total DNA was extracted with G'NOME DNA Extraction Kit (BIOlOl, Qbiogene) from 100 ml culture of this bacterium grown as described above and was further cloned using Fosmid Library Production Kit (Epicentre) as recommended by the suppliers.
  • the pool of clones (from phagemids of fosmids) was grown with shaking at 37 0 C in LB medium, with 50 g/ml kanamycin until OD 6 oo nm 1.5. After cultivation the cells were harvested by centrifugation (5000 g) for 15 min to yield 2-3 g/L of pellet. The cell pellet was frozen at -80 0 C overnight and then thawed. Cold PBS buffer was added directly to the frozen pellets (1.2 ml per 0.3 grs cell pellet) . The mixture was vortexed to homogeneity and subsequently sonicated for 2 min (total time) . The extract was centrifuged for 15 min at 15,000 g to separate cell debris and intact cells.
  • EXAMPLE 10 Representative procedure for the synthesis of SMs-Cy3 gold nanoparticles for identification and N- terminal sequencing of SM-acting proteins.
  • Au-6 , 8-dithioctic acid (TA) clusters were synthesized as described by Abad et al . (36) and used to create Au-TA-ANTA-Co (II) -SMs-Cy3 clusters.
  • the Au-TA clusters were incorporated to the ANTA-Co (II) -SMs-Cy3 by overnight amidation in a single step in the presence of 3 mM iV-hydroxysuccinimide (NHS, Fluka) and 3 ⁇ iM 1-ethyl -3 - [3 ⁇ - (dimethylamino) propyl] carbodiimide (EDC, Sigma) in 20 mM HEPES buffer (pH 7.5) .13 Further purification was carried out by ultrafiltration through low-adsorption hydrophilic 30 000 NMWL cutoff membranes (regenerated cellulose, Amicon) .
  • Enzymatic binding was carried out by incubation of the functionalized nanoparticles (40 g cm “3 ) in PBS buffer, pH 7.5 overnight at room temperature with protein solution (0.1 mg/ml in PBS) .
  • Au-TA-ANTA-Co2+-protein nanoparticles were separated from unbound enzyme molecules by ultrafiltration through low-adsorption hydrophilic 100 000 NMWL cutoff membranes (Amicon) .
  • Identification of bound proteins was performed by in situ trypsin digestion and ESI-Q-TOF MS/MS mapping (M. Ferrer et al . , Nature 445, 91 (2007)) that provides improved mass measurement accuracy for peptide sequencing and enables unambiguous protein identification.
  • ESI-Q-TOF MS/MS analyses were performed at the Sequencing Core Facility of the Autonomous University of Madrid. For each experiment, up to three binding experiments were prepared and analyzed. EXAMPLE 11 :
  • P. putida KT2440 and metagenomic hypothetical proteins were amplified by PCR from genomic and metagenomic DNA using the set of primers detailed in Table 4. Cycling parameters were 2 min at 95°C followed by 25 cycles at 95 0 C for 30 s, 66 0 C for 30 s, and 72°C for 20-140s (see specific elongation temperature for each protein inTable 4) , and ending with 10 min at 72°C.
  • KOL-I, -2 and -7 and VUL-9 proteins were amplified by PCR from the corresponding metagenomic DNA library using the set of primers detailed in Table 4.
  • PCR products were ligated in pGEMT plasmid (Promega) .
  • Proteins were expressed in Escherichia coli strain ORIGAMI (DE3)pLysS (Novagen) . Cultures were grown overnight in Luria-Bertani medium containing 100 mg/ml ampicillin and 50 mg/ml kanamycin, then diluted 1:100 in fresh medium. Cells were grown at 37 0 C to a final OD 6 oo of 0.5, induced with 1 rtiM isopropyl- -D-thiogalactopyranoside (IPTG) and incubated at 37°C for an additional 4 h. Cell pellets were collected by centrifugation at 4 1C for 20 min at 8,00Og.
  • Pellets were then suspended in 25 ml prechilled lysis buffer (Complete EDTA-free protease inhibitor tablet (Roche) , 150 mM NaCl, 1 mM dithiothreitol , 50 mM Hepes, pH 7.0 , 5 mM imidazole) and lysed by sonication on ice for 3 min with 30 s intervals. Cell lysates were centrifuged once more at 4°C for 20 min at 30,000 g, and the soluble fractions were retained. Proteins were purified using a 1-ml HisTag
  • EXAMPLE 13 Receiver Operating Characteristic (ROC) analysis.
  • ROC receiver operating characteristic
  • TPR TP/ (TP+FN)
  • FPR 1- (TN/ (TN+FP) )
  • TP "true positives” - cases predicted as positives (above the threshold for that particular cut) which are in fact positives (correct predictions); FN: “false negatives” - cases predicted as negatives (below the threshold) which are actually positives (wrong predictions) ; TN: “true negatives”; FP: “false positives”.
  • TP/ (TP+FN) is also known as “sensitivity” and gives an idea of the fraction of positives recovered at this particular cut of the list (note that TP+FN is the total number of positive cases) .
  • TN/ (TN+FP) is also known as "specificity".
  • the ROC plot is constructed by plotting TPR against FPR for the different cuts of the list.
  • a random method (a classifier without discriminative power which spreads positives and negatives uniformly across the sorted list of scores) will produce a diagonal line from (0,0) to (1,1) . Methods with some discriminative power will generate curves above this line. The higher the curve (closer to the (0,1) corner) the better the method.
  • a method with a perfect discriminative power (which puts all the positives together at the top of the list, associated to the highest scores) would be represented by a single point at (0,1) .
  • a parameter based in this representation which quantifies the global performance of a method in the AUC ("area under curve") .
  • Buffers The buffers used for the activity assay were: 1 mM MV in Tris-HCl 20 mM buffer pH 8.1 and sodium dithionite 10 or 100 mM in Tris-HCl 20 mM buffer pH 8.1.
  • PCR amplification was performed with 0.1 ng DNA template.
  • 16S rRNA genes were amplified using the Eubacteria-specific forward primer F27 (5 1 - AGAGTTTGATCMTGGCTCAG-3 ' ) in case of KOL and L 1 A and a universal F530 primer (5'-
  • TCCGTGCCAGCAGCCGCCG-3 ' for VUL library, in all cases in the combination with the universal reverse primer R1492 (5'- CGGYTACCTTGTTACGACTT-3 ' ) .
  • Amplification was done in 20 ⁇ l reaction volume with recombinant Taq DNA Polymerase (Invitrogen, Gemany) and original reagents, according to the basic PCR protocol, with an annealing temperature of 45 0 C (VUL) and 50 0 C C (L 1 A and KOL), for 30 cycles.
  • PCR amplicons were purified by electrophoresis on 0.8% agarose gels, followed by isolation from excised bands using a QIAEX II Gel Extraction Kit (Qiagen, Germany) .
  • the purified PCR products were ligated into plasmid vector pCRII-TOPO (TOPO TA Cloning kit, Invitrogen, Germany) with subsequent transformation into electrocompetent cells of E. coli (TOP 10) (Invitrogen, Germany) .
  • TOP 10 E. coli
  • After blue/white screening, randomly picked clones were resuspended in PCR- lysis solution A without proteinase K (67 mM Tris-Cl (pH 8.8) ; 16 mM NH 4 SO 4 ; 5 M - mercaptoethanol ; 6.7 mM MgCl 2; 6.7 M EDTA (pH 8.0) (Sambrook and Russel, 2002) and heated at 95C C for 5 min.
  • the lysate (l ⁇ l) was used as DNA template for PCR amplification using primers M13F (5' -GACGTTGTAAAACGACGGCCAG- 3') and M13R ( 5 ' -GAGGAAACAGCTATGACCATG- 3 ' ) .
  • primers M13F 5' -GACGTTGTAAAACGACGGCCAG- 3'
  • M13R 5 ' -GAGGAAACAGCTATGACCATG- 3 '
  • PCR products were purified with MinElute 96 UF PCR purification kit (Qiagen, Germany) and sequenced with M13 and M13R primers according to the protocol for BigDye Terminator vl .1 Cycle Sequencing Kit from Applied Biosysterns (USA) .
  • micro-array analysis were further performed by spotting 0.25 nl of substrate solutions at concentration of 2.52 pmol ml "1 and by arraying the slides with at least 0.10 mg protein lysate ml "1 to ensure detection of all proteins in the extract (it should be noted that enzyme concentrations as low as 1.5 ng ml "1 were sufficient to ensure appropriate detection with a S/N 10) .
  • EXAMPLE 18 EXAMPLE 18 :
  • Vulcano Island sediment was introduced into an acidic (pH 1.7) ferrous iron- and sulfate-rich liquid medium and incubated for 4 weeks at 45°C to produce enrichment VOL; the Koluev Island coastal water was enriched with crude oil and incubated for 4 weeks at 4 0 C to produce enrichment KOL; and the seawater : brine interface sample from the L'Atalante Basin was supplemented with glucose and yeast extract and incubated anaerobically for 6 months at 14 0 C, to produce enrichment L' A.
  • the microbial communities obtained for analysis represent communities from very distinct, rather extreme habitats: a low energy, low nutrient, heavy metal-rich habitat (VOL) 7 a nutrient and energy-rich, organic pollutant -contaminated habitat (KOL) , and a hypersaline, anaerobic environment, inoculated with a sample taken also from a high pressure habitat but which was subsequently maintained at atmospheric pressure, so should contain facultative barophiles (L'A) .
  • VOL low energy, low nutrient, heavy metal-rich habitat
  • KOL organic pollutant -contaminated habitat
  • L'A facultative barophiles
  • EXAMPLE 19 General pan -reactome considerations.
  • the VUL reactome consisted of 807 compounds
  • the KOL reactome consisted of 1493 compounds
  • the L'A reactome 2386 The restricted metabolic activity of the VUL sample was not unexpected, since the diversity of the community is low, the biomass concentration is low, and the prevailing physico-chemical conditions highly selective of a restricted metabolism.
  • the reactome of KOL was also not unexpected, since the excess carbon in the hydrocarbon-based enrichment leads to high cell densities and much recycling of cellular carbon in all its diverse forms.
  • the extremely diverse metabolic profile of the L'A metagenome library is surprising, given the highly restricted diversity of the original community.
  • the oligotrophic environment selects for organisms expressing a wide range of nutrient scavenging systems constitutively at low levels, and in addition, anaerobic metabolism and salt and pressure tolerance systems not specified or expressed by the other two communities, and, on the other, the E. coli cellular environment may result in expression of a range of aerobic metabolism systems encoded, but not necessarily expressed under natural conditions, by the community organisms. Nevertheless, the exceptional richness of the metabolic profile of the L'A library is impressive .
  • EXAMPLE 20 The micro-array served as experimental platform to identify gene functions.
  • P. putida proteins Sequence analysis revealed the identity of proteins acting against cis-2-hydroxypenta-2 , 4-dienoate, ⁇ -carboxymuconolactone, 3-hydroxyanthranilate and dimethylallyl diphosphate - all of them correspond to the hypothetical proteins with no assigned function annotated PP_1394, PP_1752, PP_2949 and PP_1642 (Table 4) .
  • a case of interest is the ability of protein PP_1394 to transform the conversion of cis-2 -hydroxypenta- 2 , 4-dienoate to cis-2 -hydroxypenta- 2, 4-dienoate as a part of the biphenyl degradation pathway.
  • This pathway is not annotated in KEGG for P. putida KT2440 strain (cf. above), in spite of the fact that strains Fl, GBl and W619 clearly possess some genes responsible for p- cymene and 4-chlorobiphenyl degradation (see http://www.genome.jp/kegg/) .
  • Metagenomic proteins Sequence analysis revealed that all of metagenomic proteins acting against undecane, (S) -4,5- dihydroxypentan-2 , 3 -dione, 2-bromo-l-chloropropane, phosphatidylinositol-4 , 5-bisphosphate and methyl viologen exhibited a high degree of similarity to predicted hypothetical proteins with no function assigned (Table 4), except L'A62, a 162 -amino acid polypeptide with a predicted molecular mass of 18,068 Da along with estimated pi of 4.55, that exhibited high similarity to a predicted [NiFe] hydrogenase from Carboxythermus hydrogenoformans (7e ⁇ 54 ) .
  • the band of frequency value of 1947 cm “1 and the group of bands between 2080 and 2095 cm “1 correspond to the carbonyl ligand and the cyanide ligands respectively of this type of hydrogenases in the "unready” and “ready” oxidized states (A. De Lacey et al . , Biochem Biophys Acta 832, 69 (1985)) .
  • the band at 1936 cm “1 can be assigned to the carbonyl ligand of irreversibly inactivated enzyme, whereas the bands at 2060 and 2073 cm “1 can be assigned to the cyanide ligands of the same state.
  • H 2 -uptake activity of protein 62 was measured in a spectrophotometer using methyl viologen as electron acceptor (Figure 7, inset) .
  • the protein isolated under aerobic conditions had the typical lag-phase of several minutes in the activity profile of standard NiFe- hydrogenases in the "unready" oxidized state (V. M. Fernandez et al . , Biochim Biophys Acta 832, 69 (1985)) .
  • Incubation under H 2 of the protein during several hours led to disappearing of the lag-phase and an increase of the maximum activity. This activation process is also a functional characteristic signature of standard NiFe- hydrogenases.
  • the structural and functional data measured suggest an active site very similar to that of standard NiFe-hydrogenases, although the overall protein structure is unique up to date for this type enzymes (just 1 subunit of very small size, an amino acid sequence with no motifs for iron-sulfur clusters nor with the typical Ll or L2 signatures) (P.M. Vignais, B. BiIloud, Chem Rev 107, 4206 (2007) ) .

Landscapes

  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Immunology (AREA)
  • Zoology (AREA)
  • Proteomics, Peptides & Aminoacids (AREA)
  • Molecular Biology (AREA)
  • Wood Science & Technology (AREA)
  • Biotechnology (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Microbiology (AREA)
  • Analytical Chemistry (AREA)
  • Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
  • Biochemistry (AREA)
  • General Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Urology & Nephrology (AREA)
  • Biophysics (AREA)
  • Genetics & Genomics (AREA)
  • Biomedical Technology (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
  • Hematology (AREA)
  • Cell Biology (AREA)
  • Food Science & Technology (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • General Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
  • Pathology (AREA)
  • Measuring Or Testing Involving Enzymes Or Micro-Organisms (AREA)
  • Investigating Or Analysing Materials By The Use Of Chemical Reactions (AREA)

Abstract

The present invention relates to a probe compound that can comprise any substrate or metabolite of an enzymatic reaction in addition to an indicator component, such as, for example, a fluorescence dye, or the like. Moreover, the present invention relates to means for detecting enzymes in form of an array, which comprises any number of probe compounds of the invention which each comprise a different metabolite of interconnected metabolites representing the central pathways in all forms of life. Moreover, the present invention relates to a method for detecting enzymes involving the application of cell extracts or the like to the array of the invention which leads to reproducible enzymatic reactions with the substrates. These specific enzymatic reactions trigger the indicator (e.g. a fluorescence signal) and bind the enzymes to the respective cognate substrates. Moreover, the invention relates to means for isolating enzymes in form of nanoparticles coated with the probe compound of the invention. The immobilisation of the cognate substrates or metabolites on the surface of nanoparticles by means of the probe compounds allows capturing and isolating the respective enzyme, e.g. for subsequent sequencing.

Description

Probe Compound for Detecting and Isolating Enzymes and Means and Methods using the Same
Description
Background of the Invention
The present invention relates to a probe compound for detecting and isolating enzymes, to a method for producing the probe compound, to means for detecting enzymes and means for isolating enzymes, to a method for producing the means for detecting and isolating enzymes, and to a method for detecting and isolating enzymes using the same.
In more detail, the present invention relates to a probe compound that can comprise any substrate or metabolite of an enzymatic reaction in addition to an indicator component, such as, for example, a fluorescence dye, or the like. Moreover, the present invention relates to means for detecting enzymes in form of an array. The array according to the present invention comprises any number of probe compounds of the invention which each comprise a different metabolite of interconnected metabolites representing the central pathways in all forms of life. The probe compound and the array of the invention can be used for detecting specific enzyme-substrate interactions associated with the corresponding substrate (s) or metabolite (s) , which allows to identify substrate-specific enzymatic activity in a sample. Moreover, the present invention relates to a method for detecting enzymes involving the application of cell extracts or the like to the array of the invention which leads to reproducible enzymatic reactions with the substrates. These specific enzymatic reactions trigger the indicator (e.g. a fluorescence signal) and bind the enzymes to the respective cognate substrates. Moreover, the invention relates to means for isolating enzymes in form of nanoparticles coated with the probe compound of the invention. The immobilisation of the cognate substrates or metabolites on the surface of nanoparticles by means of the probe compounds allows capturing and isolating the respective enzyme, e.g. for subsequent sequencing. In short, the probe compound of the invention provides two new aspects: first, that only an active protein (enzyme) triggers the indicator signal, and second, that the active protein subsequently binds to the probe compound .
In recent years, the new discipline of "functional genomics" has greatly accelerated the research on the genomic basis of life processes in health and disease, and has significantly improved our understanding of such processes, their regulation and underlying mechanisms. However, until relatively recently, functional genomics has been sequence- centric, that is, functional assignments and metabolic network reconstructions have mostly depended on the genome sequence of the organism in question, combined with bioinformatic analyses based on homologies to known gene/protein-relationships. In addition to the fact that a significant fraction of genes in databases available today has a questionable annotation, many are not annotated at all, which adds further uncertainties to analyses and predictions based on them. With the recent advent of
"metabolomics" , functional insights into the metabolic state of a cell became possible independently of sequence information. However, problems of metabolite identification and quantification still exist, and the link with the cognate metabolic pathways is still heavily dependent upon sequence -based metabolic reconstructions. Furthermore, it is currently very difficult to derive global metabolic overviews of non-sequenced organisms or communities of organisms existing in an individual habitat or biotop (biocoenosis) .
Therefore, there exists an urgent need to solve the twin problems of the identification of metabolites and the enzymes involved in their transformation and, simultaneously, to begin the critical process of rigorous annotation of yet un-annotated and incorrectly annotated open reading frames (genes) , and thereby improving the utility of the exponentially growing body of genome sequence information. Thus, an activity-based, annotation- independent procedure for the global assessment of cellular responses is urgently needed.
"Microarrays" or "biochips" have proven to be an important and indispensable tool for the fast gain and processing of information required in the field. Here, the term 'array' refers to a collection of a large number of different test compounds preferably arranged in a planar plane, e.g. by attachment on a flat surface, such as a glass slide surface, or by occupying special compartments or wells provided on a plate, such as a micro-titre plate. The test compounds, which are also referred to as probes, probe compounds or probe molecules, are usually bound or immobilised on the flat surface or to the walls of a compartment, respectively. The use of arrays allows for the rapid, simultaneous testing of all probe molecules with respect to their interaction with an analyte or a mixture of analytes in a sample. The analytes of the sample are often referred to as target molecules. The advantage of a planar array over a test (assay) having immobilised probe molecules on mobile elements, such as, for example, beads, is that in an array the chemical structure and/or the identity of the immobilised probe molecules is precisely defined by their location in the array surface. A specific local test signal, which is produced, for example, by an interaction between the probe molecule and the analyte molecule, can accordingly be immediately assigned to a type of molecule or to a probe molecule. As evidence of an interaction between a probe molecule and an analyte molecule, it is also possible to use the enzymatic conversion of the probe by the biomolecule, with the result that a local test signal can also disappear and accordingly serves as direct evidence. Particularly in miniaturised form, arrays having biological probe molecules are also known as "biochips".
Usually, the surface of the microarray having the bound probe molecules is brought into contact, over its entire area, with the solution of the analyte molecules from a sample. Then, the solution is usually removed after a predetermined incubation time. Alternatively, appropriate amounts of the sample solution are filled into the respective compartments (wells) of the array. When the specific and selective interaction between the probe molecule and an analyte molecule is complete, a signal is generated at the location of the probe molecule. That signal can either be produced directly, for example by binding of a fluoresence-labelled biomolecule, or can be generated in further treatments with detection reagents, for example in the form of an optical or radioactive signal. Many different technical details relating to procedure and detection are well known and completely described in the art. There are numerous array protocols and processes which are adapted for automatic handling by corresponding (robotic) apparatuses, thus allowing for high reliability and reproducibility of information gain and processing.
Examples of known arrays in the prior art are nucleic acid arrays of DNA fragments, cDNAs, RNAs, PCR products, plasmids, bacteriophages and synthetic PNA oligomers, which are selected by means of hybridisation, with formation of a double- strand molecule, to give complementary nucleic acid analytes . In addition, protein arrays of antibodies, proteins expressed in cells or phage fusion proteins (phage display) play an important part. Furthermore, compound arrays of synthetic peptides, analogues thereof, such as peptoids, oligocarbamates or generally organic chemical compounds, are known, which are selected, for example, by means of binding to affinitive protein analytes or other analytes by means of enzymatic reaction. Moreover, arrays of chimaeras and conjugates of the said probe molecules have been described.
DNA microarray technology has a vast potential for improving the understanding of microbial systems. Microarray-based genomic technology is a powerful tool for viewing the expression of thousands of genes simultaneously in a single experiment. While this technology was initially designed for transcriptional profiling of a single species, its applications have been dramatically extended to environmental applications in recent years. The use of microarrays to profile metagenomic libraries may also offer an effective approach for characterizing many clones rapidly. As an example, a fosmid library was obtained and further arrayed on a glass slide. This format is referred to as a metagenome microarray (MGA) . In the MGA format, the \probe' and λ target' concept is a reversal of those of general cDNA and oligonucleotide microarrays : targets (fosmid clones) are spotted on a slide and a specific gene probe is labelled and used for hybridization. This format of microarray may offer an effective metagenome -screening approach for identifying clones from metagenome libraries rapidly without the need of laborious procedures for screening various target genes.
However, one of the greatest challenges in using microarrays for analyzing environmental samples is the low detection sensitivity of microarray-based hybridization in combination with the low biomass often present in samples from environmental settings. Microarrays for expression profiling can be divided into two broad categories, microarrays based on the deposition of preassembled DNA probes (cDNA microarrays) and those based on in situ synthesis of oligonucleotide probes (e.g. Affymetrix arrays, oligonucleotide microarrays) . Applications employing DNA microarrays include, for example, the characterization of microbial communities from environmental samples such as soil and water. Various types of DNA microarrays have been applied to study the microbial diversity of various environments. Those include, for example, oligonucleotides, cDNA (PCR amplified DNA fragments) , and whole genome DNA.
One of the major problems associated with nucleic acid-based micro-arrays is derived from the short half-life of mRNA, and that mRNA in bacteria and archaea usually comprise only a small fraction of total RNA. Moreover, the study of the gene expression from an environmental sample using DNA microarrays is a challenging task. First, the sensitivity may often be a part of the problem in PCR-based cDNA microarrays, since only- genes from populations contributing to more than 5% of the community DNA can be detected. Second, samples often contain a variety of environmental contaminants that affects the quality of RNA and DNA hybridization and makes it difficult to extract undegraded mRNA. The specificity of the extraction method plays a central role and should vary depending on the site of sampling, as there must be sufficient discrimination between probes. However, there is a promising perspective for microarrays in determining the relative abundance of a microorganism bearing a specific functional gene in a complex environment .
However, specificity is a key issue, since one needs to distinguish the differences in hybridization signals due to population abundance from those due to sequence divergence. Furthermore, annotation and the comprehensive functional characterization of proteins or RNA molecules remain difficult, error-prone processes, but systems microbiology relies heavily on a thorough understanding of the functions of gene products.
At the moment, after DNA micro-arrays, the peptide arrays are the most popular. In this kind of arrays, peptides with different chemical composition are synthesised and immobilized on glass slides. The peptides may also contain a marker, such as a fluorescence dye marker (e.g. a fluorescent cyanine dye known under the name ' Cy3 ' ) , but here the detection method is only based on the lowered fluorescence obtained with a protein bound to the molecule. There is no enzymatic reaction necessary for the signal, so un-specific bindings may occur and trigger a signal, which may lead to incorrect assignments. Further, there is no possibility to reconstruct metabolic networks.
Another array alternative is to bind proteins to a slide. Such system is usually not based on the detection of a fluorescence signal, but rather on the utilization of surface Plasmon resonance. This system has been exploited for the analysis of molecular interactions, i.e. protein- protein or molecule-protein interactions.
In view of the problems encountered in the prior art, the present invention is therefore based on the object of providing a novel probe compound, which allows for the testing of a reactive interaction of an enzyme with a small molecule or enzymatic substrate. The probe compound should allow for the easy linkage of all small molecules or substrates necessary for the life functions of an organism or communities living in a habitat (biocoenosis) . Thus, a plurality of probe compounds should allow for the construction of a ' reactome array1 or microarray which allows for the testing of all life supporting enzymatic reactions of an organism or community simultaneosly . Particularly, the probe compound should provide a highly sensitive, accurate, reproducible, and robust high- throughput tool for a genome-wide analysis of the metabolic status of an organism or community. In this context, the term "genome-wide analysis" means an analysis that is independent of genome sequence. Moreover, the probe compound should also allow for use in the isolation of an enzyme so that said enzyme may be further analysed or identified in a subsequent step. Moreover, the probe compound should also allow for the identification of small molecules, substrates and/or metabolites which are metabolised by an organism or community, thus allowing the identification of biologic pathways or the direct comparison of the reactomes of different organisms, which might be applied in the search for new targets for drug- screening .
Summary of the Invention
The object of the invention is solved by a probe compound comprising a transition metal complex and a reactive component comprising a test component and an indicator component, wherein the test component and the indicator component are linked to form the reactive component, and wherein the reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex. The probe compound of the invention provides a means for testing of a reactive interaction of an enzyme with a small molecule or enzymatic substrate. The probe compound may be readily used in combination with all small molecules or substrates necessary for the life functions of an organism or communities living in a habitat
(biocoenosis) . Further, the probe compound provides a highly sensitive, accurate, reproducible, and robust high- throughput tool for a genome-wide analysis of the metabolic status of an organism or community. It allows the fast and reliable detection of a substrate specific enzyme interaction. Moreover, the probe compound may be readily used to detect the involvement of one enzymatic substrate in different metabolic pathways. Moreover, the probe compound provides a means to immobilise a substrate-specific enzyme, which can be advantageously used to isolate this enzyme from a sample. Preferably, the object of the invention is solved by a probe compound for detecting specific enzyme -substrate interactions comprising a transition metal complex and a reactive component of general formula (X) :
His-LHis-τc-TC-Lτc-ic-IC-LIC-His-His formula (X)
wherein His represents a histidine residue, TC represents a test component, IC represents an indicator component, and each of LHis-τc/ Lτc-ic and LiC-HiS independently represents optional linker components, wherein the reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex by the two histidine residues.
A preferred embodiment of the probe compound of the invention can be illustrated by the following general formula (1) :
Figure imgf000012_0001
/ \
AC - L AΛCC--MMCC -- MMCC LLTTCC--IICC Formula (1)
\ /
Figure imgf000012_0002
wherein AC represents an optional anchoring component, MC represents the transition metal complex, TC represents the test component, IC represents the indicator component, and LAC-MO LMC-TC, LTC-IC and LMC_IC each independently represents an optional linker component between the respective components indicated by the subscripts, wherein it is preferred that LMC-TC and LMC_IC each independently comprise a histidine residue . In more detail, the present invention relates to a probe compound that can comprise any substrate or metabolite of an enzymatic reaction in addition to an indicator component, such as, for example, a fluorescence dye, or the like. In short, the probe compound of the invention provides two new aspects: first, that only an active protein (enzyme) triggers the indicator signal, and second, that the active protein subsequently binds to the probe compound.
The object of the invention is also solved by a method for preparing the probe compound of the invention. The inventive method provides a versatile method for preparing all embodiments of the probe compound. Moreover, the method of the invention can be used for the identical and reproducible production of probe compounds comprising different enzymatic substrates, which allows for the ready use in automatic processes, such as parallel synthesis or the like.
The object is also solved by an array which comprises a plurality of different probe compounds of the invention. The array (which is sometimes referred to as "reactome array" in the following) can be used for the simultaneous detection of all reactive interactions between the probe compounds and analyte molecules (enzymes) from a sample. The array also provides a fast and reliable way to detect all metabolic pathways active in an organism or community, and may be used advantageously for an activity-based, annotation- independent procedure for the global assessment of cellular responses. The array can include a number of interconnected metabolites representing central pathways in all forms of life. The application of cell extracts to the array leads to reproducible enzymatic reactions with substrates that trigger the indicator signal and bind enzymes to cognate substrates.
The invention also provides a method for producing an array according to the invention, which allows for a versatile, fast and reproducible production of arrays according to the invention .
Moreover, the object is also solved by an isolation means comprising a probe compound according to the invention and a nanoparticle, preferably a magnetic nanoparticle . The isolation means according to the invention allows for the substrate specific interaction and binding of an enzyme which can then be isolated by means, such as, for example, filtration, gravitation force (centrifugation) , an external magnetic force, or the like. The invention also provides a method for producing an isolation means according to the invention. The immobilisation of the cognate substrates or metabolites on the surface of nanoparticles by means of the probe compounds allows capturing and isolating the respective enzyme, e.g. for subsequent sequencing.
Moreover, the object is solved by a method for detecting enzymes using the probe compound according to the invention, or the array according to the invention, as well as by a method for isolating enzymes, using the isolation means according to the invention.
The particular subject-matter of the invention and its preferred embodiments will be described in more detail in the following description as well as in the examples and figures attached thereto. Brief Description of the Figures
Figure 1 shows a schematic overview of the array strategy, including a summary of the four major steps in the construction and analysis of arrays. Steps 1 and 2: extensive data and synthetic mining effort to produce a library of metabolites than can be arrayed on glass slides in a spatially-addressable manner; steps 3 nad 4: detection and analysis of enzymatic reactions following application of cell lysates to the array, and metabolic reconstructions.
Figure 2 shows an overview of the array strategy, including a summary of the four major steps in the construction of metabolite complexes. (1) 2-step synthesis of bi-functional , non- fluorescent Cy3 dye component; (2) preparation of the His-tagged substrate (1-indanone is shown as a model substrate) , (3) preparation of Co2+ linker molecules; and (4) synthesis of Cy3 -metabolite complexes containing an amine with a nitrogen-to-metabolite 'labile' bond proximal to the catalysis reaction site.
Fig. 3 illustrates the reactome strategy. The generic structure of reactome metabolites involves three linked components, the enzyme substrate-metabolite, the quenched dye, and the linker used to immobilize the complex on the array or on nanoparticles . The substrate-metabolite is linked to the quenched dye though a labile nitrogen bond, and both the dye and the substrate are anchored to the Co (II) -containing poly (A) linker by histidine 'tags' .
Details of the synthetic strategy are provided in Figures 2 and 8. An enzyme-catalysed chemical change in the substrate at a position adjacent to the weakly amine region causes rupture of the labile nitrogen: metabolite bond, and release of the quenched Cy3 dye. This in turn provokes release of the reaction product and the histidine 'tags' anchored to the Co(II) , thereby exposing an active cobalt cation which ligates and immobilizes the enzyme on the array spot. The released dye is no longer quenched and gives a fluorescent signal. The nature of the reaction and the catalysis product is defined by the position to which the quenched dye and the substrate are linked (see table 2) .
Figure 4 shows Dose-response curves determined with pure E. coli β-Gal and Cy3-linked X-GaI. (A) Substrate dose response with fixed amount of β-Gal (5 ng/ml) ; (B) β-Gal dose response with fixed amount of Cy3 -modified X-GaI (2.52 pmol/ml) . For each experiment, normalized intensity values and fit curves were scaled relative to the maximum asymptotic values of the fit.
Figure 5 shows the Receiver Operating Characteristic (ROC) curve of the array. The ROC shows the capacity of the array to discriminate compounds potentially metabolised by P. putida from those which are not metabolised. The "true positive rate" (TRP) is plotted on the Y-axis against the
"false positive rate" (FRP) on the X-axis. The diagonal line represents the discriminative power of a random method.
Figure 6 shows an overall comparison of metabolites transformed by lysates of the three communities KOL, VUL and L'A. (A) Pairwise comparisons of the compounds metabolized by lysates of the KOL, VUL and L'A metagenome libraries. (B) Overall comparison of compounds metabolized by the three libraries. (C) Pairwise comparisons of the compounds metabolized by lysates of the individual metagenome libraries and that of P. putida.
Figure 7 shows dose-response curves determined with purified P. putida KT2440 proteins (A) and metagenomic proteins (B) . Left and right figures represent protein and molecule dose responses. Results shown are the average of three independent assays, and were corrected for background signal. Results are not fitted to any model. The spotting process was carried out using a MicroGrid II micro-arrayer (Biorobotics) by spotting 0.25 nL droplets of SMs-Cy3 solutions (spot size 400 μm diameter with concentrations ranging from 0 to 0.25 pmol/ml) and further arrayed with 60 μl of a solution of pure enzyme (from 16 to 90 ng/ml in PBS buffer, depending on the enzyme used) (left column) or by spotting 0.25 nL droplets of SMs-Cy3 solution (spot size 400 μm diameter with concentration of 0.4 pmol/ml) and further arrayed with 60 μl of solution of pure enzyme at different concentrations (from 0 to 6000 μg/ml in PBS buffer) . Signals were analyzed and quantified using GenePix pro 4.1 software (Axon) . As shown, Cy3 fluorescence emission increased with increasing the amount of both protein and substrate, whereas inactive proteins did not (see below) . (C) FTIR spectrum of L'A62 hydrogenase . Inset shows the H2-uptake activity using methyl viologen as acceptor.
Figure 8 summarizes the major steps used for the construction of metabolite complexes corresponding to the 26 different synthetic methods. Abbreviations used are as follows: 1,8-BDN ( 1 , 8 -bis- (dimethylamino) -naphthalene) ; REBr (hybrid halogenase/dehalogenase; MeOH (methanol) , (E) compound (Cy3 intermediate containing histidine and linkers) .
Figure 9 shows representative molecules of the different synthetic methods used to link metabolites with histidine and the dye molecule.
Detailed Description of the Invention
The present invention provides a probe compound comprising a transition metal complex and a reactive component comprising a test component and an indicator component, wherein the test component and the indicator component are linked to form the reactive component, and wherein the reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex. The probe compound of the invention thus comprises the following components: a transition metal complex and a reactive component. The reactive component in turn comprises the following components: a test component and an indicator component, which are linked to form the reactive component. Further, the reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex.
A preferred embodiment of the probe compound of the invention can be illustrated by the following general formula (1) :
LMC-TC - TC
I \
AC - LAC. MC MC LTC-IC Formula ( 1
\ /
LMC-IC - IC wherein AC represents an optional anchoring component, MC represents the transition metal complex, TC represents the test component, IC represents the indicator component, and LAC-Mc, LMc-τc/ LTC-IC and LMC-IC each independently represents an optional linker moiety between the respective components indicated by the subscripts.
Preferably, the probe compound for detecting specific enzyme -substrate interactions comprises a transition metal complex and a reactive component of general formula (X) :
His-LHis-τc-TC-Lτc_IC-IC-LiC-His-His formula (X)
wherein His represents a histidine residue, TC represents a test component, IC represents an indicator component, and each of LHiS-τc, Lτc-ic and LIC-His independently represents optional linker components, wherein the reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex by the two histidine residues.
Herein, the term "linked" means that two components are connected with each other by means of at least one chemical bond, preferably by one, two, or three chemical bonds, and most preferred by exactly one chemical bond. A chemical bond indicates any chemical bond known in the art, such as, for example, an ionic bond, a covalent bond, including a single bond, a double bond, a triple bond, or another suitable multiple bond, and a hydrogen bond, and the like. Preferably, the chemical bond between the individual components is a covalent single bond. Preferably, the "link" or chemical bond between two components is a direct bond between the two components; but it may also comprise a suitable linker atom or molecule, if necessary. In some cases, one or both of the components to be linked will have to be activated in order to allow for the formation of a chemical bond or link. The procedures and means to be applied for such activation and formation of chemical bonds are standard knowledge of the field, and any skilled person will immediately know how to proceed.
Since the individual components are required to be linked (or chemically bonded) to each other as specified, the term "component" is used to indicate the respective parts of the probe compound which are characterised by their respective function as determined in the following. Herein, the term "component" is meant to refer to a specified part or moiety of a molecule, which is identified by its function within this molecule. For example, the term "indicator component" refers to a part or moiety of the molecule, which comprises a signal-generating function, e.g. a fluorescence dye or the like, that allows for indicating the location of the probe compound. Similarly, the term "test component" refers to a part or moiety of the molecule, which comprises a substrate or metabolite, thus being the site of enzymatic interaction with the probe compound. The respective components are linked by chemical bonds to form the molecule, i.e. the probe compound. It should be noted that, in the context of this invention, the term "component" is used with the meaning of "part" or "moiety" of one compound or molecule, and not to refer to individual members of a multi -molecule system. The terms "component", "part" and "moiety" may be used alternatively with this meaning. However, for reasons of consistency, the term "component" will also be used to refer to the respective molecules before they are reacted to form the respective part (component) of the probe compound, or after they are released from the probe compound, respectively. A person skilled in the art will readily understand the exact nature of the respective molecules, as well as their contribution to the probe compound.
The term "linked" indicates the presence of at least one chemical bond between the corresponding components. A chemical bond can be a hydrogen bond, an ionic bond or a covalent bond, including a bond between a transition metal atom and its surrounding ligand atoms in a coordination compound (also referred to as "coordination bond" in the following) . Preferably, the chemical bond(s) between the components of the probe molecule are covalent bonds, further preferred covalent single bonds, wherein the bond(s) between the reactive component and the transition metal complex preferably are coordination bonds. The probe compound of the invention is required to have bonds between the transition metal complex and the reactive component, as well as between the test component and the indicator component forming the reactive component. However, the respective components may also be linked by additional bonds, as long as such bonds do not hinder the function of the probe compound. For example, the reactive component may be linked to the transition metal complex by at least one coordination bond formed between the test component moiety of the reactive component and the central metal atom of the transition metal complex and by at least one coordination bond formed between the indicator component moiety of the reactive component and the central metal atom of the transition metal complex. In a preferred embodiment, the reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex by exactly one coordination bond formed between the test component moiety of the reactive component and the central metal atom of the transition metal complex and by exactly one coordination bond formed between the indicator component moiety of the reactive component and the central metal atom of the transition metal complex. The respective coordination bonds can be direct bonds between the metal atom and a suitable atom of the test or indicator components, or a bond formed via a suitable linker moiety, which is linked to the test and/or indicator component, respectively. A preferred linker moiety is a histidine residue. By forming links via a linker moiety, it is possible to obtain a reproducible binding property for all test and indicator components.
The term "test component" is used for the part or component of the probe compound which comprises a substrate or metabolite. Herein, the terms "substrate" and "metobolite" refer to any molecule capable of specific interaction with the active site of an enzyme. The substrate or metabolite is comprised in the test component in such a manner that its characteristic structure and/or functional groups necessary for interaction with the active site of an enzyme are maintained within the test component. Therefore, the substrate or metabolite is preferably linked to the other components of the probe compound at positions of the substrate or metabolite molecule, which are not involved in enzyme -substrate interaction. Optionally, a spacer or linker moiety can be used to provide a suitable binding position on the the test component, which allows for an unimpeded enzyme interaction. In this case, the term "test component" refers to the component comprising both the substrate and the spacer moiety. The test component may be linked to the probe compound by chemical bonds involving positions, i.e. atoms or functional groups, of the substrate or metabolite and/or an optional spacer or linker moiety. The term "test component" is preferably used to indicate a component comprising a so-called "small organic molecule" that can interact with an enzyme. The term "small organic molecule" refers to a molecule comprising of carbon and hydrogen atoms, optionally including nitrogen, oxygen, phosphorous, sulfur, and/or halogen (F, Cl, Br, I) atoms, and having a molecular weight of 5000 Da or less, preferably of 2000 Da or less. Preferably, the test component comprises a known substrate of at least one enzyme. Moreover, the test component can also comprise a pseudo-substrate or inhibitor of a known enzyme. However, the test component may also comprise a molecule suspected to interact with the active site of an enzyme. The test component may also comprise a small organic molecules for the search for pharmaceutical active ingredients. According to one embodiment, the "test component" does not comprise a polymeric compound based on nucleic acids, such as DNA, cDNA, RNA, or the like, or a polymeric compound based on amino acids, such as peptides, proteins, or the like. According to another embodiment, the test component may comprise at least one nucleic acid and/or amino acid, if necessary. Preferably, the test component comprises one or two nucleic acids, or one or two amino acids. According to another embodiment, the test component comprises a polymeric compound, such as a polymeric compound based on natural occurring sugar units or the like, e.g. cellulose or the like. Preferable, a polymeric compound has a molecular weight of 5000 Da or less, i.e. 5 kDa or less. According to another embodiment, the test component comprises a polymeric compound based on nucleic acids, such as DNA, cDNA, RNA, or the like, and/or a polymeric compound based on amino acids, such as peptides, proteins, or the like. Moreover, the test component can be preferably functionalised with a linker component or moiety suitable for binding to the transition metal complex. Such functionalisation is especially advantageous for test components comprising substrates, which do not readily form coordination bonds. In a preferred embodiment, the test component is functionalised with a histidine molecule or residue (sometimes referred to as a "His-tag" in the following) . The amino acid histidine was found to be especially versatile, because it may be linked to a test component or indicator component by either its amine function or its carboxylic acid function, while the imidazole ring provides for a good coordination bond to the transition metal atom. A histidine residue may be linked to the substrate or metabolite comprised in the test component or to another part of the test component, either directly or using a suitable linker moiety. Similarly, a histidine residue may be linked to the dye comprised in the indicator component or to another part of the indicator component, either directly or using a suitable linker moiety. A skilled person will know how to link a histidine residue to the desired site or position of a test or indicator component, whether a special activation and/or linker moiety will be required, as well as the starting materials and conditions necessary therefor, etc. A His-tag has the additional advantage to ensure an identical binding property of all possible substrates to the transition metal complex. Moreover, it was found that a link including a His-tag may be advantageously broken upon enzymatic reaction of a test component comprising a His-tag. Moreover, it was found that by selecting the site of histidine binding to the test component, it is possible to prepare probe compounds which allow for the identification of different metabolic pathways and the enzymes involved therein. The term "indicator component" is used to indicate a molecule which can generate a signal, thus indicating the location of the probe molecule, e.g. on an array. That signal can either be produced directly, for example by adsorbance or fluorescence, or can be generated in further treatments with detection reagents, for example in the form of an optical or radioactive signal. Preferably, the indicator component comprises a dye, further preferred a fluorescence dye. The term "fluorescence dye" indicates a molecule showing fluorescence upon irradiation with a suitable light source. Preferably, an indicator component comprises a fluorescent azo compound or a cyanine compound, or the like. Especially preferred is a cyanine compound, which is known in the art under the name of "Cy3". If necessary, the moiety having the fluorescence property is further modified, e.g. by addition of a suitable linker moiety, in order to allow the binding to the test component, and/or to the transition metal complex. For example, a Cy3 dye available as its Cy3-NHS-ester may be reacted with both histidine and a 4 -amino-3 -butyric acid linker to allow for linking with both the transition metal complex and the test component, respectively. An additional linker moiety has the advantage to ensure an identical and reproducible binding to the indicator component and/or the transition metal complex, which allows for the ready use in parallel synthesis or the like.
The test component is linked to the indicator component to form the reactive component. Preferably, the test component is linked to the indicator component by at least one covalent chemical bond, further preferred by one, two, or three covalent bonds, and still further preferred by exactly one covalent bond. A preferred example of such a covalent bond is a carbon-oxygen single bond, which can be formed between the test component and the indicator component by various chemical reactions, such as, for example, a condensation reaction, an addition reaction, an oxidation reaction, and the like. A preferred example is a condensation reaction between a carboxylic acid and an alcohol, or between two alcohols, or an addition reaction wherein the oxygen atom of an alcohol function is added to an aliphatic or aromatic carbon atom, or the like. It should be noted that such bond forming reaction is not restricted to the examples given above, and that there is no prejudice regarding which individual function should be present in the respective molecules to become the respective components, etc. A person skilled in the art will immediately know which combinations of functional groups will be required to form a corresponding chemical bond between the individual molecules to become the respective components of the probe compound, and also which starting materials and conditions etc. are required to form the desired chemical bond between the components. Another preferred covalent bond is a carbon- nitrogen single bond. Preferably, the carbon-nitrogen single bond is part of a quaternary amine function (quaternary ammonium function) comprised in the link between test component and indicator component. The link or bond between the test component and the indicator component may also be formed between the test component and a linker moiety previously attached to the indicator component, or vice versa. An additional linker moiety has the advantage to ensure an identical and reproducible binding to the test component, which allows for the ready use in parallel synthesis or the like. In a preferred embodiment, the indicator component comprises an amino butyric acid linker moiety, and a bond or link to the test component is formed using the carboxylic acid function of this linker moiety. Preferably, the link between indicator component and test component comprises a linker moiety comprising an amino butyric acid linker residue attached to the indicator component, the carboxylic acid function of which is linked to another linker moiety comprising a quaternary amine function, which in turn is linked to the test component. Such linker moiety can be formed, for example, by reacting an indicator component, e.g. a fluorescence dye, first with 4-amino-3-butanoate and then with N,N-dimethylethanolamine . Linking with the test component under formation of a quaternary amine can then be obtained by reacting the so- prepared indicator component having a linker moiety comprising an amino butyric acid residue, the carboxylic acid function of which is esterised by N, N- dimethylethanolamine, with a iodine-containing test component in the presence of 1 , 8-bis- (dimethylamino) - naphthalene, or a similar method.
The reactive component comprising the test component and the indicator component, which are linked to each other, optionally by a linker moiety or molecule, is in turn linked to the transition metal complex. Preferably, the reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex by two, three or four coordination bonds, and further preferred by exactly two coordination bonds. That means that at least one atom of the reactive component is a direct ligand atom of the transition metal atom of the transition metal complex, thus being part of the immediate coordination sphere of the central transition metal atom of the transition metal complex. The term "at least one atom of the reactive component" also includes an atom of a linker moiety, which can optionally be attached to either the test component or the indicator component. For example, in a preferred embodiment, a histidine molecule is attached as a linker moiety (His-tag) to the reactive component. In this case, the "at least one atom of the reactive component" can also indicate an atom of the His-tag, preferably a nitrogen atom of the imidazole ring system. Preferably, the reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex by two coordination bonds, wherein one ligand atom is an atom of the test component and the other ligand atom is an atom of the indicator component. In a preferred embodiment, the reactive component comprises a His-tag linked to the test component and a His-tag linked to the indicator component. In this case, the reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex by two coordination bonds, wherein each bond includes one atom of one of the respective His- tags .
A preferred coordination bond between the reactive component and the transition metal complex is a M-O-R-bond, wherein M indicates the transition metal atom and O-R indicates an oxygen atom or function of a molecule R constituting the reactive component. Preferred examples of suitable oxygen functions are an alcoholate function (R-O') , a carboxylate function (RCOO") , a peroxide function (R-O-O"), or the like. Another preferred coordination bond between the reactive component and the transition metal complex is a M-N-R-bond, wherein M indicates the transition metal atom and N-R indicates a nitrogen atom or function of a molecule R constituting the reactive component. An example for such nitrogen function is an aliphaptic amine function, including a primary, secundary and tertiary amine function. The nitrogen atom can also be part of an aromatic or (partially) saturated ring system, such as, for example, a pyrrol, imidazole, diazole or triazole ring, or the like. A specially preferred coordination bond is a coordination bond comprising a nitrogen atom of an imidazole ring, which may be part of a histidine moiety or His-tag. Another preferred coordination bond is a M-S-R or a M-C-R single bond, wherein M indicates the transition metal atom and S and C, respectively, indicate a sulphur or carbon function of a molecule R constituting the reactive component. It should be noted that the coordination bond between reactive component and transition metal complex is not restricted to the examples given above, and that there is no prejudice regarding which individual function should be present in the respective molecules to form the desired coordination bond, etc. A person skilled in the art will immediately know which functional groups will be required to form a corresponding coordination bond, and also which starting materials and conditions etc. are required.
The transition metal complex preferably comprises at least one transition metal atom and at least one ligand molecule, wherein at least one coordination bond is formed between the ligand molecule and the transition metal atom. The at least one ligand molecule preferably comprises one or more atoms or funtions which can form a coordination bond with a transition metal atom. Preferred examples for atoms or function are an oxygen atom, a nitrogen atom, a phosphorous atom, a sulphur atom, or the like. These atom or functions all can form a coordination bond with a transition metal atom, and are the same as exemplified above. Preferably, a ligand molecule comprises more than one atom or function that can form a coordination bond with a transition metal atom, further preferred two to eight of such atoms or functions, still further preferred three to five of such atoms or functions, and most preferred four or five of such atoms of functions. In a preferred embodiment of the present invention, the transition metal complex comprises exactly one transition metal atom and exactly one ligand molecule comprising more than one atom or function that can form a coordination bond with a transition metal atom. Herein, the term "transition metal atom" is used to indicate the central transition metal atom of the transition metal complex, which is linked to both the, ligand molecule (s) and the reactive component by coordination bonds as defined above. Examples of suitable transition metal atoms are Ti, V, Mn, Fe, Co, Ni, Cu, Zn, Mo, W, Pt, Au, or the like. Preferred examples are Co, Ni, and Cu. The transition metal atom means any transition metal atom irrespective of its oxidation state. The term transition metal ion is also used for a transition metal atom that carries a net charge, which is sometimes referred to as a "transition metal ion" in the art, wherein a formal charge or oxidation state is assigned to the transition metal atom or ion. Preferred oxidation states of transition metal atoms of the present invention are from 0 to +4, preferably +2 to +3, and especially preferred +2. Preferred examples of transition metal atoms are Co(II), Ni(II) , and Cu(II) . Accordingly, the coordinating atoms or functions of the ligand molecule may be assigned with a formal charge, wherein preferred charges range from 0 to -2, wherein a charge of 0 or -1 is especially preferred. As used herein, the term "ligand molecule" refers to a molecule that comprises at least one atom or function which forms a direct coordination bond to the central atom of a transition metal complex, preferably one, two, three, four, five, six, seven, or eight such atoms or functions. It should be noted that the coordination bond between ligand molecule and transition metal atom is not restricted to the examples given above, and that there is no prejudice regarding which individual function should be present in the ligand molecule to form the desired coordination bond, etc. A person skilled in the art will immediately know which functional groups will be required to form a corresponding coordination bond, and also which starting materials and conditions etc. are required.
The term "probe compound" indicates a compound or molecule that can interact with an enzyme (or analyte molecule) in a reactive manner, as outlined in the following. The term 11 interaction with an enzyme in a reactive manner" indicates an interaction wherein the reactive component is not only bound to the enzyme, but also transformed in a reaction catalysed by the enzyme (metabolised) . The reaction catalysed by the enzyme can be any reaction catalysed by an enzyme, such as, for example, an oxidation or reduction reaction, an addition reaction, a hydrolytic bond cleaving reaction, an elimination reaction, an isomerisation reaction, or a condensation reaction.
Preferably, the reaction catalysed by the enzyme is a hydrolytic cleaving reaction or an elimination reaction, wherein the enzyme cleaves the link between the test component, or its reaction product, respectively, and the indicator component and/or the transition metal complex.
Preferably, the interaction with the enzyme results in a cleavage of the link between the test component and the transition metal complex by the enzyme, whereupon a reaction product comprising the metabolised test component and the indicator component together is formed. Further, the interaction with the enzyme may also result in a cleavage of both the link between the test component and the transition metal complex and the link between the test component and the indicator component by the enzyme, whereupon more than one reaction products comprising the metabolised test component and/or the indicator component in separate molecules, may be released from the probe compound. For example, in a preferred embodiment wherein the test component is linked to the transition metal complex by a histidine moiety (His-tag) , the link between the histidine is cleaved by the enzymatic reaction. As a result, the reaction product comprising both the test component and the indicator component remains linked to the transition metal complex, and thus to the remainder of the probe compound. The test component or the reaction product thereof may remain bound to the active site of the enzyme, thus immobilising the enzyme to the probe compound, or its reaction product, respectively. Moreover, the signal characteristic of the indicator component, which is triggered by the enzymatic reaction, also remains at the probe compound .
Alternatively, the interaction with the enzyme results in a cleavage of the link between the indicator component and the test component by the enzyme, resulting in a reaction product comprising the indicator component alone, or a reaction product comprising the metabolised test component and the indicator component together, or more than one reaction products comprising the metabolised test component and/or the indicator component in separate molecules. Here, the term "reaction product comprising the indicator component (or test component) " indicates a compound or molecule based on the indicator component or test component, respectively, which is metabolised and/or released by the corresponding reaction catalysed by the enzyme.
Alternatively, the interaction with the enzyme results in a cleavage of the both the link between the test component and the transition metal complex and the link between the test component and the indicator component by the enzyme, whereupon a reaction product comprising the metabolised test component, or more than one reaction products comprising the metabolised test component and/or the indicator component in separate molecules, may be released from the probe compound. For example, in a preferred embodiment wherein the test component is linked to the transition metal complex by a histidine moiety (His-tag) , the link between the histidine is cleaved by the enzymatic reaction, and the link to the indicator component is cleaved as well.
Preferably, the reaction product comprising the indicator component is not released from the probe compound, i.e. the reaction product comprising the indicator component remains part of the probe compound, or its reaction product, respectively. For example, in a preferred embodiment wherein the indicator component is linked to the transition metal complex by a histidine moiety (His-tag) , the histidine remains linked to both the transition metal complex and the indicator component upon enzymatic cleavage of the link between the test component and the indicator component . As a result, the reaction product comprising the indicator component remains linked to the transition metal complex, and thus to the remainder of the probe compound. Thereby, the signal characteristic of the indicator component, which is triggered by the enzymatic reaction, also remains at the probe compound . Preferably, the reaction product comprising the test component is not released from the probe compound. For example, in a preferred embodiment wherein the test component is linked to the transition metal complex by a histidine moiety (His-tag) , only the link between the histidine and the test component is cleaved by the enzyme. As a result, the reaction product comprising both the test component and the indicator component remains linked to the transition metal complex, and thus to the remainder of the probe compound. Thereby, the test component or the reaction product thereof may remain bound to the active site of the enzyme, thus immobilising the enzyme to the probe compound, or its reaction product, respectively. Moreover, the signal characteristic of the indicator component, which is triggered by the enzymatic reaction, also remains at the probe compound .
Preferably, the interaction of the probe compound with an enzyme results in the cleavage of both the links between transition metal complex and the reactive component as well as the link between the test component and the indicator component. This in turn exposes the transition metal atom which then ligates the enzyme, which can be used to immobilize the enzyme on an array spot or the like. The released indicator component has a changed binding situation which may preferably result in the generation of a signal.
The exact nature of all reaction products has not been revealed yet, but it is observed that an enzyme -specific reaction of the probe compound of the invention results in binding of the enzyme to the transition metal complex and the generation of a signal by the indicator component, e.g. the generation of a fluorescence signal .
It was found that the probe compound of the present invention allows for the detection of enzyme concentrations which are as low as 1.5 ng/ml protein or 2.5 pmol/ml substrate, respectively.
It was found that the probe compound of the invention advantageously allows for the testing of a reactive interaction of an enzyme with a small molecule or enzymatic substrate. The presence of the central transition metal complex further allows to provide a probe compound wherein all small molecules or substrates necessary for the life functions of an organism or communities living in a habitat can be readily included. Information about substrates that are involved in one or more metabolic reactions and about the enzymes involved in the corresponding metabolic reactions may be found, for example, in the Kyoto Encyclopedia of Genes and Genomes (KEGG Database) , the University of Minnesota Biocatalysis and Biodegration Database (UM-BBD) , PubMed, or the like. The probe compound of the invention was shown to be highly versatile for the identification of the reactive interaction with any small molecule or substrate tested so far. The key characteristic of the probe compound is that a productive reaction with a cognate enzyme releases the indicator component, producing a detectable signal, e.g. a fluorescent signal, and simultaneously results in the capture of the reacting enzyme through coordination with the transition metal complex. Nonproductive interactions of proteins with the probe compound, such as, for example, binding without chemical reaction, do not lead to the release of the indicator component and the associated production of a detectable signal. An example of this reactional behaviour is shown in Figure 3. The probe compound provides a highly sensitive, accurate, reproducible, and robust high-throughput tool for a genome- wide analysis of the metabolic status of an organism or community. Advantageously, the complete reactome (i.e. the complement of metabolic reactions of an organism) can be provided without prior knowledge of its sequence in as little time as 30 minutes or less.
Preferably, the transition metal complex comprises a cobalt or copper atom, and most preferred a cobalt atom. It was found that a cobalt or copper complex shows an advantageous binding property to all reactive components of interest, thus allowing for a most versatile use of the probe component of the invention. Especially preferred is a cobalt complex wherein the central cobalt atom is assigned a formal oxidation state of +2.
Preferably, the transition metal complex comprises a multidentate ligand molecule, i.e. a ligand molecule comprising two or more ligand atoms bound to the central transition metal atom. Further preferred, the transition metal complex comprises a multidentate ligand molecule comprising two, three, four, five, or six ligand atoms bound to the central transition metal atom. Especially preferred, the transition metal complex comprises a multidentate ligand molecule whose coordinating ligand atoms do not occupy all possible coordination positions of the central transition metal atom. For example, in the case of a central cobalt atom (Co2+) , which usually exhibits coordination numbers of five or six, the multidentate ligand may occupy five, four or three of the potential coordination (binding) positions. Thus, a preferred ligand molecule for a central cobalt atom should provide three, four, or five coordinating ligand atoms, especially preferred four coordinating ligand atoms. A preferred example for a ligand molecule is a molecule comprising at least one coordinating nitrogen atom, such as, for example, a nitrogen atom of an aliphatic amine function, and at least one coordinating oxygen atom, such as, for example, an oxygen of a carboxilic acid function. A preferred example for a ligand molecule comprises nitrotriacetic acid. For example, in the case of a central cobalt atom, a ligand molecule based on nitrotriacetic acid will occupy four of the five or six potential coordination or binding positions, thus leaving one or two free binding positions for binding of the reactive component. However, a person skilled in the art will readily know which other ligand molecules exhibit similar properties and thus can also be used in the present invention.
Preferably, the transition metal complex comprises an anchoring component. The term "anchoring component" indicates a molecule or function that can be used to attach the probe compound to a solid surface, or to another component or molecule, or the like. Thus, the transition metal complex, and thereby the whole probe compound, can be attached to any suitable solid surface, or component or ' molecule, known in the art. Suitable solid surfaces may be porous surfaces, such as, for example, paper or cellulose substrates or the like, or non-porous surfaces, such as, for example, glass surfaces, or surfaces of polymeric materials, such as a surface of polycarbonate, or the like. For example, the anchoring component can be used to attach the probe compound to the surface of a glass slide in order to form an array thereon. Alternatively, the anchoring component can be used to attach the reactive compound to another component, such as, for example, a nanoparticle . The anchoring component may be any molecule or function known in the art which has the desired function to allow for the attachment to a solid surface, another component or molecule, or the like. A person skilled in the art will readily know which molecule or function should be used for a desired attachment . Preferably, the anchoring component comprises a polymeric compound, further preferred a polymeric compound of a biomolecule. A specially preferred anchoring component comprises a poly A chain, i.e. a polymer of adenosin. Any poly A chain known in the art may be used. Preferably, the poly A chain has a molecular weight of from 10 kDa to 150 kDa, further preferred of from 50 kDa to 120 kDa, and most preferred of about 100 kDa. A poly A chain is known in the art for binding to glass surfaces, activated silica, or the like. A poly A chain can be easily attached to a glass surface or the like, which might be optionally activated, and polymerised thereon using UV radiation according to standard protocols.
In another preferred embodiment of the anchoring component comprises at least one thiol function, which allows for the attachment to metal clusters, such as, for example, gold nanoparticles . However, another function which is known to bind to a desired metal cluster or nanoparticle can also be used. A compound which has a carboxylate group or a phosphate group in one moiety and a thiol group in the other moiety is preferably used. A preferred example for an anchoring component comprising thiol functions is an α- dihydrolipoic acid residue (or a 6 , 8-dithioctic acid residue, TA) . Depending on the nature of the surface of the metal cluster or nanoparticle to be used, i.e. either depending on the nature of the metal surface itself, or depending on the nature of a first activation or coordination layer, a skilled person will know which anchoring compound should to use to form an anchoring link in the sense of the invention.
Optionally, the anchoring component is linked to the transition metal complex by a suitable spacer component or moiety, such as, for example, an aliphatic hydrocarbon chain having at least one suitable functional group (s) for linking, such as, for example, a pentyl moiety having an amino group, or the like.
The anchoring component is directly linked to the transition metal complex. Preferably, the anchoring component is linked to the transition metal complex by a covalent bond, which is formed between an atom of the anchoring component and the ligand molecule of the transition metal complex. The anchoring component can also be linked to the transition metal complex by a coordination bond, which is formed between an atom of the anchoring component and the central transition metal atom of the transition metal complex. Especially preferred, the multidentate ligand of the transition metal complex comprises the anchoring component .
In a preferred embodiment of the probe compound of the present invention, the transition metal complex comprises a nitrotriacetic acid Co(II) complex. It was found that the presence of this transition metal complex allows for the most versatile adaptation of the probe compound for the identification of the reactive interaction with any small molecule or substrate tested so far. A preferred transition metal complex comprising an anchoring component is provided by using the compound Nα,Nα-bis- (carboxymethyl) -L- lysine, or (S) -N- (5-amino-l-carboxypentyl) -imino-diacetic acid, respectively, as a ligand molecule for forming a cobalt (II) complex. In the so-formed cobalt complex, the aminopentyl residue, which is attached to one of the acetic acid groups of the ligand molecule, constitutes an anchoring component or a spacer moiety for attaching another anchoring component. The amine function of this anchoring component itself can be readily used to attach the transition metal complex, and thus the whole probe compound, to another component or molecule, such as, for example, a nanoparticle . Moreover, the amine function of this anchoring component can also be used to further attach a polymeric chain, such as, for example, a poly A chain, which can be used to attach the transition metal complex, and thus the whole probe compound, to a solid surface, such as, for example, a glass slide, in order to advantageously manufacture an array comprising corresponding probe compounds .
Thus, the term "probe compound" indicates a compound or molecule that can be immobilised on a supporting base by the anchoring component .
Preferably, the indicator component comprises a fluorescence dye, further preferred a fluorescent azo compound or a cyanine compound, examples of which are known in the art under the names of "Cy3" or "Cy5" or the like. By using this well-established dyes, it is possible to use the corresponding hardware available commercially, such as, for example, wave-length optimised reader apparatuses, corresponding software solutions, and the like. However, a person skilled in the art will understand that the present invention can easily be adopted to other indicator components and/or detection systems, if required. A person skilled in the art will also know how to carry out such adaptation.
Preferably, the test component comprises a known substrate, a metabolite, a pseudo-substrate, or an inhibitor of an enzyme. Further preferred, the test component comprises a molecule identified as a substrate of at least one metabolic reaction in the Kyoto Encyclopedia of Genes and Genomes (KEGG Database) , the University of Minnesota Biocatalysis and Biodegration Database (UM-BBD) , PubMed, or the like. Further preferred, the test component comprises a compound selected from the group listed in Table 1, 2 and 3, respectively.
By using such test components, it is possible to prepare probe compounds according to the invention which collectively form most of the central metabolic networks of cellular systems. However, the test component may also comprise additional metabolites characteristic of microbial metabolic activities not yet assigned or included in these databases, as well as
In a specially preferred embodiment of the probe compound of the present invention, the transition metal complex is represented by the Nα,Nα-bis- (carboxymethyl) -L-lysine cobalt (II) complex, which may further comprise an anchoring component comprising a poly A chain or a 6, 8-dithioctic acid (TA) linked to the free amine function of the ligand molecule. In this embodiment, an indicator component comprises a Cy3 fluorescent dye, which comprises a histidine moiety (His-tag) for linking to the transition metal complex and a aminobutyric acid moiety as an optional linker moiety for linking to the test component. The test component may comprise any enzymatic substrate or other suitable small organic molecule, for example, one of the substrates listed in Table 1. The test component is linked to the indicator component via the optional aminobutyric acid linker moiety and further comprises a histidine moiety (His-tag) for linking to the transition metal complex. Preferably, the link between the test component and the indicator component further comprises a quaternary amine function. By choosing the appropriate position for introducing the histidine moiety, the involvement of one substrate in different metabolic pathways can be detected by the probe compound. Preferred positions for binding the histidine moiety are shown in Table 2. The so-formed reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex by two coordination bonds, one of which comprises the His-tag linked to the test component, while the other comprises the His-tag of the indicator component. It was surprisingly found that, if the reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex, the characteristic fluorescence activity of the indicator component is no longer observed. In other words, the probe compound remains silent with respect to the characteristic fluorescence signal. This would result in a dark spot in an assay or array position. When the probe compound is brought into contact with an enzyme having a function specific to the test component or substrate comprised in the probe compound, the test component or substrate is metabolised. It was surprisingly found that this enzymatic reaction has two effects. First, the characteristic fluorescence signal of the indicator component is observed again, and second, the enzyme remains bound to the transition metal compound. Thus, the probe compound allows for the unambiguous detection of the specific enzymatic reaction by flurescence detection. Moreover, the probe compound allows for an immobilisation of the substrate-specific enzyme, which can be advantageously used to isolate this enzyme from a sample.
In case of a probe compound of the invention comprising a Cy3 dye, it is observed that the the fluorescence dye is quenched, i.e. does no longer emit its characteristic fluorescence signal, if the reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex to form the probe compound of the invention. In any other form, the dye emits its characteristic fluorescence signal and cannot be used to detect productive enzymatic reactions. Only when a productive enzymatic reaction occurs between an enzyme and the probe compound of the invention, the dye is released and the fluorescence is observed. This behaviour of the probe compound of the invention is the major difference to standard systems such as the labelling of proteins with a dye or DNA with a dye to produce protein arrays or DNA arrays, respectively, because the dye is permanently fluorescent in those cases.
The probe compound according to the above-discussed preferred embodiment of the invention can be illustrated by the following general formula (2) :
His - tag - TC / \
AC - LAC-MC - MC Lτc-ic Formula ( 2 ] \ /
His - tag - IC
wherein AC represents an optional anchoring component, preferably poly A or TA, MC represents the Nα,Nα-bis- (carboxymethyl) -L-lysine cobalt (II) complex, TC represents the test component, IC represents the fluorescence dye Cy3 , His-tag represents a histidine moiety as described above, and LAC-Mc and LTC-ic each represent optional linker moieties between the respective components indicated by the subscripts. Preferably, the Lτc-ic linker moiety comprises a quartenary amine function.
Although the exact mechanisms involved in these reactions are not completely understood yet, it is believed that the linking of the reactive component to the transition metal complex influences the indicator component in such a manner that its electronic structure necessary for its characteristic fluourescence signal is disturbed. The reaction of the enzyme with the test component or substrate is believed to alter or break down the reactive component, which influences the binding properties of the reactive component or its respective metabolised products, respectively, to the transition metal complex. Thereby, the adverse effect on the indicator component is no longer present so that the indicator component can again exhibit its characteristic fluorescence signal. Moreover, this enzymatic alteration or break down of the reactive component may also create new binding sites at the reactive component and/or the transition metal complex, which result in the binding of the enzyme .
The present invention also provides a method for preparing the probe compound. The method for preparing the probe compound of the invention comprises the following steps :
a) Preparing a transition metal complex by reacting a suitable salt of a transition metal with a desired ligand molecule, optionally comprising an anchoring component. Herein, the appropriate conditions of solvent, pH, temperature and the like can be chosen according to known procedures. If necessary, the thus-obtained transition metal complex can be further purified by standard procedures, such as, for example, filtration, re-crystallisation, or the like. In a preferred embodiment, Nα,Nα-bis- (carboxymethyl) - L-lysine is reacted with cobalt (II) chloride to form the corresponding complex.
b) If an anchoring component is desired, it may also be incorporated at this stage. For example, in a preferred embodiment, the above cobalt (II) complex of the Nα,Nα-bis- ( carboxymethyl) -L-lysine ligand may be reacted with a suitably activated poly A chain or with 6 , 8-dithioctic acid, or the like.
c) In a separate reaction, a substrate molecule to be incorporated in the test component is coupled to an indicator component, optionally including a linker moiety. If necessary, either one or both of the test component and indicator component is previously transferred into an activated form suitable for coupling, according to standard techniques. Herein, the appropriate conditions of solvent, pH, temperature and the like can be chosen according to known procedures. For example, a Cy3 dye available as its Cy3-NHS-ester may be reacted with a 4 -amino-3 -butyric acid linker to allow for linking with the test component. Preferably, a linker moiety between the test component and the indicator component comprises a quaternary amine function (a quartenary ammonium nitrogen atom) . If necessary, the thus-obtained reactive component can be further purified by standard procedures, such as, for example, filtration, re-crystallisation, or the like.
d) Optionally, the test component and/or the indicator component is functionalised with a moiety suitable for binding to the transition metal complex, either before or after formation of the reactive component. Such functionalisation is especially advantageous for indicator components or test components, which do not readily form coordination bonds. In a preferred embodiment, the test component and/or the indicator component is functionalised with a histidine molecule (sometimes referred to as a "His- tag" in the following) . A His-tag has the additional advantage to ensure an identical binding property of all possible test components (substrates) and/or indicator components (dyes) to the transition metal complex.
e) In a subsequent step, the so-prepared reactive component comprising the test component and the indicator component is linked to the transition metal complex to form the probe compound according to the present invention. Herein, the appropriate conditions of solvent, pH, temperature and the like can be chosen according to known procedures. If necessary, the thus-obtained probe compound can be further purified by standard procedures, such as, for example, filtration, re-crystallisation, or the like.
The method comprises the steps a) , c) and e) , and the optional steps b) and/or d) , if desired. The optional steps b) and d) can be carried out at any stage of the method. For example, step d) may be carried out before step c) , or subsequent to step b) , and step b) may be carried out before step a) , subsequent to step a) , or subsequent to step e) , respectively. In a preferred embodiment, the individual steps are carried out in the order of steps a) , b) , d) , c, and e) . Alternatively, the steps may be carried out in the order of steps b) , a) , c) , d) , and e) , or in the order of steps a) , d) , c) , e) , and b) . A person skilled in the art will know which order and conditions are most suitable for the respective task.
Preferably, the step for linking the indicator component to the test component and/or the step for linking the histidine residue to the test component involves an activation of the test component by specific halogenation with iodine (I) . For example, a selected position (atom or group) of the substrate or metabolite component comprised in the test component is selectively halogenated with iodine. This can be done by standard chemical reactions or enzymatically . The halogenated position allows for substitution reactions replacing the iodine atom by the corresponding component or residue .
The present invention also provides an array for detecting enzymes comprising a plurality of different probe compounds according to the invention. The array comprises a plurality of different probe compounds according to the invention (sometimes referred to as library of probe compounds in the following) , i.e. probe compounds according to the invention which differ at least with respect to the test component comprised therein. Preferably, the probe compounds only differ with respect to the test component comprised therein. A plurality of different probe compounds can be prepared using automatic procedures, for example, parallel synthesis protocols and apparatuses, or the like. The term "comprising a plurality of different probe compounds" means at least two different probe compounds, and may comprise up to several thousands different probe compounds. For example, apparatuses and protocols, which are known and commercially available at the moment, allow the standard production of arrays based on glass slides wherein from 5000 to 15000 different probe compounds may be deposited on a single glass slide by micro-spotting techniques, or the like. In a preferred embodiment, about 2500 different probe compounds are included in the array (cf . example) . Alternatively, the array may be constructed using a plate providing separate compartments or wells, such as, for example, a micro- titre plate, which is commercially available with, e.g., 384 wells, or different numbers of wells. A complete array may comprise one or more slides or plates depending on the actual number of probe compounds included in the array, as well as on the density available on the respective medium. Preferably, an array comprises more than one copy of a library of probe compounds on one or more supports. For example, a library or sub-library of probe compounds may be provided in duplicate or triplicate on one support or slide.
In one embodiment of the array, the plurality of probe compounds is attached to a planar surface of a suitable support or carrier. A support may be any support used in the art, preferred examples of which are glass surfaces, preferably of glass slides, surfaces of polymeric materials, such as polyacetate surfaces, or the like, or surfaces of cellulose or paper materials, or the like. In order to be attached to a solid surface, such as, for example, the glass surface of a glass slide, the probe compounds are provided with a suitable anchoring component. A preferred anchoring component known from the art is a poly A chain or tail, which can be readily attached onto a glass surface or the like following standard protocols using irradiation by UV light. Other suitable solid surfaces and corresponding anchoring components as well as protocols for their use are known in the art, and a person skilled in the art will be able to select an appropriate combination. For example, when using polymeric supports, it is advantageous for the bonds between the probe molecules and the polymeric support to be chemical bonds, especially covalent chemical bonds, which allow a long-lasting, stable bond between the probe molecules and the polymeric support .
In the case of using a well plate, the probe compounds do not necessarily require an anchoring component because they can be held in the respective wells without attachment to the wall . Preferably, probe compounds are attached to the walls of a well of a well plate. Therefor, all methods known in the art may be used.
The array of the invention (which is sometimes referred to as "reactome array") can be used for the simultaneous detection of reactive interactions between the probe compounds and all analyte molecules (enzymes) from a sample. In particular, the array provides a solution to the problem of the identification of metabolites and the enzymes involved in their transformation. The array provides a fast and reliable way to detect all metabolic pathways active in an organism or community, and may be used advantageously for an activity-based, annotation- independent procedure for the global assessment of cellular responses.
The invention also provides a method for producing an array according to the invention. An array may be produced using well plates, such as commercially micro-titre plates, wherein each probe compound of the plurality of different probe compounds according to the invention is filled into an individual well, together with appropriate amounts of solvent, cofactors, cations, supplements, or the like, which are known or predicted to be required for the expected enzyme reaction. The filling of the wells may be carried out automatically, e.g. by a suitable robotic apparatus, or the like. Alternatively, the array is preferably produced using different probe compounds, which all comprise the same anchoring component. The different probe compounds having an anchoring component are then arranged onto an appropriate support surface, e.g. the surface of a glass slide, and subsequently bound thereto with the anchoring component . The arranging and binding of the different probe components may be carried out automatically, e.g. using a suitable robotic apparatus, or the like, and following established procedures and protocols. In a preferred embodiment, different probe compounds comprising a poly A chain as an anchoring component are spotted onto a glass slide by using a robotic apparatus, and subsequent fixation is achieved by cross- linking the poly A tails according to an established protocol using UV radiation. However, several other methods for arranging and fixing the different probe molecules onto a suitable support surface are known in the art . Using the method of the invention allows for a versatile, fast and reproducible production of arrays according to the invention.
Moreover, the invention also provides an isolation means comprising a nanoparticle and a probe compound according to the invention. A probe compound is preferably provided with a suitable anchoring component and attached to a nanoparticle. The term "nanoparticle" means a particle having a maximum dimension of less than 500 nm, preferably of less than 300 nm, and most preferred of about 100 nm. A minimum dimension is about 10 nm, preferably about 50 nm. A maximum or minimum dimension of a nanoparticle refers to the diameter in the case of a spherical nanoparticle. Examples for suitable nanoparticles are known in the art, as well as methods for producing the same, or anchoring components for linking the probe compound to the same. The probe compound may be linked to any nanoparticle known in the art, preferably a magnetic nanoparticle. Preferably, a nanoparticle comprises one or more metallic elements, including the transition metal elements. Preferred examples of nanoparticles comprise metallic elements, either pure metallic elements, such as, for example gold nanoparticles, or alloys comprising different metallic elements, or oxides of metallic elements, such as, for example, iron oxides, or the like. Preferred oxidic nanoparticles may comprise silicon, e.g. in form of silicon oxide. Moreover, preferred nanoparticles may also have a layered structure, e.g. an oxidic core coated by a metallic layer, such as a gold- coated silicon oxide nanoparticle, or a metallic core coated by an oxidic layer, such as a cobalt core coated with an iron oxide layer. For example, the synthesis and application of suitable magnetic gold nanoparticles is described by Abad et al. in J. Am. Chem. Soc . 127, 5689 (2005) . Preferably, a nanoparticle has a magnetic property. A preferred anchoring component for linking a probe molecule to a magnetic gold nanoparticle is 6 , 8-dithioctic acid or α-dihydrolipoic acid, respectively, which advantageously may be linked to a transition metal complex comprising the cobalt (II) complex of Nα,Nα-bis- (carboxymethyl) -L-lysine (ANTA-Co(II)) by forming an amide bond between the carboxylic acid function of the 6 , 8-dithioctic acid and the amine function of the ligand molecule. The isolation means according to the invention allows for the substrate specific interaction and binding of an enzyme which can then be isolated by means of filtration, gravitation force (centrifugation) , an external magnetic force in case of a magnetic nanoparticle, or the like. It was found that, owing to the substrate specific binding of an enzyme by the probe compound, the isolation means of the invention allows for the directed isolation of an enzyme because of its substrate specificity.
The invention also provides a method for producing a isolation means according to the invention. In this method, a probe compound comprising a suitable anchoring component is prepared according to the method of producing a probe compound according to the invention, and subsequently attached to a suitable nanoparticle prepared according to known methods. Preferably, the probe compound is attached to a magnetic nanoparticle. The method according to the invention provides an easy access to an isolation means having specific binding sites for an enzyme.
Moreover, the invention also provides a method for detecting enzymes in a substrate specific manner, using the probe compound according to the invention or the array according to the invention. An array comprising a plurality of different probe compounds is prepared according to the method of the invention. The array can preferably comprise more than one copy of the respective library of probe compounds, either by providing the library on one support or slide in duplicate or triplicate or in more copies, or by providing more than one support or slide comprising identical sets or libraries of probe compounds. The array is then brought in contact with a sample comprising the analyte molecules, i.e. the enzymes whose substrate specific activity is to be tested. This step is also referred to as incubation with a sample. A sample in the context of the method includes any kind of solution of analyte molecules
(enzymes) that can enter into an enzymatic reaction with the probe compounds on the array. These include especially biological samples obtained from the lysis of cells of bacteria, archeae, or higher organisms, but also from biological fluids such as blood, serum, secretions, lymph, dialysate, liquor, sap, body fluid from insects, worms, maggots, etc. Also included is extraction from natural sources such as biopsies, animal and plant organs or parts, cell, insect, worm, bacteria, microbe and parasitic matter as well as supernatants of cell cultures and of bacterial, microbial or parasitic cultures. A sample may also be a chemical-synthetic sample containing, for example, synthetic proteins, or the like. After incubation is complete, the sample is removed from the array. In order to obtain a complete removal of the sample, the array may be washed one or more times. Then, the array is analysed for the presence of the signal characteristic for the indicator component. Preferably, a fluorescence signal is read out and processed by a suitable apparatus, which is available in the art. All protocols and procedures known in the art may be used, including automatic processing by robotic apparatuses and the like. In a preferred embodiment, using an array comprising probe compounds comprising a Cy3 fluorescence dye, the fluorescence signal is preferably measured using a laser scanning system.
The method of the invention using the array of the invention allows to assess the complete reactome of an organism or community in one step. That is, all substrate specific enzymatic reactions which are performed within the metabolic pathways necessary for the individual life form(s) is readily accessible. This advantageously allows for the accurate reconstruction of metabolic pathways.
Moreover, the invention also provides a method for isolating enzymes using the isolation means according to the invention. According to the method, the nanoparticles are used to isolate enzymes which are bound to the isolation means by the probe molecules after the substrate specific enzymatic reaction. The reaction can be carried out under the same conditions as described above for the array of the invention, including all processes and protocols that are known in the art. Preferably, the isolation means is brought into contact with a sample comprising analyte molecules (enzymes) that can enter into an enzymatic reaction with the probe compounds on the isolation means. The isolation means carrying the enzymes are then isolated by magnetic means or by filtration. The isolated enzymes can then be analysed using standard techniques, such as, for example, sequence analysis, mass spectrometry, or the like. Identification of enzymes whose function is verified by the specific reaction with the probe compound of the invention allows for the detection of metabolic pathways as well as for the correct annotation of unsequenced genes and/or unknown proteins or enzymes. The method can be used to complete the metabolic pathway map of all life forms, as well as specialised parts thereof. The method can also be used to reconstruct the global metabolism of complete communities living in distinct natural (microbial) communities. Moreover, the method of the invention can be advantageously- used in the search for new drugs, in particular in screening for potential new targets: here the guiding principle is selective toxicity, so the search is for molecular targets in the target organism that do not exist in a human. The method of the invention is also useful for the identification of drugs that are specific for certain pathogens, so that treatment of an infected patient would not result in the elimination of a major part of the body flora, as is currently the case with common broad spectrum antibiotics, and all the negative consequences of this that ensue. Using the array to obtain reactome profiles of the representatives of the major phyla of life allows their comparison and identification of individual reactions/enzymes that are specific for each branch or clusters of branches. Some of these phylum-specific functions will be known already, but others may be new: such metabolic reactions/enzymes may then serve as newly- discovered targets for drug screening. For example, the comparison of the human reactome with the composite reactome of bacteria and archaea may identify new targets for broad spectrum antibiotics, or the comparison of the reactomes of the various bacterial phyla may reveal potential targets specific for individual phyla, such as those to which, e.g., Neissseria, Pseudomonas, Mycobacterium, Vibrio, Staph,
Strep, Pneumo, coliforms belong, providing a route to more specific, narrow spectrum antibiotics. Moreover, the comparison of reactomes of photosynthetic organisms may identify new targets for herbicides specific for, e.g., moss, or algae, or monocots, or dicots etc. that would allow the development of new generation anti-moss treatments that would not affect other plants, anti -algal treatments not active against other plants, etc., etc. Moreover, the comparison of the reactomes of insect vectors of disease (mosquito, black fly, etc) with those of other insects, humans etc. could identify vector-specific targets.
In other words, the present invention provides a versatile tool for obtaining information on the reactomes of all major branches of the tree of life which can be advantageously used in future drug development. Through the selective inhibition of pathogens, there become available a lot of applications involving the selective inhibition of specific microbial populations, either because they are known to be problematic, or simply to test experimentally their contribution to a particular process (e.g. the role of a particular GI tract organism in a particular GI physiological role, like folate production, the role of a particular rhizosphere organism in protection from fungal infections, etc.) . Thus the array provides the means of identifying phylum-specific metabolic targets for inhibitors that, in turn, can be used to inhibit specifically those phyla in microbial communities to assess their role in a particular process.
The use of the reactome array of the invention for identifying new targets can be applied from human medicine to agriculture to dental medicine to shipping (anti-algal compounds to prevent algal fouling; anti- sulphate reducer compounds to prevent corrosion of steel) to construction (e.g. anti-sulphate reducer compounds to prevent corrosion of steel) , etc., and to research tools (agonists/antagonists for all manner of selected life forms) .
The present invention provides a procedure to measure on an array, enzymatic activities of cells against many of the standard substrates and metabolites that characterize life, plus other substrates of interest . Because of the chemical design of the substrates of the array, the array provides the identity of the reaction, the reaction products and, in a subsequent step, the enzyme itself. It therefore links a substrate/metabolite with its cognate enzyme. The reactome array thus forges a thus far missing link between metabolome and genome. Since many of the metabolites on the array are connected in pathways, it is also possible to reconstruct the metabolic network operating in any organism without any prior genomic information.
The use of the array to investigate the reactome of a microbial community is particularly interesting. The array represents a new possibility to have a metabolic overview of an entire community, without perturbing it in any way prior to preparation of the community lysate for analysis. And, in cases where it is difficult to obtain sufficient biomass for direct analysis, it is even possible to obtain a small molecule microarray analysis of a metagenomic library of a
DNA sample of a community or enrichment and thereby obtain a detailed overview of the global metabolism of the sampled community. The reactome analysis described here uncovered new metabolic activities in organisms and communities (46 new functions in P. putida KT2440 and five in metagenomic communities, including a novel hydrogenase; cf . Table 4 and Figures 6 and 7, SEQ ID NOS. 13 to 16, 21 to 24, 29 to 32, 38 to 43, and 50 to 54) , which not only provide interesting opportunities for new lines of investigation, but also revealed new metabolic components of niche specificity and predominant microbial pathways shaping the overall metabolism of the individual habitats. Especially, the hydrogenase (cf. Table 4 and Fig. 7, SEQ ID NOS. 50 to 54) , which is a rather small enzyme, may be of interest in the field of energy production. Moreover, a novel reBr halogenase/dehalogenase, i.e. a multifunctional α/β- hydrolase, was mined from a metagenome library of a microbial community in seawater contamined with petroleum hydrocarbons, with a novel hydrolytic phenotype, namely the cleavage of both 'common' p-nitrophenyl (pNP) esters and haloalkanoates, and weak activity towards haloalkanes (paper in preparation, SEQ. ID. NOS. 57 to 59) . This halogenase/dehalogenase enzyme was found to be useful for the introduction of iodine into the test component in the syntheses of the probe compounds of the present invention.
Since a physico-chemical analysis of habitats is rather selective in terms of the parameters measured, detection limits defined by the instruments used, and usually does not discriminate between bioavailable and non-bioavailable levels, whereas the array scores most of the metabolic potential of the cell or community in relation to the prevailing conditions and bioavailable fraction of compounds, another application of the array is the habitat characterization by metabolic profiling. This type of application can also be used in diagnosis of diseases/intake of drugs/toxic substances that influence metabolic activities of the microbial flora, through reactome analysis of faecal/skin biota, forensic analyses of diverse types (e.g. groundwater pollution), prospecting (e.g. for natural gas seeps that indicate underlying reservoirs) , detection of manufacturing sites of illegal substances, etc. Indeed, the design of custom arrays for use with particular organisms or communities will entrain a diverse spectrum of applications relating to enzyme activity profiles, including the phenotyping of organisms (microbes, plants, higher animals and humans), populations, mutant libraries and transgene libraries, the direct diagnosis of diseases and quality control in food industries, to cite some.
The present invention will be illustrated in more detail in the following examples, but it is not restricted to the special embodiments exemplified in these examples.
Commonly used chemical and molecular-biological working methods are not described in detail here, but they can be referred to in, for example, Houben-Weyl, Methods of Organic Synthesis .
EXAMPLES
EXAMPLE 1:
General techniques . Unless specified otherwise, reactions were carried out with dry solvents freshly purified by passage through a column of activated alumina (A-2) and supported copper redox catalyst (Q-5 reactant) . All other reagents were purified according to standard literature methods or used as obtained from commercial sources.
NMR spectra of all compounds were recorded at 600, 500, 400, or 300 MHz, using Varian 1-600, Varian 1-500, Varian M-400, Varian M-300, and Bruker Biospin 300 instruments. 1H NMR chemical shifts were reported relative to residual CHCl3 (7.26 ppm) . 13C NMR data were recorded at 125, 100, or 75 MHz, using Varian 1-500, Varian M-400, or Bruker Biospin 300 MHz instruments, respectively. 13C NMR chemical shifts are reported relative to the central line of CDCl3 (77.0 ppm) . 59Co NMR measurements were carried out at room temperature with Bruker ASX-200 [B0=A .7 T, Larmor frequency vo=48.1 and 52.9 MHz in 59Co resonance, Bruker MSL-300 [B0=I.! T, vo=71.2 and 79.4 MHz), and Bruker Avance DSX-500 (B0=Il.7 T, vo=12O.4 and 132.3 MHz) spectrometers. Single-pulse MAS spectra were obtained by using a Bruker MAS probe with a cylindrical 4 -mm o.d. rotor. When necessary, continuous -wave proton decoupling with a radiofrequency (RF) field of 50 kHz was applied during acquisition. Spinning frequencies vr up to 17 kHz were utilized. A short pulse length of 1 μs corresponding to a nonselective π/12 pulse determined using an aqueous or DMSO solution of small molecules (SMs) was employed. Recycle times were 1 and 90 s in 59Co. The baseline distortions resulting from the spectrometer dead time (5-10 μs) were removed computationally using a polynomial baseline correction routine. The dead-time problem was then overcome by Fourier transformation of the NMR signal, starting at the top of the first rotational echo .
Molecular masses were analyzed at the SIDI Core Facility of the Autonomous University of Madrid. For each experiment, a magnetic high resolution mass spectrometer (8000 v acceleration) was used, with ionization source FAB (LSIMS - liquid secondary ion mass spectrometry with Cs ions) using m-nitrobenzoic alcohol (m-NBA) as matrix. The samples (0.5- 1.2 g) were dissolved in acetone, methanol or DMSO, depending of the solubility of the SMs-Cy3. Microanalyses were performed by the SIDI Core Facility of the Autonomous University of Madrid, and are quoted to the nearest 0.1% for all elements, except for hydrogen, which is quoted to the nearest 0.05%. Reported atomic percentages are within the error limits of ± 0.3%.
For N- terminal amino acid sequencing, polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis under denaturing conditions (SDS-PAGE: 10%, v/v) was performed according to Laemmli (U.K. Laemmli, Nature 227, 680 (1970)) , using a Mini-PROTEAN cell apparatus (Bio-Rad) , and protein bands were blotted to a polyvinylidene difluoride (PVDF) membrane. The PVDF membrane was stained with Coomassie Brilliant Blue R-250, after which the bands of the proteins were cut out and processed for N- terminal amino acid sequencing. The peptide sequences were initially scored against blastp nr to identify the best hits among full-length proteins, and then converted into coding sequences and screened for potential protein encoding genes (PEGs) via tblastn and tblastx search (F. Stephen et al . , Nucleic Acids Res 25, 3389 (1997)) against the comprehensive non-redundant database sourced from the nucleotide (nr/nt) collection, reference genomic sequences (refseq_genomic) , whole genome shotgun reads (wgs) and environmental samples
(env_nt) databases. This was chosen empirically to increase the number of matching potentially coding elements. Based on the best BLAST hits, degenerate oligos were designed and used to amplify full length ORFs from the metagenome libraries.
EXAMPLE 2:
Bacterial strains, culture, and growth conditions.
E. coli DH5F' was used as a recipient for pGEMT plasmid (Promega) constructs containing cloned PCR fragments of P. putida KT2440 encoding hypothetical proteins and metagenomic proteins. E. coli TOPlO (Invitrogen) was used as a recipient for pCCFOS vector (EPICENTRE) constructs. E. coli cultures were grown in Luria-Bertani (LB) medium and incubated at 37°C on an orbital platform operating at 200 rpm. When required, cultures were supplemented with the following antibiotics: ampicillin (100 μg/ml) , nalidixic acid (10 μg/ml) and chloramphenicol (12.5 μg/ml) . P. putida KT2440 was grown in M9 minimal medium with 15 mM succinate as carbon source in 100-ml flasks shaken at 30 0C and 150 rpm from an initial turbidity at 600 nm of 0.02 to a final value of 0.7+0.05. Samples (3 ml) were removed, the cells harvested by centrifugation at 4°C, and the cell pellets were washed with 20 mM Hepes pH 7.0 before storing at -200C until use. EXAMPLE 3 :
General reactome strategy.
The general reactome strategy comprises five stages for array construction and protein-SMs transformation detection as follows (cf . Figures 1 to 3) .
[1] Data searching and compound identification
Initially, an extensive data mining effort, focused mainly on the Kyoto Encyclopedia of Genes and Genomes (KEGG Database: http://www.genome.ad.jp/kegg/), the University of Minnesota Biocatalysis and Biodegradation Database (UM-BBD: http : //umbbd.msi . utnn. edu/) and PubMed
(http : //www.ncbi . nlm. nih.gov/sites/entrez) , was undertaken to produce a list of compounds to be synthesized that are substrates of one or more metabolic reactions and that collectively form most of the central metabolic networks of cellular systems. Additional metabolites characteristic of microbial metabolic activities were also identified for synthesis .
[2] Compound synthesis, modification and arraying A library of 2483 identified SMs was synthesized using the strategies specified in Table 1. The purity of each SM was confirmed by NMR and molecular mass . Individual SMs were coupled to the Cy3 fluorescent dye and subsequently combined on specific positions to a nitrotriacetic-Co (II) complex containing a terminal poly A-tail (Table 2) . Importantly, during synthesis, the Cy3 dye is attached to the molecule at specific positions that allow control of the reaction product formed, through creating for each molecule different Cy3 -variants that collectively serve as substrates for all possible reactions described in KEGG; the array thus assays multiple distinct reactions of the same metabolite. The resulting derivatives were dissolved at different concentrations from 0.5 to 100 nM (six concentrations) in dimethyl sulfoxide (DMSO) and stored at -700C until use in 384-well microtiter plates. Each well also contained cofactors, cations and supplements known or predicted to be required for efficient transformations. The 2483 SMs included in this study, together with the position of modification with Cy3 are given in Tables 1 and 2. These procedures were also used to synthesize Cy3 -modified X-GaI (obtained from Boehringer Mannheim) , which was used as substrate for the β-galactosidase of E. coli (provided also by Boehringer Mannheim) . Individual SMs were subsequently spotted onto Corning UltraGAPS glass slides in a spatially addressable manner, by means of a MicroGridII spotting device from Biorobotics operating at 200C and 50% relative humidity, and subsequently immobilized by standard UV cross- linking .
[3] Array analysis and cell extract 60 μl quantities of cell lysates of microbial cultures, or libraries of metagenomic clones of microbial communities, diluted in PBS buffer to a final protein concentration of 0.1 mg/ml , were layered on the array, which was subsequently incubated at room temperature for 30 min.
[4] Data analysis and metabolic reconstruction Arrays were scanned for fluorescence with a GenePix 4000B scanner (Axon Instruments) operating at 532 nm at 10 μm resolution with 100% laser power, and images (spot and background intensities were quantified in triplicate or more) were analyzed using the GenePix v5.1 software (Axon Instruments) . Reconstruction of metabolic maps were carried out with GraphViz and SOI Linux software.
[5] Protein identification with gold beads
Proteins reacting with specific metabolites were identified by incubating a protein extract with metabolite-coated gold nano-particles, followed by protein sequencing of the captured proteins, reverse translation of the sequences into gene sequences, cloning of the corresponding genes, hyper- expression of the genes, and purification and characterization of the corresponding proteins.
EXAMPLE 4:
General procedure for the synthesis of probe compounds.
The general reaction strategy showing the successive steps for the construction "of Cy3 modified metabolites and their integration into probe compounds is described below.
1. Preparation of nitrilotriacetic-Co(II) complexes.
The amino-nitrilotriacetic-Co (II) complex was formed by reaction of NR,NR-b±s (carboxymethyl) -L-lysine hydrate (ANTA, Fluka) with an excess of cobalt (II) chloride (Sigma) in 20 mM HEPES in aqueous solution (36) . Excess cobalt was precipitated by increasing the pH to 10, and the precipitate was removed by filtration through a 0.2 μm membrane (PTFE, Amicon) .
2. Incorporation of poly(A) tails in nitrilotriacetic-Co(II) complexes (optional ).
Activation of the phosphate groups of the poly (A) tails (Sigma Genosys, average molecular weight: 100 kDa) and subsequent amidation with the Co(II) complex was performed by overnight incubation with 3 mM N-hydroxysuccinimide (NHS, Fluka) and 3 mM 1 -ethyl -3 - [3Φ- (dimethylamino) propyl] - carbodiimide (EDC, Sigma) in 20 mM HEPES buffer (pH 7.5) .
3. Generation of double activated Cy3 dye. Cyanine dye was linked via a histidine tag and a flexible linker through which the dye is linked to the Co(II) complex and the metabolite, respectively. Briefly, a histidine molecule was firstly incorporated to the Cy3 dye by enzymatic acidolysis of Cy3 NHS (a succinimidyl ester, GE Healthcare) with histidine and immobilized Lewatit lipase ELl (37) from a cow rumen metagenome (37.39 mol% incorporation of histidine in 24 h, at a ratio 1 histidine: 4 NHS ester) . 3-Methyl-2-butanol was used as solvent with a water content of up to 3.2%, and the reaction was carried out at 50-55 0C. High-performance preparative liquid chromatography was used to analyze and purify the products of the acidolysis reaction. Purified Cy3-His was dissolved in DMSO at a concentration up to 4 M and stored at -700C until use
In a second step, the Cy3-His was joined to a 4-amino-3- butyric acid linker. Briefly, the linker was dissolved in 0.1 M sodium borate buffer pH 8.5 and Cy3-His dissolved in a small amount of neutral water was added in aliquots until equimolar concentrations were reached. After incubation for 2 hours at room temperature, the labeled product was purified by reverse phase HPLC on a Chemcobond 5C18 ODS column (4.6 x 150 mm) . Elution was carried out with a linear gradient of 6% to 50% acetonitrile in 50 mM ammonium formate, pH 7.0, over a period of 30 min at a flow rate 1.0 mL/min, with monitoring of the eluate at 550 nm. The yield was 46%. HRMS (MALDI) calculated for C44H55N6OnS2 [M+] was 908.0906 and found was 908.0955. The Cy3-His-4-amino-3 - butyric acid (N/iV-dimethylamino) ethylester was synthesized by Lewatit lipase ELl-mediated esterification as described above. The final product was purified by reverse phase HPLC, as described above, except that the gradient was 6% to 80% acetonitrile. The yield was 0.1%. HRMS (MALDI) calculated for C53H64N9O13S2 [M+] was 1099.2815 and found was 1099.2841.
4. His -tagged metabolite library synthesis .
The primary synthetic challenge involved finding a reaction path from a functionalized core with the highest yield (>26- 90% overall) . The purified metabolites were characterized by NMR and HPLC and were found to be 90% pure,- yields were >20%. A number of standard strategies were employed, and new ones developed for the synthesis of compound libraries synthesized on solid supports or by parallel synthesis using separate reaction vessels. The full spectrum of synthesis methods used in the present study (as well as NMR and high resolution mass spectra) will be available to the community on our web server (http://biology.bangor.ac.uk/people/staff/025123) and are briefly described in Table 1, together with metabolite synthesis strategies. In some cases, the metabolites were directly purified from pure cultures using preparative HPLC (Waters 2795 XE) . The purity of each SM was confirmed by NMR and mass determination (see Table 1) . SMs were reconstituted and diluted in PBS buffer, DMSO or a mixture of both, accordingly to their solubility properties, and stored in 384-well microtiter plates at -700C until used. Metabolites were further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag at specific positions (SM-His; see Tables 1 to 3) using solid-solid and solid-liquid phase synthesis. General synthetic methods to incorporate His-tags to different metabolites (SM) are listed in the following.
Figure imgf000068_0001
5. Generation of His -tagged metabolite-Cy3 library.
Incorporation of the fluorescence dye in the metabolite was achieved by reaction of the SM-His molecules with activated Cy3-His-4-amino-3-butyric acid (iV, iV-dimethylamino) ethylester, using solid-solid and solid-liquid phase synthesis. The resulting library is composed of individual metabolites coupled at different positions to Cy3 dye molecules, both of which carry histidine tags. The coupling of Cy3 at different positions was designed to create the full spectrum of potential substrates needed to detect all possible catalytic reactions described in KEGG for a given core metabolite. Thus, each type of Cy3 substituent configuration determines the identity of the reaction and the reaction products. And, only when a reaction occurs at a specific position is the Cy3 dye released to give a fluorescent signal .
General synthetic methods to incorporate different His- tagged metabolites (SM) to the activated Cy3 are listed in the following.
Figure imgf000069_0001
6. Incorpora tion of His - tagged metaboli te -Cy3 derivatives to the poly(A ) -ni trilotriacetic -Co ( II ) complex. The final step in the array development is the incubation of the histidine functionalized Cy3-SM with poly(A)- nitrilotriacetic-Co (II) complexes in 50 mM phosphate buffer, 50 mM NaCl, pH 7.5 for 1 hour at 250C. When required, DMSO was added to increase substrate solubility. The resulting complexes were separated from unbound enzyme molecules by HPLC as described above. To ensure that each SM-Cy3 binds through both of its His residues, 59NMR was performed, and only derivatives incorporating single SM-Cy3 molecules were purified, and stored in 384 microtiter plates at -700C until used. These molecules were used directly for the construction of the array.
7. Binding of His-tagged metabolite-Cy3 derivatives to gold nanoparticles (optional).
Au-6 , 8-dithioctic acid (TA) clusters were synthesized as described by Abad et al . (Abad et al . in J. Am. Chem. Soc . 127, 5689 (2005)) and used to create Au-TA-ANTA-Co (II) -SMs- Cy3 clusters. Briefly, the Au-TA clusters were linked to the ANTA-Co (II) -SMs-Cy3 (prepared as described above) by overnight amidation in a single step in the presence of 3 mM N-hydroxysuccinimide (NHS, Fluka) and 3 mM l-ethyl-3- [3Φ- (dimethylamino) propyl] carbodiimide (EDC, Sigma) in 20 mM HEPES buffer (pH 7.5) . Further purification was carried out by ultrafiltration through low-adsorption hydrophilic 30000 NMWL cutoff membranes (regenerated cellulose, Amicon) .
SYNTHESIS EXAMPLE 1:
The following Synthesis Example 1 provides a complete synthesis of a probe compound comprising 5-bromo-4-chloro-3- indoyl-beta-galactopyranoside (X-GaI) as test component (SM) and Cy3 as indicator component . Both the test component and the indicator component are linked to a transition metal complex comprising cobalt by one histidine linker moiety each. Test component and indicator component are linked by 4 -amino-3 -butyric acid as a linker moiety. The so-prepared probe compound is used for the analysis of the sensitivity of the reactome array.
1. Preparation of nitrilotriacetic-Co (II) complexes. The amino-nitrilotriacetic-Co (II) complex was formed by reaction of NR1 i\7R-bis (carboxymethyl) -L-lysine hydrate (ANTA, Fluka) with an excess of cobalt (II) chloride (Sigma) in 20 mM HEPES in aqueous solution (J. M. Abad et al . , J Am Chem Soc 127, 5689 (2005) ) . Excess cobalt was precipitated by increasing the pH to 10, and the precipitate was removed by filtration through a 0.2 μm membrane (PTFE, Amicon) .
2 . Incorpora tion of poly (A) tail s in ni trilotriaceti c-Co (II) complexes .
Activation of the phosphate groups of the poly (A) tails (Sigma Genosys, average molecular weight: 100 kDa) and subsequent amidation with the Co(II) complex was performed by overnight incubation with 3 mM i\J-hydroxysuccinimide (NHS, Fluka) and 3 mM l-ethyl-3- [3Φ- (dimethylamino) propyl] - carbodiimide (EDC, Sigma) in 20 mM HEPES buffer (pH 7.5) .
3. Generation of double activated Cy3 dye.
Cyanine dye was linked via a histidine tag and a flexible linker through which the dye is linked to the Co(II) complex and the metabolite, respectively. Briefly, a histidine molecule was firstly incorporated to the Cy3 dye by enzymatic acidolysis of Cy3 NHS (a succinimidyl ester, GE Healthcare) with histidine and immobilized Lewatit lipase ELl (37) from a cow rumen metagenome (37.39 mol% incorporation of histidine in 24 h, at a ratio 1 histidine: 4 NHS ester) . 3-Methyl-2-butanol was used as solvent with a water content of up to 3.2%, and the reaction was carried out at 50-55 0C. High-performance preparative liquid chromatography was used to analyze and purify the products of the acidolysis reaction. Purified Cy3-His was dissolved in DMSO at a concentration up to 4 M and stored at -700C until use .
In a second step, the Cy3-His was joined to a 4-amino-3- butyric acid linker. Briefly, the linker was dissolved in
0.1 M sodium borate buffer pH 8.5 and Cy3-His dissolved in a small amount of neutral water was added in aliquots until equimolar concentrations were reached. After incubation for 2 hours at room temperature, the labeled product was purified by reverse phase HPLC on a Chemcobond 5C18 ODS column (4.6 x 150 mm) . Elution was carried out with a linear gradient of 6% to 50% acetonitrile in 50 mM ammonium formate, pH 7.0, over a period of 30 min at a flow rate 1.0 mL/min, with monitoring of the eluate at 550 nm. The yield was 46%. HRMS (MALDI) calculated for C44H55N6OnS2 [M+] was 908.0906 and found was 908.0955. The Cy3-His-4-amino-3- butyric acid (2V,iV-dimethylamino) ethylester was synthesized by Lewatit lipase ELl-mediated esterification as described above. The final product was purified by reverse phase HPLC, as described above, except that the gradient was 6% to 80% acetonitrile. The yield was 0.1%. HRMS (MALDI) calculated for C53H64N9O13S2 [M+] was 1099.2815 and found was 1099.2841.
4. Preparation of His -tagged 5-bromo-4-chloro-3-indolyl- beta-galactopyranoside [X-GaI) .
A histidine molecule was firstly incorporated to the X-GaI by enzymatic esterification of histidine with X-GaI and immobilized Thermomyces lanuginosus lipase ELl (11.2 mol% incorporation of histidine in 24 h, at a ratio 2 histidine : 1 X-GaI) . 3-Methyl-2-butanol was used as solvent with a water content of up to 3.0%, and the reaction was carried out at 450C. High-performance preparative liquid chromatography using nucleosil C18 column using methanol : water as mobile phase was used to analyze and purify the products. Purified X-Gal-His was stored at -200C until use. This method was used to link His molecules to carboxylate containing molecules.
5. Incorporation of X-Gal-His to Cy3 -His -4 -amino-3 -butyric acid (N,N-dimethylamino) ethylester.
The activated Cy3 is reacted with X-Gal-His halide in the presence of a quaternary ammonium salt such as benzyltriethylammonium chloride using 50% aqueous sodium hydroxide as an acid-removing agent (Bull. Chem. Soc . Jpn., 54, 1879 (1981)) . By using this method, the Cy3 molecule is attached via the linker moiety to the halogenated moiety in the X-GaI molecule.
6 . Incorpora tion of His - tagged X-Gal -Cy3 deriva tives to the poly (A) -ni trilotriacetic-Co (II) complex .
The final step in the array development is the incubation of the histidine functionalized Cy3-X-Gal with poly (A) - nitrilotriacetic-Co (II) complexes in 50 mM phosphate buffer, 50 mM NaCl, pH 7.5 for 1 hour at 250C. When required, DMSO was added to increase substrate solubility. The resulting complexes were separated from unbound enzyme molecules by HPLC as described above. To ensure that each SM-Cy3 binds through both of its His residues, 59NMR was performed, and only derivatives incorporating single SM-Cy3 molecules were purified, and stored in 384 microtiter plates at -700C until used. These molecules were used directly for the construction of the array.
EXAMPLE 5:
Improved procedure for the synthesis of probe compounds.
1. Preparation of nitrilotriacetic-CofII) complexes
The procedure was adapted from J. M. Abad et al . , J Am Chem Soc 127 , 5689 (2005) , where the full synthesis is described. The amino-nitrilotriacetic-Co (II) complex (A) was formed by reaction of NR, iVR-bis (carboxymethyl) -L-lysine hydrate (ANTA, Fluka) (5 g; 19 mmol) with an excess of cobalt (II) chloride (Sigma) (24.7 g; 190 mmol) in 20 mM HEPES in aqueous solution (10 ml total volume) overnight at 250C. Excess cobalt was precipitated by increasing the pH to 10 by adding 4 N NaOH, and the precipitate was removed by filtration through a 0.2 μm membrane (PTFE, Amicon) (2.3 g, 53% yield; white solid crystalline powder) (A) . Reaction scheme:
Figure imgf000074_0001
2 . Incorporation of poly (A) tails to ni trilotriacetic-Co (II) complexes .
The procedure was adapted from J. M. Abad et al . , J Am Chem Soc 127 , 5689 (2005) . Briefly, activation of the phosphate groups of the poly (A) tails (Sigma Genosys) (2.091 mg,- 258 nmol) and subsequent amidation with the Co(II) complex was performed by overnight incubation at 250C with 3 mM N- hydroxysuccinimide (NHS, Fluka) and 3 mM l-ethyl-3- [3C- (dimethylamino) propyl] -carbodiimide (EDC, Sigma) in 20 mM
HEPES buffer (pH 7.5) . Concentration of the pure fractions (freeze drier) afforded the poly (A) -ANTA-Co (II) complexes (B) as a white solid crystalline powder (1.82 mg,- ~86%) .
Reaction scheme:
Figure imgf000075_0001
3. Modification of cyanine dye with histidine
A histidine molecule was firstly incorporated to the Cy3 dye by enzymatic transamidolysis of Cy3 NHS (a succinimidyl ester, GE Healthcare) with histidine and immobilized Lewatit lipase ELl (D. Reyes-Duarte et al . , Angew Chem Int Ed Engl 44, 7553 (2005)) from a cow rumen metagenome. All reactions were performed in the dark. Solvents were dried over 3 A molecular sieves for 24 h prior to use. Briefly, Cy3 NHS (250 mg, 0.344 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of dimethylsulfoxide (DMSO) and 2-methyl-2-butanol was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, histidine (Sigma) (213 mg; 1.38 mmol) was added. When the conversion of Cy3 NHS to the corresponding amide reached the maximum value (determined by HPLC: 37.39 mol% incorporation of histidine in 24 h, at a ratio 4 histidine :1 Cy3 NHS ester) , the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2-methyl-2-butanol . The crude product was purified by semipreparative reverse-phase HPLC (Prontosil-AQ, 5 Im, 120 A, 250 • 8 mm column) , and compounds were eluted with acetonitrile (20% -for 5 min, followed by linear gradients to 45% in 5 min, to 50% in 7 min and to 100% in 2 min) in triethylammonium hydrogen carbonate buffer (0.01 M, pH 8.6) at a flow of 3 mL/min. Fractions containing the product (C) (retention time 10.43 min, UV detection at 280 nm and 545 nm) were combined and dried by lyophilisation. The product (C) (101 mg; -37%) was further dissolved in dimethylsulfoxide (DMSO) at a concentration up to 4 M and stored at -700C until use. The water solubility of the compound was found to be >0.38 M at room temperature as determined by absorbance . The compound (C) had an extinction coefficient (ε) of 130810 1/mol-cm an its λmax 545 nm as determined in 10 mM Tris-HCl at pH 7.4 according to the method of CR. Cantor and I. Tinoco, J". MoI. Biol. 13, 65 (1965) . Mass spectrometry was used to confirm the structure. HRMS: calculated for C37O9S2N5H44 [M+H+] was 766.2580, found 766.2597. As shown, the result was within of the calculated molecular mass. Reaction scheme:
Figure imgf000076_0001
4. Modification of his tagged cyanine with 4-amino-3- butanoate
The 4-amino-3 -butanoate was incorporated to (C) through the sulfonate. Two methods were used. First, sulfonyl chloride his tagged cyanine was firstly prepared from (C) according to J. Sokolowska-Gajda and H. S. Freeman, Dyes and Pigm 14, 35 (1990) . This compound was used for a sulfonamide reaction (R-NH-SO2-Cy3) with 4 -amino- 3 -butanoate as described by Z. Wai et al . , The proceeding of the 3rd International Conference on Functional Molecules 167 (2005) . Briefly, to a solution of 4 -amino- 3 -butanoate (60 mg; 0.58 mmol) in dry acetonitrile (10 ml), K2CO3 (1.0 g) was added and then a suspension of sulfonyl chloride Cy3-His (10 mg; 0.013 mmol) in dry DMSO (15 ml) was added dropwise. Then, the reaction mixture was stirred at 400C for 4 hrs and maintained for further 2 hrs. Then, the reaction mixture was cooled to room temperature, poured into water and extracted with ethyl acetate EtOAc. The solid obtained was dried under vacuum to give the product (D) as a light red powder. After recrystallized from acetonitrile, solid sulfonamide was obtained with the yield 32.0% (3.6 mg) . The product was further purified by HPLC as described below. Additionally, the sulphonamide reaction was also performed as described by C. Tsopelas et al . , J Nucl Med 43, 1377 (2002) with small modifications. Briefly, 4 -amino-3 -butanoate (60 mg; 0.58 mmol) was added to a 10 ml 0.1 M NaHCO3 (pH 8.0) solution containing sulfonate Cy3-His (10 mg; 0.013 mmol) and further incubated at 400C for 600 min with swirling (100 rpm) in the dark. Under these conditions, 27 mol% incorporation of the dye was achieved. The product was recovered by semipreparative reverse phase HPLC analysis performed on a VPODS C-18 column (150 x 4.6 mm) at a flow rate of 1.0 mL/min for analysis, and PRC-ODS C-18 column (250 x 20 mm) at a flow rate of 10.0 mL/min for preparative scale. Detection was performed at 552 nm. HPLC solvents consist of water containing 0.1% TFA (solvent A) and acetonitrile containing 0.1% TFA (solvent B) . Concentration of the pure fractions in vacuo afforded purified product (D) (2.7 nag; -24%) . In both cases, purified product was further dissolved in dimethylsulfoxide (DMSO) at a concentration up to 4 M and stored at -700C until use. The mass spectrometry data was in agreement with the formation of one sulfonamide bond. HRMS: calculated for C4IO10S2N6H52 [M+H+] was 852.3186, found 852.3152. Reaction scheme:
Figure imgf000078_0001
5. Modification of intermediate (D) with N,N- dimethylethanolamine
Compound (D) was subjected to direct esterification with N, N-dimethylethanolamine using immobilized Lewatit lipase ELl (D. Reyes-Duarte et al . , Angew Chem Int Ed Engl 44, 7553 (2005)) from a cow rumen metagenome . Briefly, compound (D) (25 mg, 0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of dimethylsulfoxide (DMSO) and 2 -methyl -2 -butanol was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL . The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, N, N-dimethylethanolamine (25 mg; 0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value (determined by HPLC: 53 mol% in 48 h) , the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2-methyl-2-butanol . The product was recovered by- evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol. The crude product was redisolved in DMSO and further purified by semipreparative reverse-phase HPLC (Prontosil-AQ, 5 Im, 120 A, 250 • 8 mm column equipped with a Prontosil-AQ, 5 Im, 120 A, 33 8 mm pre-column, and compounds were eluted with acetonitrile (20% for 5 min, followed by linear gradients to 45% in 5 min, to 50% in 7 min and to 100% in 2 min) in triethylammonium hydrogen carbonate buffer (0.01 M, pH 8.6) at a flow of 3 mL/min. Fractions containing the product (E) (retention time 14.79 min, UV detection at 280 nm and 542 run) were combined and dried by lyophilisation. The product (E) (13.5 mg; ~50%) was further dissolved in dimethylsulfoxide (DMSO) at a concentration up to 4 M and stored at -700C until use. The water solubility of the compound was found to be approx. 0.24 M at room temperature as determined by absorbance . The compound (E) had an extinction coefficient (ε) of 112728 1/mol-cm an its λmax 545 nm as determined in 10 mM Tris-HCl at pH 7.4 according to the method of CR. Cantor and I. Tinoco (loc. cit.) . Mass spectrometry was used to confirm the structure. H HRMS: calculated for C45Oi0S2N7H6I [M+H+] was 923.3921, found 923.3950. As shown, the result was within of the calculated molecular mass. Reaction scheme:
Figure imgf000080_0001
6. Metabolite library
The primary synthetic challenge involved finding a reaction path from a functionalized core with the highest yield (>26- 90% overall) . The purified metabolites were characterized by HPLC and HRMS and were found to be 90% pure; yields were >20%. First, the comprehensive collection of metabolites was obtained. Table 1 shows a complete description of synthetic and purification methods and commercial suppliers. In case the metabolite was purified from cell extract of an organism, the chromatographic description of the method used for separation and the amount of metabolite per gram of extract are specifically shown. When a synthetic method was used, the exact and experimental masses (HRMS (MALDI)) are shown, together with the precise information of mass and molar quantities of reagents used, reaction conditions, work-up procedure and isolated yield in mass as well as percentage. As can be seen in Table Sl enzymatic and chemical methods were used. Metabolites were reconstituted and diluted in PBS buffer, DMSO or a mixture of both, accordingly to their solubility properties, and stored in 384-well microtiter plates at -700C until used. Reaction/purification/source scheme : Commercial sources
Substrates ► M (metabolite)
Purification from cells
7. Histidine and dye labelled metabolite library synthesis
The metabolite array is constituted by thousands of molecules that are modified to link them to a fluorofore (i.e. Cy3 , or possibly any other with similar characteristics) and a histidine molecule. Overall, there are a number of strategies to perform those addition reactions based on the linking and nature positions which are described below. Briefly, the methods include specific halogenation reactions by the action of a promiscuous halogenase, esterification or transesterification or amidation or transamidation reactions by the action of a promiscuous lipase and carbon-carbon bond formation in the presence of the proton sponge 1, 8-bis- (dimethylamino) - napthalene . Figure 8 shows a schematic representation of each of the different general methods used to create the histidine and dye labelled metabolite library synthesis. In this figure a representative metabolite is shown.
Even though approx. 2500 molecules were modified to anchor them to a dye, few dozen of general procedures can be considered to perform the synthesis, named "synthetic method 1 to 30" described below. These general methods are based on the nature of position of the molecules to which the histidine moiety and the dye moiety are attached. Table 8 shows the linking position to which both components are attached to the metabolites. Below the general synthetic methods are described, each of them describing the individual and succesive steps. Further, general HPLC purification methods to separate the final dye labelled metabolites are described.
A number of abbreviations are used below: DMSO (dimethylsulfoxide) ; 2M2B (2-methyl-2-butanol) ; 1,8-BDN (1,8-bis- (dimethylamino) -naphthalene) ; CH3CN (acetonitrile) , α-KG (α-ketoglutarate) , HPLC (high pressure liquid chromatography) , ELl-Lewatit (immobilized Lewatit lipase ELl from a cow rumen metagenome) , I-metabolite (Iodine containing metabolite; E (Cy3 intermediate containing histidine and linkers) .
The source of enzymes used for synthetic purposes are as follow. ELl, Protein-engineered lipase isolated from cow rumen metagenome {Angewandte Chemie International Edition (2005) 44: 7553-7557); Dehalogenase : multifunctional α/β- hydrolase mined from a metagenome library of a microbial community in seawater contaminated with petroleum hydrocarbons, with a novel hydrolytic phenotype, namely the cleavage of both λ common' p-nitrophenyl (pNP) esters and haloalkanoates, and weak activity towards haloalkanes (Table 5; SEQ ID Nos . 57 to 59; paper in preparation) ; Halogenase : this enzyme corresponds to the same dehalogenase described above but it is able to perform halogenation reactions in organic media. The promiscuity of the enzyme can be also seen in the capacity to perform two different reactions. In the presence of the cofactor α-ketoglutarate the enzyme is able to activate non-activated alkyl groups and in the presence of NADH is able to halogenate activate molecules containing alkenyl groups . Below we described the general methods which consist in three steps: first, the incorporation of iodide to the metabolite; second, the incoprotation oh histidine to the halogenated metabolite; third, the incorporation of the dye to the previous intermediate. While the first and second methods may differs among the different methods, the third remains equal :
Step 3. Formation of Cy3 -labeled metabolite. The corresponding labeled quaternary ammonium metabolite were obtained in the presence of 1,8 -BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . (loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti, R. M. Lemmon, J" Org Chem 22, 228 (1957) with small modifications. Briefly, the (general method for the synthesis of quaternary amines is as follows. Reaction mixture (2 ml) contains histidine tagged I-metabolite (0.078 mmol) , 0.78 mmol of (E) and 1,8- BDN at a final concentration of 100 mM in DMSO. The temperature was controlled at 320C. After incubation (range from 11.52 to 424 min) the product was recovered by evaporating the CH3CN. The labeled product was purified by semi -preparative reverse-phase HPLC. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure.
Therefore, a full description of steps 1 and 2 is only given below. Reference is made to Figure 8, which shows exemplary reaction schemes for each of the following 26 synthetic methods, and Figure 9, which shows the exemplary metabolite used in the respective synthetic methods, wherein the position, to which histidine is linked, is marked by a black arrow, and that, to which the dye is linked, is marked by a grey arrow. Synthetic method 1: this method is designed to perform direct halogenation to two sp3 carbon atoms (e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring) and further incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) and Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component to those sp3 carbon atoms - i.e. both components to two different sp3 carbon atoms.
Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 1 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9, wherein Hys and Cy3 are linked to two different sp3 carbon atoms of an alkyl group.
2. Formation of I-metabolite. The iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 37 °C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi preparative HPLC. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated two "I" per molecule. 2. Incorporation of histidine . I-metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. The incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8-BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . {loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, to a solution of I -metabolite (concentration range from 0.1 to 2.3 mmol) , histidine (concentration range from 0.44 to 1 mmol) , and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 10 mM were added, in CH3CN (10 ml final volume) . The temperature was controlled at 320C. After incubation (range from 11.52 to 424 min) the product was recovered by- evaporating the CH3CN. The corresponding product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure.
Synthetic method 2 : this method is designed to perform direct halogenation to two sp2 carbon atoms (e.g. a carbon atom of an aromatic carbon bond or a carbon atom of an unsaturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. terminal, or within a chain or ring) and further incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) and Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component to those groups - i.e. both components to two different sp2 carbon atoms .
Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 7 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9, wherein His and Cy3 are linked to two differnt sp2 carbon atoms of an aryl group .
1. Formation of I-metabolite. The iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via I" as follows. The general halogenation procedure via cofactor is as follows. The reaction mixtures were incubated at 37°C with metabolite (0.080 mmol) , KI (75 mM) , 2 mM NADH, and halogenase (4 mg/ml, 100 μL) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH = 7.8), containing up to 20% DMSO (to increase metabolite solubility), in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 24 hour of incubation, reaction product (s) were separated by semi- preparative HPLC. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of
10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated two "I" per molecule. 2. Incorporation of histidine. I-metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. The incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8-BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . (loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications.
Briefly, to a solution of I-metabolite (concentration range from 0.1 to 2.3 mmol), histidine (concentration range from 0.44 to 1 mmol) , and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 10 mM were added, in CH3CN (10 ml final volume) . The temperature was controlled at 32 °C. After incubation (range from 11.52 to 424 min) the product was recovered by evaporating the CH3CN. The corresponding product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure.
Synthetic method 3 : this method is designed to perform direct halogenation to both a sp3 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring) and a sp2 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of an aromatic carbon bond or a carbon atom of an unsaturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. terminal, or within a chain or ring) in the same metablite and further incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) and Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component to those groups - i.e. one component to a sp3 carbon atom and one component to a sp2 carbon atom. Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr . 8 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9, wherein one of His and Cy3 is linked to a sp3 carbon atom of an methyl group, while the other is linked to an aryl carbon atom.
1. Formation of I-metabolite. The iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via I" as follows. The general halogenation procedure via cofactor is as follows. The reaction mixtures were incubated at 37°C with metabolite (0.080 mmol) , KI (75 mM) , 2 mM NADH, and halogenase (4 mg/ml, 100 μL) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH = 7.8) , containing up to 20% DMSO (to increase metabolite solubility), in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 24 hour of incubation, reaction product (s) were separated by semi- preparative HPLC. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule. Further, a second iodide was incorporated via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 370C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi preparative HPLC. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule in this step, and two "I" per molecule at the end of the two-steps halogenation process. 2. Incorporation of histidine. I -metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. The incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8-BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et. al . Hoc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon {loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, to a solution of I-metabolite (concentration range from 0.1 to 2.3 mmol) , histidine (concentration range from 0.44 to 1 mmol), and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 10 mM were added were added, in CH3CN (10 ml final volume) . The temperature was controlled at 320C. After incubation (range from 11.52 to 424 min) the product was recovered by evaporating the CH3CN. The corresponding product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure.
Synthetic method 4: this method is designed to perform direct halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring) to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) through esterification with an OH group of the metabolite - i.e. one component to a sp3 carbon atom and one component to an OH group .
Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 36 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
1. Formation of I-metabolite. The iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 370C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -7O0C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule. 2. Incorporation of histidine . I -metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. A histidine molecule was incorporated by enzymatic esterification of the previous intermediate and ELl-Lewatit. Solvents were dried over 3 A molecular sieves for 24 h prior to use. Briefly, metabolite (0.344 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, histidine (1.38 mmol) was added. When the conversion to the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol and the crude product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. Fractions containing the product were combined and dried by lyophilisation. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml.
Synthetic method 5: this method is designed to perform direct esterification through an -OH group and further halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring) to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and His (black arrow in Figure 9) - i.e. both components to two different OH groups.
Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 132 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
1. Formation of I-metabolite. The metabolite was subjected to transesterification with vinyl acetate using ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, vinyl acetate (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol. The crude product was further purified by semi-preparative HPLC. The product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 ttiM) , and halogenase (32 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 370C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml .
2. Incorporation of histidine. I -metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. A histidine molecule was incorporated by enzymatic esterification of the previous intermediate and ELl-Lewatit. Solvents were dried over 3 A molecular sieves for 24 h prior to use. Briefly, metabolite (0.344 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 40 °C with magnetic stirring. Then, histidine (1.38 mmol) was added. When the conversion to the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol and the crude product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. Fractions containing the product were combined and dried by lyophilisation. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml.
Synthetic method 6: this method is designed to perform direct halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring) to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) through an NH2 group of the metabolite - i.e. one component to a sp3 carbon atom and one component to an NH2 group . Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 154 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
1. Formation of I-metabolite. The iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 370C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule. 2. Incorporation of histidine. I -metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. A histidine molecule was incorporated by enzymatic amidation of the previous intermediate and ELl-Lewatit. Solvents were dried over 3 A molecular sieves for 24 h prior to use. Briefly, metabolite (0.344 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL . The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, histidine (1.38 mmol) was added. When the conversion to the corresponding amide reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml. Synthetic method 7: this method is designed to perform direct esterification through an -OH group and further halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) through an NH2 group of the metabolite - i.e. one component to an NH2 group and one component to an OH group .
Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 196 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
1. Formation of I-metabolite . The metabolite was subjected to transesterification with vinyl acetate using ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, vinyl acetate (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol. The crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 370C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi-preparative HPLC. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml . 2. Incorporation of histidine. I-metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. A histidine molecule was incorporated by enzymatic amidation of the previous intermediate and ELl-Lewatit. Solvents were dried over 3 A molecular sieves for 24 h prior to use. Briefly, metabolite (0.344 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL . The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, histidine (1.38 mmol) was added. When the conversion to the corresponding amide reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml .
Synthetic method 8: this method is designed to perform partial dehalogenation in (fully) halogenated aliphatic compounds, followed by halogenation (iodization) to two different sp3 carbon atoms (e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring) and further incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) and Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component to those sp3 carbon atoms - i.e. both components to two different sp3 carbon atoms after a three-step dehalogenation, esterification and halogenation. Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 1692 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
1. Formation of I-metabolite . The iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via α-KG prior selective dehalogenation. First, the metabolite (100 μl of a 100 mM solution in MeOH) was added to 900 μl in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) and dehalogenase (32 μM) . Reaction was allowed to proceed at 400C for 5 hours. Then the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product (mixture of partial dehalogenated products) was concentrated by liophilization. The purified intermediate ( 95% pure) was used for a subsequent iodization reaction as follows. The metabolite was subjected to transesterification with vinyl acetate using ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, vinyl acetate (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol. The crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 370C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 °C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated two "I" per molecule. 2. Incorporation of histidine. I -metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. The incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8 -BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . (loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, to a solution of I -metabolite (concentration range from 0.1 to 2.3 mmol) , histidine (concentration range from 0.44 to 1 mmol), and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 10 mM were added were added, in CH3CN (10 ml final volume) . The temperature was controlled at 320C. After incubation (range from 11.52 to 424 min) the product was recovered by evaporating the CH3CN. The corresponding product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure.
Synthetic method 9: this method is designed to perform direct halogenation to a sp2 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of an aromatic carbon bond or a carbon atom of an unsaturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. terminal, or within a chain or ring) and further incorporation of Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component to this group and incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) through an NH2 group of the metabolite . Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr . 306 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
1. Formation of I-metabolite . The iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via I" as follows. The general halogenation procedure via cofactor is as follows. The reaction mixtures were incubated at 37°C with metabolite (0.080 mmol) , KI (75 mM) , 2 mM NADH, and halogenase (4 mg/ml, 100 μL) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH = 7.8), containing up to 20% DMSO (to increase metabolite solubility) , in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 24 hour of incubation, reaction product (s) were separated by semi- preparative HPLC. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule after purification. 2. Incorporation of histidine. I -metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. A histidine molecule was incorporated by enzymatic amidation of the previous intermediate and ELl-Lewatit. Solvents were dried over 3 A molecular sieves for 24 h prior to use. Briefly, metabolite (0.344 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, histidine (1.38 mmol) was added. When the conversion to the corresponding amide reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol and the crude product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. Fractions containing the product were combined and dried by lyophilisation. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70°C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml .
Synthetic method 10: this method is designed to perform direct esterification through a -COOH group and further halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) through halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring) .
Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 327 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
1. Formation of I-metabolite . The metabolite was subjected to direct esterification with ethanol using ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, ethanol (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol. The crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 37°C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi- preparative HPLC. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of
10 μg/ml . Following the two-step reaction process, HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated two "I" per molecule after purification.
2. Incorporation of histidine. I -metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. The incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8 -BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . (loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, to a solution of I-metabolite (concentration range from 0.1 to 2.3 mmol) , histidine (concentration range from 0.44 to 1 mmol), and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 10 mM were added, in CH3CN (10 ml final volume) . The temperature was controlled at 320C. After incubation (range from 11.52 to 424 min) the product was recovered by evaporating the CH3CN. The corresponding product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure.
Synthetic method 11: this method is designed to perform direct esterification through a -COOH group and further halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) through an- -OH group of the metabolite. Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr . shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
1. Formation of I-metabolite . The metabolite was subjected to direct esterification with ethanol using ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL . The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, ethanol (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol. The crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 rtiM) , and halogenase (32 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 370C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi- preparative HPLC. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule 2. Incorporation of histidine. I-metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. A histidine molecule was incorporated by enzymatic esterification of the previous intermediate and ELl-Lewatit. Solvents were dried over 3 A molecular sieves for 24 h prior to use. Briefly, metabolite (0.344 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, histidine (1.38 mmol) was added. When the conversion to the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml .
Synthetic method 12 : this method is designed to perform direct esterification through two -COOH groups and further halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link them to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) and His (black arrow in Figure 9) components .
Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 397 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
1. Formation of I-metabolite. The metabolite was subjected to direct esterification with ethanol using ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, ethanol (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol. The crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 37°C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi- preparative HPLC. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated two "I" per molecule. 2. Incorporation of histidine. I -metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. The incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8-BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . (loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon {loc. cit.) with small modifications.
Briefly, to a solution of I -metabolite (concentration range from 0.1 to 2.3 mmol) , histidine (concentration range from 0.44 to 1 mmol) , and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 10 mM were added, in CH3CN (10 ml final volume) . The temperature was controlled at 320C. After incubation (range from 11.52 to 424 min) the product was recovered by evaporating the CH3CN. The corresponding product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure.
Synthetic method 13 : this method is designed to perform direct halogenation to a sp2 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of an aromatic carbon bond or a carbon atom of an unsaturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. terminal, or within a chain or ring) and further incorporation of Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and direct amidation through a -COOH group to incorporate the His (black arrow in Figure 9) component .
Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 398 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
2. Formation of I-metabolite. The iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via I" as follows. The general halogenation procedure via cofactor is as follows. The reaction mixtures were incubated at 370C with metabolite (0.080 mmol) , KI (75 ttiM) , 2 mM NADH, and halogenase (4 mg/ml, 100 μL) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH = 7.8), containing up to 20% DMSO (to increase metabolite solubility), in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 24 hour of incubation, reaction product (s) were separated by semi- preparative HPLC. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of
10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule. 2. Incorporation of histidine. I-metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. A histidine molecule was incorporated by enzymatic amidation of the previous intermediate and ELl-Lewatit. Solvents were dried over 3 A molecular sieves for 24 h prior to use. Briefly, metabolite (0.344 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, histidine (1.38 mmol) was added. When the conversion to the corresponding amide reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol and the crude product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. Fractions containing the product were combined and dried by lyophilisation. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml .
Synthetic method 14: this method is designed to perform direct esterification through a -COOH group and further halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) and direct amidation through a NH2 group to incorporate the His (black arrow in Figure 9) component.
Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr . 860 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
1. Formation of I-metabolite. The metabolite was subjected to direct esterification with ethanol using ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, ethanol (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol. The crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 37°C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi- preparative HPLC. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 °C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule. 2. Incorporation of histidine. I-metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. A histidine molecule was incorporated by enzymatic amidation of the previous intermediate and ELl-Lewatit. Solvents were dried over 3 A molecular sieves for 24 h prior to use. Briefly, metabolite (0.344 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL . The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, histidine (1.38 mmol) was added. When the conversion to the corresponding amide reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol and the crude product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. Fractions containing the product were combined and dried by lyophilisation. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml. Synthetic method 15: this method is designed to perform direct transesterification through a -OH group and further halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) and direct amidation through a NH2 group to incorporate the His (black arrow in Figure 9) component.
Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 543 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
1. Formation of I-metabolite . The metabolite was subjected to transesterification with vinyl acetate using ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL . The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, vinyl acetate (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol. The crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 37°C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 °C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule. 2. Incorporation of histidine. I-metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. A histidine molecule was incorporated by enzymatic amidation of the previous intermediate and ELl-Lewatit. Solvents were dried over 3 A molecular sieves for 24 h prior to use. Briefly, metabolite (0.344 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL . The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, histidine (1.38 mmol) was added. When the conversion to the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol and the crude product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. Fractions containing the product were combined and dried by lyophilisation. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of
10 μg/ml.
Synthetic method 16: this method is designed to perform direct transesterification through a -OH group and further halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) through a -COOH group of the metabolite.
Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 1179 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9. 1. Formation of I-metabolite . The metabolite was subjected to direct transesterification with vinyl acetate using ELl- Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, vinyl acetate (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol. The crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 370C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule.
2. Incorporation of histidine. I-metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. A histidine molecule was incorporated by enzymatic amidation of the previous intermediate and ELl-Lewatit. Solvents were dried over 3 A molecular sieves for 24 h prior to use.
Briefly, metabolite (0.344 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, histidine (1.38 mmol) was added. When the conversion to the corresponding amide reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol and the crude product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. Fractions containing the product were combined and dried by lyophilisation. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml .
Synthetic method 17: this method is designed to perform direct esterification through one -OH group and further halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) and and His (black arrow in Figure 9) components .
Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr . 1212 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
1. Formation of I-metabolite. The metabolite was subjected to direct transesterification with vinyl propionate using
ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, vinyl propionate (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol. The crude product was further purified by semi- preparative HPLC. The product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 370C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 °C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated two "I" per molecule. 2. Incorporation of histidine. I-metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. The incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8 -BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . Hoc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications.
Briefly, to a solution of I-metabolite (concentration range from 0.1 to 2.3 mmol), histidine (concentration range from 0.44 to 1 mmol), and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 10 mM were added, in CH3CN (10 ml final volume) . The temperature was controlled at 320C. After incubation (range from 11.52 to 424 min) the product was recovered by evaporating the CH3CN. The corresponding product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure.
Synthetic method 18: this method is designed to perform direct halogenation to one sp3 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring) and further incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) and Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) components to this moiety
Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 417 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
1-1. Formation of I-metabolite I. The iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 37°C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule. 1-2. Incorporation of ethyl amine I-metabolite I. The corresponding metabolite was used to incorporate an ethyl group throught the reaction with ethyl amine in the presence of 1,8-BDN as described by R.A. Kaufman et al . (loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, reaction mixture (2 ml) contains I- metabolite I (0.078 mmol) , 0.78 mmol of ethyl amine and 1,8- BDN at a final concentration of 100 mM in DMSO (10 ml final volume) . The temperature was controlled at 320C. After incubation (range from 11.52 to 424 min) the product was recovered by evaporating the CH3CN. The labeled product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure.
1-3. Formation of I-metabolite II. The iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 rtiM) , and halogenase (32 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 370C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated two "I" per molecule.
2. Incorporation of histidine. I-metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. The incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8-BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman and et al . (loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, to a solution of I-metabolite (concentration range from 0.1 to 2.3 mmol), histidine (concentration range from 0.44 to 1 mmol) , and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 10 mM were added, in CH3CN (10 ml final volume) . The temperature was controlled at 320C. After incubation (range from 11.52 to 424 min) the product was recovered by evaporating the CH3CN. The corresponding product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure. Synthetic method 19: this method is designed to perform direct esterification through a -COOH group and further halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) and direct halogenation to a sp2 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of an aromatic carbon bond or a carbon atom of an unsaturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. terminal, or within a chain or ring) and further incorporation of His (grey arrow in Figure 9) component
Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr . 1332 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
1. Formation of I-metabolite. The metabolite was subjected to direct esterification with ethanol using ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL . The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, ethanol (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol. The crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 37°C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi- preparative HPLC. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of
10 μg/ml . Using this intermediate a second iodization reaction was performed via I". The general halogenation procedure via cofactor is as follows. The reaction mixtures were incubated at 37°C with metabolite (0.080 mmol) , KI (75 mM) , 2 mM NADH, and halogenase (4 mg/ml , 100 μL) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH = 7.8), containing up to 20% DMSO (to increase metabolite solubility) , in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 24 hour of incubation, reaction product (s) were separated by semi -preparative HPLC. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 °C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml. HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated two "I" per molecule after the two-step process.
2. Incorporation of histidine . I-metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. The incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8-BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . (loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, to a solution of I-metabolite (concentration range from 0.1 to 2.3 mmol) , histidine (concentration range from 0.44 to 1 mmol), and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 10 mM were added, in CH3CN (10 ml final volume) . The temperature was controlled at 320C. After incubation (range from 11.52 to 424 min) the product was recovered by evaporating the CH3CN. The corresponding product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure. Synthetic method 20: this method is designed to perform direct halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring) and further incorporation of Cy3 (grey arrow in
Figure 9) component to this alkyl group and direct amidation through a -COOH group to link it to His (grey arrow in Figure 9) component.
Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 1790 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
1. Formation of I-metabolite . The iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 370C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule.
2. Incorporation of histidine. I -metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. A histidine molecule was incorporated by enzymatic amidation of the previous intermediate and ELl-Lewatit. Solvents were dried over 3 A molecular sieves for 24 h prior to use.
Briefly, metabolite (0.344 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, histidine (1.38 mmol) was added. When the conversion to the corresponding amide reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol and the crude product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. Fractions containing the product were combined and dried by lyophilisation. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of
10 μg/ml .
Synthetic method 21: this method is designed to perform direct esterification through a -COOH group and further halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) and His (grey arrow in Figure 9) components .
Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr . 1409 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
1. Formation of I-metabolite. The metabolite was subjected to direct esterification with ethanol using ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL . The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, ethanol (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol. The crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 37°C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi- preparative HPLC. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated two "I" per molecule. 2. Incorporation of histidine. I-metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. The incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8 -BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . (loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications.
Briefly, to a solution of I-metabolite (concentration range from 0.1 to 2.3 mmol) , histidine (concentration range from 0.44 to 1 mmol), and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 10 mM were added, in CH3CN (10 ml final volume) . The temperature was controlled at 32 °C. After incubation (range from 11.52 to 424 min) the product was recovered by evaporating the CH3CN. The corresponding product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure.
Synthetic method 22 : this method is designed to perform direct halogenation to one sp2 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of an aromatic carbon bond or a carbon atom of an unsaturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. terminal, or within a chain or ring) and further incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) and Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) components to this moiety.
Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 1614 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
1-1. Formation of I-metabolite I. The iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via I" as follows. The general halogenation procedure via cofactor is as follows. The reaction mixtures were incubated at 37°C with metabolite (0.080 mmol) , KI (75 mM) , 2 mM NADH, and halogenase (4 mg/ml, 100 μL) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH = 7.8), containing up to 20% DMSO (to increase metabolite solubility) , in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 24 hour of incubation, reaction product (s) were separated by semi- preparative HPLC. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 °C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule. 1-2. Incorporation of ethyl amine. The corresponding metabolite was used to incorporate an ethyl group throught the reaction with ethyl amine in the presence of 1,8 -BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . (loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, reaction mixture (2 ml) contains I-metabolite (0.078 mmol) , 0.78 mmol of ethyl amine and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 100 mM in DMSO (10 ml final volume) . The temperature was controlled at 320C. After incubation (range from 11.52 to 424 min) the product was recovered by evaporating the CH3CN. The labeled product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure. 1-3. Formation of I-metabolite II. The iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus
2 mM α-KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 370C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated two "I" per molecule. 2. Incorporation of histidine. I -metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. The incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8-BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . {loc . cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon {loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, to a solution of I -metabolite (concentration range from 0.1 to 2.3 mmol), histidine (concentration range from 0.44 to 1 mmol) , and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 10 mM were added, in CH3CN (10 ml final volume) . The temperature was controlled at 320C. After incubation (range from 11.52 to 424 min) the product was recovered by evaporating the CH3CN. The corresponding product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure. Synthetic method 23: this method is designed to perform direct halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom (e.g. a carbon atom of a saturated hydrocarbon bond, e.g. a terminal methyl carbon atom or a methylene carbon atom, e.g. within a chain or ring) and further incorporation of Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and direct amidation through a -COOH group to link it to His (grey arrow in Figure 9) component.
Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr . 394 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
1. Formation of I-metabolite . The iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 inM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 370C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi-preparative HPLC. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule. 2. Incorporation of histidine . I -metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. A histidine molecule was incorporated by enzymatic amidation of the previous intermediate and ELl-Lewatit. Solvents were dried over 3 A molecular sieves for 24 h prior to use. Briefly, metabolite (0.344 mmol) was dissolved in 5 rriL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, histidine (1.38 mmol) was added. When the conversion to the corresponding amide reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol and the crude product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. Fractions containing the product were combined and dried by lyophilisation. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 °C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml.
Synthetic method 24: this method is designed to perform partial dehalogenation in an halogenated compound, followed by halogenation (iodization) to an alkyl group and further incorporation of Cy3 (grey arrow) component to this alkyl group and direct esterification through one -OH group to link it to His (black arrow) component.
Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 1997 shown in Table 1 and Figure 9.
1. Formation of I-metabolite. The iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via α-KG prior selective dehalogenation. First, the metabolite (100 μl of a 10 mM solution in MeOH final concentration of 1 mM) was added to 900 μl in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) and dehalogenase (32 μM) . Reaction was allowed to proceed at 400C for 5 hours. Then the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product (mixture of partial dehalogenated products) was concentrated by liophilization. The purified intermediate ( 95% pure) was used for a subsequent iodization reaction as follows. The metabolite was subjected to transesterification with vinyl acetate using ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, vinyl acetate (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol. The crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus
2 mM α-KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 370C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi-preparative HPLC. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated two "I" per molecule.
2. Incorporation of histidine. I-metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. The incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8 -BDN as described by R.A. Kaufman et al . {loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, to a solution of I-metabolite (concentration range from 0.1 to 2.3 mmol) , histidine (concentration range from 0.44 to 1 mmol), and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 10 mM were added were added, in CH3CN (10 ml final volume) . The temperature was controlled at 320C. After incubation (range from 11.52 to 424 min) the product was recovered by evaporating the CH3CN. The corresponding product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure.
Synthetic method 25: this method is designed to perform direct transamidation through one -NH2 group and further halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) and and His (black arrow in Figure 9) components .
Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 1481 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
1. Formation of I-metabolite. The metabolite was subjected to direct transamidation with vinyl propionate using ELl- Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, acetate (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding amide reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol. The crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 370C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi- preparative HPLC. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated two "I" per molecule at the end of the two-step process .
2. Incorporation of histidine. I -metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. The incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8 -BDN as described by R.A. Kaufman et al . (loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, to a solution of I-metabolite (concentration range from 0.1 to 2.3 mmol) , histidine (concentration range from 0.44 to 1 mmol) , and 1,8 -BDN at a final concentration of 10 mM were added, in CH3CN (10 ml final volume) . The temperature was controlled at 320C. After incubation (range from 11.52 to 424 min) the product was recovered by evaporating the CH3CN. The corresponding product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure.
Synthetic method 26: this method is designed to perform partial dehalogenation in an halogenated unsaturated compound, followed by halogenation (iodization) to a sp3 carbon atom and further incorporation of Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component to this sp3 carbon atom and direct halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom and further incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) component to this sp3 carbon atom.
Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the metabolite nr. 242 shown in Table 1 and Figures 8 and 9.
1. Formation of I-metabolite . The iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via α-KG prior selective dehalogenation. First, the metabolite (100 μl of a 10 mM solution in MeOH final concentration of 1 mM) was added to 900 μl in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) and dehalogenase (32 μM) . Reaction was allowed to proceed at 40 °C for 5 hours. Then the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product (mixture of partial dehalogenated products) was concentrated by liophilization. The purified intermediate ( 95% pure) was used for a subsequent iodization reaction as follows. The metabolite was subjected to transesterification with vinyl acetate using ELl-Lewatit. Briefly, metabolite (0.029 mmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, vinyl acetate (0.29 mmol) was added. When the conversion of the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The product was recovered by evaporating the tert-amyl alcohol. The crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The product so obtained was further subjected to iodide halogenation via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the metabolite (2.1 mM) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (32 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG and up to 5% DMSO, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 10 h of incubation at 37°C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. I-metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 μg/ml . HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated two "I" per molecule at the end of the two-step proccess .
2. Incorporation of histidine . I-metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. The incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8-BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . (loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, to a solution of I-metabolite (concentration range from 0.1 to 2.3 mmol) , histidine (concentration range from 0.44 to 1 mmol) , and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 10 mM were added, in CH3CN (10 ml final volume) . The temperature was controlled at 320C. After incubation (range from 11.52 to 424 min) the product was recovered by evaporating the CH3CN. The corresponding product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure.
Synthetic method 27 for labelling DNA 1 (5-GAC GCT GCC GAA TTC TGG CTT GCT AGG ACA TCT TTG CCC ACG TTG ACC C- 3) : The substrate contain a mixture of labelled metabolites at different position of the DNA substrate (see attached figure) . Only when an endonuclease cut close to the base where the Cy3 and His are close, the Cy3 is released. When attached to G, C or A the synthetic method includes a direct halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) through an NH2 group of the metabolite.
Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the DNA nucleotide shown in Figure 9.
1. Formation of I-metabolite. The iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the oligonucleotide (6.6 nmol) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (131 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG, in a final volume of 0.8 ml. After 150 h of incubation at 37°C, the reaction mixture was transferred to 1.5 ml filtration unit (3-kDa membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the products were purified by semi- preparative HPLC. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 1.5 nmol/ml. HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule per base. I -metabolite obtained is a complex mixture of halogenated molecules in which G, C, A and T bases are halogenated. 2. Incorporation of histidine. I -metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. A histidine molecule was incorporated by enzymatic amidation of the previous intermediate and ELl-Lewatit. Solvents were dried over 3 A molecular sieves for 24 h prior to use. Briefly, metabolite (21.8 nmol) was dissolved in 5 mL of
DMSO and 2M2B was slowly added to a final volume of 25 mL. The biocatalyst (Lewatit lipase ELl, 2.5 g) and 3 A molecular sieves (2.5 g) were then added and the suspension maintained 30 min at 400C with magnetic stirring. Then, histidine (12.9 mmol) was added. An excess of histidine was used to facilitate the reaction yield. When the conversion to the corresponding ester reached the maximum value, the mixture was cooled, filtered and washed with 2M2B. The crude product was further purified by semi -preparative HPLC to obtain a mixture of his tagged oligonucleotide. Using this method histidine linking is mainly performed at the G, C and A bases due to the presence of an amine group through which the histidine is incorporated. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of l.lnmol/ml.
When attached to thyamine (T) the synthetic method includes a direct halogenation to sp3 carbon atoms and further incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) and Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component to those sp3 carbon atoms.
Example of metabolite subjected to this synthetic protocol is the DNA nucleotide shown in Figure 9.
1. Formation of I-metabolite. The iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the oligonucleotide (6.6 nmol) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (131 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG, in a final volume of 0.8 ml. After 150 h of incubation at 370C, the reaction mixture was transferred to 1.5 ml filtration unit (3-kDa membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the products were purified by semi- preparative HPLC. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 1.5 nmol/ml. HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule per G, T and A while incorporated two "I" per thymine (T) . I -metabolite obtained is a complex mixture of halogenated molecules in which G, C, A and T bases are halogenated.
2. Incorporation of histidine. I-metabolite was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. The incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8-BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . (loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon {loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, to a solution of I-metabolite (1.3 nmol), histidine (6.8 nmol), and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 1 μM were added, in CH3CN (1 ml final volume) . The temperature was controlled at 320C. After 34.1 min incubation the product was recovered by evaporating the CH3CN. The corresponding products were purified by semi -preparative HPLC. Using this method a heterogeneous mixture of products is formed: histidine tags can be incorporated to G, A and C through one position of the the ribose ring or to the two positions of T (one to the ribose and one to the base) . Therefore, the product should be extensively purified by semi -preparative HPLC, to obtain the desired product, namely, that containing the His tag in the pyrimidine ring of thymine (T) .
Synthetic method 28 for labelling DNA 1 3 (5- TGG TCA TCA GGG CTT TAC CTC CCG GAC AAT CCG GAG CTT ACG GAG TAC CTG TAG
AGC TTC CTG TGC AAG C- 3) : direct halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) through an NH2 group of the metabolite. Only when an endonuclease cut close to the base where the Cy3 and His are close, the Cy3 is released. When attached to G, C or A the synthetic method includes a direct halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) through an NH2 group of the metabolite. When attached to thyamine (T) the synthetic method includes a direct halogenation to sp3 carbon atoms and further incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) and Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component to those sp3 carbon atoms.
The conditions for synthesis are those described in the method 27.
Synthetic method 29 for labelling labelling lambda DNA digested with Sau3AI: direct halogenation to a sp3 carbon atom to link it to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) component and incorporation of His (black arrow in Figure 9) through an NH2 group of the metabolite (in the G base at the 5'- moiety) .
DNA substrate is prepared as follows:
20 μl concentrated lambda DNA (12 μg) (from NEB) 7 μl Buffer NEBl 1OX 7 μl BSA 1OX
2 μl MiIIiQ water
36 μl Sau3AI 0.4U/μl
Total reaction volume: 70 μl
Incubate 40-60 min at 370C. Stop reactions by adding 65 mM EDTA 0.5 M pH 8 (1.5 μl for each 10 μl reaction volume) and heat the samples to 65 0C 15 min. Sample is loaded on a 20 cm long preparative gel 2% agarose, run it at 30-35 V overnight at 40C and cut and stain the slots with the DNA marker. Under UV light cut out the part of the gel blocks with the DNA markers in the range of ca . 100-200 bp . Cut out the desired gel region (25-40 Kb gel region) and trim excess agarose. Then proceed to the agarose gel digestion following the GELase (EPICENTRE) protocol and concentrate DNA. Once isolated the DNA then proceed as described below.
1. Formation of I-metabolite. The iodide halogenation of metabolite was performed via α-KG. The halogenation reaction contained the oligonucleotide (6.6 nmol) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (131 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG, in a final volume of 0.8 ml. After 150 h of incubation at 37°C, the reaction mixture was transferred to 1.5 ml filtration unit (3-kDa membrane cut-off) to remove the enzyme, and the products were purified by semi- preparative HPLC. I -metabolite was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -70 °C until used at a concentration of 1.5 nmol/ml. HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated one "I" per molecule per G, T and A while incorporated two "I" per thymine (T) . I -metabolite obtained is a complex mixture of halogenated molecules in which G, C, A and T bases are halogenated.
Steps 2 is similar to those described in synthesis 27.
Synthetic method 30 for labelling labelling a protein substrate (rhodonase) : the protein is partially unfolded and then a direct halogenation is performed to the valine, leucine and isoleucine amino acids to link them to Cy3 (grey arrow in Figure 9) and His (black arrow in Figure 9) components . Partially unfolded rhodonase was prepared and purified as described elsewhere (Ferrer et al . , MoI. Microbiol . 53, 167- 182 (2005) .
1. Formation of I-metabolite . The iodide halogenation of protein substrate was performed via α-KG at the N-terminal position. The halogenase used in this study showed a catalytic core which was accessible to the linearized protein, namely at its N-terminal position. The halogenation reaction contained the protein (1.0 nmol) , KI (5.0 mM) , and halogenase (108 μM) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) plus 2 mM α-KG, in a final volume of 0.5 ml. After 96 h of incubation at 370C, the reaction mixture was transferred to a 1.5 ml filtration unit (3000 NMWL membrane cut-off) to remove the non-enzymatic reaction components, and the product was purified by semi -preparative HPLC using a Bio- SiI SEC 400 column (Bio-Rad) pre-equilibrated with phosphate buffer. Separation was performed at room temperature at a flow rate of 1 ml min "". The following standards were used to calibrate the gel filtration column and to ensure than the protein substrate and the halogenase proteins are perfectly separated from the reaction mixture: E . GroEL (840 kDa) , tyroglobulin (669 kDa) , ferritin (440 kDa) , gamma-globulin (158 kDa) (Ferrer et al . , MoI. Microbiol. 53, 167-182 (2005) . Iodide protein was reconstituted and diluted in PBS buffer and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 2 pmol/ml.
2. Incorporation of histidine . Iodide protein was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. The incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1,8 -BDN as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . {loc . cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon (loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, to a solution of halogenated protein (1.2 pmol) , histidine (4.2 μmol) , and 1,8-BDN at a final concentration of 10 mM were added, in CH3CN (10 ml final volume) . The temperature was controlled at 320C. After 148 min incubation the product was recovered by evaporating the CH3CN. The corresponding product was purified by fast preparative liquid chromatography (FPLC) as described elsewhere (Ferrer et al., MoI. Microbiol. 53, 167-182 (2005) . Under these conditions the protein suffers an extensive denaturalization process .
To purify any of the above intermediates of final products, any of the following HPLC purification methods can be used.
Method 1 (standard for the purification of the final labelled metabolite)
Prontosil-AQ, 5 Im, 120 A, 250 • 8 mm column equipped with a Prontosil-AQ, 5 Im, 120 A, 33 8 mm pre- column, and compounds were eluted with acetonitrile (20% for 5 min, followed by linear gradients to 45% in 5 min, to 50% in 7 min and to 100% in 2 min) in triethylammonium hydrogen carbonate buffer (0.01 M, pH 8.6) at a flow of 0.4 to 3 mL/min.
Method 2 (standard for medium polar compounds)
Analytic : on a Mediterranea 5 μM C-18 column (250x4.6 mm, Macherey-Nagel) , equilibrated with 85% MeOH:15% H2O plus 0.1% acetic acid. Column was kept at 35°C and elution was performed at 55 atm and 0.7 ml/ml. Detection was performed both by light scattering (temp 68.2 0C, 1.8 1/min) and PDA (250, 300 and 400 nm) . Semi -preparative : on a Mediterranea 5 μM C-18 column (250x4.6 mm, Macherey-Nagel) , equilibrated with 85% MeOH:15% H2O plus 0.1% acetic acid. Column was kept at 35°C and elution was performed at 55 atm and 3.0 ml/ml. Detection was performed both by light scattering (temp 68.2 0C, 1.8 1/min) and PDA (250, 300 and 400 nm) .
Method 3 (standard for medium polar esters) Analytic : using a ternary pump (model 9012, Varian) coupled to a thermostatized (25 0C) autosampler (model L-2200, VWR International) . The temperature of the column was kept constant at 45 0C. Detection was performed using a photodiode array detector (ProStar, Varian) in series with an evaporative light scattering detector (ELSD, model
2000ES, Alltech) , and integration was carried out using the Varian Star LC workstation 6.41. For the analysis the column was a Lichrospher 100 RP8 (4.6 x 125 mm, 5 μm, Analisis Vinicos) , and the mobile phase was 70:30 (v/v) H20/methanol (H2O contained 0.1% of acetic acid) at 1 mL/min for 5 min. Then, a gradient from this mobile phase to 50:50 (v/v) H20/methanol was performed in 5 min, and this eluent was maintained during 15 min. For preparative scale the column was Mediterranea-C18 (4.6 x 150 mm, 5 μm, Teknokroma, Spain) . The mobile phase was 90:10 (v/v) methanol/H20 (H2O contained 0.1% of formic acid) at 1.5 mL/min.
Semi -preparative: using a ternary pump (model 9012, Varian) coupled to a thermostatized (25 0C) autosampler (model L- 2200, VWR International) . The temperature of the column was kept constant at 45 0C. Detection was performed using a photodiode array detector (ProStar, Varian) in series with an evaporative light scattering detector (ELSD, model 2000ES, Alltech) , and integration was carried out using the Varian Star LC workstation 6.41. For preparative scale the column was Mediterranea-C18 (4.6 x 150 mm, 5 μm, Teknokroma, Spain) . The mobile phase was 90:10 (v/v) methanol/H20 (H2O contained 0.1% of formic acid) at 1.5 mL/min.
Method 4 (standard for short sugars)
Analytic: Using a pump (Spectra-Physics Inc., Model SP 8810) coupled to a Nucleosil 100-C18 column (250mmx4.6 mm) (Sugelabor, Spain) . The mobile phase was water at 0.5 ml min x . The column was kept constant at 40 0C. A differential refractometer (Waters, model 2410) was used and set to a constant temperature of 45 0C.
Semi -preparative 1: using a system equipped with a Waters Delta 600 pump, a Nucleosil 100-C18 column (250mmxl0 mm) (Sugelabor, Spain) coupled to a precolumn (50mmxl0 mm) packed with the same stationary phase. A differential refractometer (Varian, model 9040) set to 35 0C and a fraction collector (Waters) were used. Water was the mobile phase (2.4 ml min x) , and the column temperature was kept constant at 40 0C.
Semi -preparative 2: with a quaternary pump (Delta 600, Waters) coupled to a 5 μM Lichrosorb-NH2 column (4.6mmx250 mm) (Merck) . Detection was performed using an evaporative light scattering detector DDL-31 (Eurosep) equilibrated at 85 C. Acetonitrile : water 85:15 (v/v), degassed with helium, was used as mobile phase at 0.9 ml min1 for 8.1 min. Then, a gradient from this eluent to acetonitrile : water 75:25 (v/v) was performed in 2 min, and held for 6 min. A new gradient to acetonitrile : water 70:30 (v/v) was performed in 5 min and held for 14 min. Total analysis time was 35 min. The column temperature was kept constant at 25 0C.
Method 5 (standard for short length esters) Analytic: The pump (Spectra-Physics Inc., Model SP 8810) was coupled to a Nucleosil 100-C18 column (250mmx4.6 mm) (Sugelabor, Spain) . The mobile phase was 80% MeOH: 20% H2O at 0.5 ml min 1. The column was kept constant at 40 0C. A differential refractometer (Waters, model 2410) was used and set to a constant temperature of 45 0C.
Semi -preparative : using a system equipped with a Waters Delta 600 pump, a Nucleosil 100-C18 column (250mmxl0 mm) (Sugelabor, Spain) coupled to a precolumn (50mmxl0 mm) packed with the same stationary phase. A differential refractometer (Varian, model 9040) set to 35 0C and a fraction collector (Waters) were used. 80% MeOH: 20% H2O was the mobile phase (2.4 ml min1), and the column temperature was kept constant at 40 0C.
Method 6 (standard for long length fatty and their sugar derivatives)
Analytic : using a system equipped with a Spectra-Physics pump, a Sugelabor Nucleosil 100-C18 column (250 x 4.6 mm) and a refraction index detector (Spectra-Physics) . For the analysis methanol/water 95:5 (v/v) was used as mobile phase (flow rate 1.5 mL/min) and the temperature of the column was kept constant at 400C.
Semi -preparative : using a system equipped with a Waters Delta 600 pump, a Nucleosil 100-C18 column (250mmxl0 mm) (Sugelabor, Spain) coupled to a precolumn (50mmxl0 mm) packed with the same stationary phase. A differential refractometer (Varian, model 9040) set to 35 0C and a fraction collector (Waters) were used. 90% MeOH: 10% H2O or 95% MeOH:5% H2O was the mobile phase (2.8 ml min x) , and the column temperature was kept constant at 40 0C.
Method 7 (standard for folate derivatives)
Analytic : on a Nucleosil 100-C18 column (250 x 4.6 mm) using isocratic program of 88% A and 12% B in 30 min at a flow rate of 0.3 ml/min. Mobile phase A consisted of 0.1% formic acid while mobile phase B consisted of 0.1% formic acid in a 95:5 acetonitrile/water solution. Diode array detector (DAD) was set at 290 nm.
Semi -preparative: using a system equipped with a Waters Delta 600 pump, a Nucleosil 100-C18 column (250mmxl0 mm) (Sugelabor, Spain) coupled to a precolumn (50mmxl0 mm) packed with the same stationary phase. A differential refractometer (Varian, model 9040) set to 35 0C and a fraction collector (Waters) were used. 80% MeOH: 20% H2O was the mobile phase (2.4 ml min1), and the column temperature was kept constant at 40 0C.
Method 8 (standard for short length alkanes)
Analytic: on a 5 μM LiChroCart 125-4 RP 18 column (Merck) . The initial solvent composition was 20% methanol-80% phosphate buffer (20 inM) , pH 4.8, reaching 100% methanol within 14 min at a flow rate of 1 ml min"1. Detection was performed both by light scattering (temp 68.2 0C, 1.8 1/min) .
Semi -preparative: on a 5 μM LiChroCart 125-4 RP 18 column (Merck) at a flow rate of 1 ml min"1. For sufficient separation, the solvent system, consisting of methanol (eluent A) and ammonium acetate buffer (20 mM, pH 4.8) (eluent B) , was started in a ratio of 20% A and 80% B and reached 70% A and 30% B within 12.5 min, and then it was changed to 100% A within 30 s and held constant for another 5 min.
Method 9 (standard for medium and long length alkanes)
Analytic: on a 2.7 μM Halo C8 (150x4.6 mm) column with MeOH: H2O: acetic acid (750:250:4) as buffer A and acetonitrile: methanol :THF:acetic acid (500:375:125:4) as buffer B at a flow rate of 0.8 ml min"1. Gradient was performed from 100 buffer A to 100% buffer B in 60 min. Column was kept at 35°C and elution was performed at 55 atm and 0.8 ml/ml. Detection was performed both by light scattering (temp 68.2 0C, 1.8 1/min) .
Semi -preparative: on a 2.7 μM Halo C8 (150x4.6 mm) column with MeOH: H2O: acetic acid (750:250:4) as buffer A and acetonitrile :methanol :THF:acetic acid (500:375:125:4) as buffer B and at a flow rate of 2.2 ml min"1. Gradient was performed from 100 buffer A to 100% buffer B in 60 min. Column was kept at 35 °C and elution was performed at 55 atm and 0.8 ml/ml . Detection was performed both by light scattering (temp 68.2 0C, 1.8 1/min) .
Method 10
Analytic 1: on a Nucleosil 100-C18 column (250 x 4.6 mm) using isocratic program of 88% A and 12% B in 30 min at a flow rate of 0.3 ml/min. Mobile phase A consisted of 0.1% formic acid while mobile phase B consisted of 0.1% formic acid in a 95:5 acetonitrile/water solution. Diode array detector (DAD) was set at 290 nm. Analytic 1: on a SC125/Lichrospher column (250 x 4.6 mm) . The mobile phase was 0.01% (vol/vol) H3PO4 (87%) and 50% (vol/vol) methanol at 1.0 ml min x . The column was kept constant at 40 0C. A differential refTactometer (Waters, model 2410) was used and set to a constant temperature of 35 0C.
Semi -preparative: using a system equipped with a Waters Delta 600 pump, a Nucleosil 100-C18 column (250mmxl0 mm) (Sugelabor, Spain) coupled to a precolumn (50mmxl0 mm) packed with the same stationary phase. A differential refractometer (Varian, model 9040) set to 35 °C and a fraction collector (Waters) were used. 0.01% (vol/vol) H3PO4 (87%) and 50% (vol/vol) methanol was the mobile phase (2.0 ml min 1J , and the column temperature was kept constant at 40 0C.
8. Incorporation of (H) derivatives to the poly(A) - nitrilotriacetic-Co(II) complex The final step in the labeled metabolite development is the incubation of the histidine functionalized Cy3 -metabolites with poly (A) -nitrilotriacetic-Co (II) complexes in 50 mM phosphate buffer, 50 mM NaCl, pH 7.5 for 1 hour at 25 °C. When required, DMSO was added to increase substrate solubility up to 50%. Briefly, 0.015 mmol (13 mg) (H) was dissolved in 5 ml 50 mM phosphate buffer, 150 mM NaCl, pH 7.5 (PBS) , containing up to 50% DMSO depending on the solubility of the molecule, with 0.025 mmol (B) in a 15 ml falcon tube which was placed on a rotatory shaker for 1 h at 250C. To ensure that each (H) molecule binds to (B) through both of its His residues, analytical HPLC and 59Co-NMR analyses were performed (see data in Table Sl) , and only derivatives incorporating single Cy3 -labelled molecules (I) were purified by semipreparative reverse-phase HPLC (Prontosil-AQ, 5 Im, 120 A, 250 • 8 mm column equipped with a Prontosil-AQ, 5 Im, 120 A, 33 • 8 mm pre-column, and compounds were eluted with acetonitrile (20% for 5 min, followed by linear gradients to 45% in 5 min, to 50% in 7 min and to 100% in 2 min) in triethylammonium hydrogen carbonate buffer (0.01 M, pH 8.6) at a flow of 0.4 to 3 mL/min. Overall, yields higher than 93% were achieved. Fractions containing labelled metabolites were pooled and solvent evaporated. Molecules were dissolved in PBS buffer containing 50% DMSO and stored in 384 microtiter plates at - 70 °C until used at concentration of 40 μM.
Reaction scheme (a general schematic metabolite nM" is represented)*:
Figure imgf000140_0001
* R, indicated the PoIy(A) tail used to bind to the glass slides .
9. Binding of (H) to gold nanoparticles
Au-6 , 8-dithioctic acid (TA) clusters were synthesized as described by Abad et al . , J Am Chem Soc 127, 5689 (2005) and used to create Au-TA-ANTA-Co (II) -metabolite-Cy3 clusters. The Au-TA clusters were linked to (H) by overnight amidation in a single step in the presence of 3 mM N- hydroxysuccinimide (NHS, Fluka) and 3 mM l-ethyl-3- [3Φ-
(dimethylamino) propyl] carbodiimide (EDC, Sigma) in 20 mM HEPES buffer (pH 7.5) . Further purification of nanoparticles
(J) containing Cy3 labeled metabolites was carried out by ultrafiltration through low-adsorption hydrophilic 30000 NMWL cutoff membranes (regenerated cellulose, Amicon) . As an average value, a concentration of 9 x 1010 particles/ml of diameter ~2.9 ± 0.8 nm that corresponds to a surface area of ~ 141 ± 3 cm2/ml, binds 62.5 pmol of (H) .
Reaction scheme (a general schematic metabolite "M" is represented) :
Figure imgf000141_0001
SYNTHESIS EXAMPLE 1 :
Step (1) to (5) are described above. Step 6. X-GaI source
5-Bromo-4-chloro-3 -indolyl β-D-galactopyranoside (X-GaI) was provided by Roche Diagnostics (IN, USA) (ref. 10651745001) , further reconstituted and diluted in DMSO, and stored at - 700C until used at a concentration of 100 mg/ml .
Step 7. Formation of iodide X-GaI, further incorporation of histidine to iodide-X-Gal and formation of Cy3-labeled X-GaI
The iodide halogenation of X-GaI was performed via I" as follows. The reaction mixture was incubated at 37°C with X- GaI (0.080 mmol; 32.69 mg dissolved in 0.1 ml DMSO) , KI (75 mM) , 2 mM NADH, and REBr dehalogenase (4 mg/ml, 100 μL) in phosphate buffer (20 mM, pH 7.8) at a final volume of 0.5 ml. The final volume of DMSO was keep at 20% v/v in order to maintain the solubility of the X-GaI. After 24 hour of incubation reaction product was separated by HPLC on a Hypersil 5 μM C-18 column (250x4.6 mm, Macherey-Nagel) equilibrated with KH2PO4 (50 mM) and acetonitrile (85:15 v/v) . Runs were performed by gradient elution from a starting mobile phase of KH2PO4 (50 mM) and acetonitrile (85:15 v/v) to a final mobile phase consisting of KH2PO4 (50 mM) and acetonitrile (60:40 v/v) . The purified iodide X-GaI was found to be 95% pure (13.8 g, 26% yield; white solid crystalline powder) . Iodide X-GaI was reconstituted and diluted in DMSO and stored at -700C until used at a concentration of 10 mg/ml. HRMS data clearly show that the enzyme incorporated two "I" per molecule. HRMS: calculated for Ci4H13BrCl I2NO6 , 658 . 7704 , [M+H+] found was 659 . 7770 . Reaction scheme :
Figure imgf000142_0001
Iodide X-GaI was further functionalized via incorporation of a histidine tag. The incorporation of histidine was performed in the presence of the non-nucleophilic base and proton sponge 1 , 8-bis- (dimethylamino) -napthalene (Sigma) as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . {loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemmon {loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, to a solution of iodide X-GaI (0.1 mmol ; 65.8 mg) , histidine (1 mmol, 156 mg) , and 1 , 8-bis- (dimethylamino) - napthalene at a final concentration of 10 mM, in CH3CN. The temperature was controlled at 320C. After 100 min incubation the product was recovered by evaporating the CH3CN. The corresponding product was purified by semipreparative reverse-phase HPLC (Prontosil-AQ, 5 Im, 120 A, 250 • 8 mm column equipped with a Prontosil-AQ, 5 Im, 120 A, 33 8 mm pre-column, and compounds were eluted with acetonitrile (20% for 5 min, followed by linear gradients to 45% in 5 min, to 50% in 7 min and to 100% in 2 min) in triethylammonium hydrogen carbonate buffer (0.01 M, pH 8.6) at a flow of 0.4 to 3 mL/min. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure (21 mg, 32% yield; white solid crystalline powder) .
Mass spectrometry was used to confirm the structure. HRMS: calculated for C20H2IBrClIN4O8 was 685.9276, [M+H+] found 686.9266. As shown, the result was within of the calculated molecular mass. Reaction scheme:
Figure imgf000143_0001
The corresponding labeled quaternary ammonium X-GaI were obtained in the presence of 1 , 8-bis- (dimethylamino) - napthalene (Sigma) as described by R. A. Kaufman et al . {loc. cit.) and F. Mazzetti and R. M. Lemraon (loc. cit.) with small modifications. Briefly, the general method for the synthesis of quaternary amines is as follows. Reaction mixture (2 ml) contains histidine tagged iodide-X-Gal (0.078 mmol, 53.4 mg) , 0.78 mmol of (E) and 1 , 8-bis- (dimethylamino) -napthalene at a final concentration of 100 mM in DMSO. The temperature was controlled at 320C. After 100 min incubation the product was recovered by evaporating the CH3CN. The labeled product was purified by semipreparative reverse-phase HPLC (Prontosil-AQ, 5 Im, 120 A, 250 • 8 mm column equipped with a Prontosil-AQ, 5 Im, 120 A, 33 • 8 mm pre-column, and compounds were eluted with acetonitrile (20% for 5 min, followed by linear gradients to 45% in 5 min, to 50% in 7 min and to 100% in 2 min) in triethylammonium hydrogen carbonate buffer (0.01 M, pH 8.6) at a flow of 0.4 to 3 mL/min. The purified metabolite was found to be 98% pure (47.3 mg, 41% yield; white solid crystalline powder) . Mass spectrometry was used to confirm the structure. HRMS: calculated for C65H82BrClN11Oi8S2 was 1482.4153, [M+H+] found 1483.4106.
Reaction scheme
Figure imgf000144_0001
Steps (8) and (9) are as described above. EXAMPLE 6 :
SM spotting and detection of protein-SM transformations.
SM-Cy3s (0.25 nL droplets of 3.5 pmol/i in DMSO/PBS = 1:1; spot size 400 μm diameter) were spotted by means of a
MicroGrid II micro-arrayer (Biorobotics) onto a glass slide, followed by fixation by cross-linking through the poly A tail. Each SM was spotted in triplicate on each slide. Buffer controls were applied for comparison. Sixty μl of cell lysate at a protein concentration of 0.1 mg/ml in PBS buffer was deposited on the slide and incubated at room temperature for 30 to 180 min. PBS buffer was used as a control. The slide was then washed with PBS and deionized water, dried by standard array slide centrifugation protocol and fluorescence intensities of the spots were measured with a microarray laser scanning system (Axon) set to a pmt of 500 and 100% laser power. Signals were analyzed and quantified using GenePix pro 4.1 software (Axon) . Through the analysis of three micro-arrays of three biological replicates, average values and standard deviations were calculated using the Microsoft Excel programme. The average deviation is given in the caption of Table 3. Each data point was normalized to the signal intensity obtained with X-Gal-Cy3 and pure β-galactosidase (150 pg/ml) , and normalized signal intensities were compared to those produced by the control array incubated with buffer. Normalization with the Cy3 β-Gal-signal intensity eliminated errors of signal intensity variation between arrays. All values given in Table 3 are therefore Cy3 -signal corrected signal intensities after lysate incubation compared to buffer-only incubation. On the average of four Cy3- signal intensity measurements, the signal intensity of SM-Cy3 on the buffer- incubated array was 0.2% lower than the signal intensity of lysate- incubated array, showing high reproducibility of the Cy3 -signal intensity and thus the legitimacy of using it as standardization factor.
EXAMPLE 7:
Data Analysis. After background subtraction, signal intensities for each replica were normalized and manually analyzed using Excel program (Microsoft) and GenePix Pro 6 Demo Program (http : //www.moleculardevices . com/product literature/family links .php?familyid=14) . MultiExperiment Viewer software (Sun Microsystems Inc) was used to visualize and compare differences in signal intensity.
EXAMPLE 8:
Construction of (meta) genomic libraries. DNA was extracted from three environments which differdiffering by in regard to the species composition and richness and main environmental constraints and the corresponding insert - libraries were constructed.
Kolguev Island coastal seawater (KOL) : A 200 ml sample of the coastal seawater of Kolguev Island (Barents Sea, Russia) was placed into a 1 L Erlenmeyer flask containing sterile crude oil (Arabian light, 0.5 % (vol/vol) ) and nutrients ([NH4]2PO4, 0.05% (w/vol)) . After four weeks of incubation at 4 0C on a rotary shaker, total DNA was extracted the culture with G' NOME DNA Extraction Kit (Qbiogene; Carlsbad, California) , and a metagenome expression library in the bacteriophage lambda-based ZAP phagemid vector (ZAP Express Kit, Stratagene) , was constructed as described in the manufacturers' protocols. A library of 8 x 106 phage particles, average insert size about 6 kbp, was thereby generated. Phage particles were used to infect E. coli XLl Blue MRF' and subsequent mass excision was performed by using E. coli XLOLR cells, as recommended by the supplier. Vulcano Island (VUL) : The fosmid library was established from the DNA isolated from the enrichment of microbial community from acidic pool of Porto Levante on Vulcano
Island, Italy. Sulphfur and iron-containing sandy volcanic acidic (pH 1.5-4) hydrothermal pool sample was enriched with the medium 874 (pH 1.7) (DSMZ, http : //www. dsmz . de) containing 0.1% (w/vol) yeast extract and was incubated for 4 weeks at 45°C with shaking. The total amount of fosmid clones was 11520. The DNA was extracted using G'NOME DNA Extraction Kit (BIOlOl, Qbiogene) and was cloned using Fosmid Library Production Kit (Epicentre) as recommended by the suppliers. L'Atalante seawater-brine interface sample (L1A) : The brine- seawater interface above hypersaline anoxic basin L'Atalante (Eastern Mediterranean Sea) was sampled during the MedBio2 oceanographic cruise in December 2006 from the depth of 3.431 meters. The 50 mL-samples were placed into sterile 100 ml Hungate bottles containing resazurine (anoxia indicator) , 1 g/L yeast extract and 2 mM 13C-glucose. The salinity measured immediately after the cast was 180 g/L (NaCl) . After six months of incubation at 140C in the dark, the total DNA was extracted with G'NOME DNA Extraction Kit (BIOlOl, Qbiogene) and was further cloned using Fosmid Library Production Kit (Epicentre) as recommended by the suppliers .
P. putida KT2440: the total DNA was extracted with G'NOME DNA Extraction Kit (BIOlOl, Qbiogene) from 100 ml culture of this bacterium grown as described above and was further cloned using Fosmid Library Production Kit (Epicentre) as recommended by the suppliers. EXAMPLE 9 :
Culture conditions and general procedure for the preparation of protein lysates. Cells of P. putida KT2440 were grown at 30 °C in 100 mL-flasks filled with 10 mL minimal medium (MM) prepared as follows. A solution with "Epure" water containing (NH4) 2SO4 (2 g/L) , Na2HPO412H20 (6 g/L) , KH2PO4 (3 g/L) and NaCl (3 g/L) was adjusted to pH 7.0 ± 0.2 and then autoclaved. The medium was supplemented with 20 mM MgSO4, 10 mM FeSO4 and 15 mM Na-succinate (from a stock solution sterilized by filtration through a 0.22 μm filter
(Millipore) ) . Like in case of L'A and Volcano libraries, the individual clones were incubated overnight without shaking at 370C in LB medium, 12.5 g/ml chloramphenicol, in 384 microtiter plates. An aliquot of 10 μl each culture were pooled together in appropriate flasks filled with IL medium and subsequently incubated 6 additional hours (OD60onm 1-5) at 370C. For lambda phage Kolguev library, mass excision in E. coli XLOLR was done following the protocol recommended by the supplier. The pool of clones (from phagemids of fosmids) was grown with shaking at 370C in LB medium, with 50 g/ml kanamycin until OD6oonm 1.5. After cultivation the cells were harvested by centrifugation (5000 g) for 15 min to yield 2-3 g/L of pellet. The cell pellet was frozen at -800C overnight and then thawed. Cold PBS buffer was added directly to the frozen pellets (1.2 ml per 0.3 grs cell pellet) . The mixture was vortexed to homogeneity and subsequently sonicated for 2 min (total time) . The extract was centrifuged for 15 min at 15,000 g to separate cell debris and intact cells. The supernatant was carefully collected avoiding disturbing the pellet, and transferred to new tubes. Then, the extracts were immersed in liquid nitrogen and subjected to lyophilisation in order to avoid volatile contaminants. After that, extracts were resuspended in 1.2 mL PBS buffer and protein concentration was determined by a standard procedure (38) and further fixed to 0.1 mg/ml .
EXAMPLE 10: Representative procedure for the synthesis of SMs-Cy3 gold nanoparticles for identification and N- terminal sequencing of SM-acting proteins. Au-6 , 8-dithioctic acid (TA) clusters were synthesized as described by Abad et al . (36) and used to create Au-TA-ANTA-Co (II) -SMs-Cy3 clusters. Briefly, the Au-TA clusters were incorporated to the ANTA-Co (II) -SMs-Cy3 by overnight amidation in a single step in the presence of 3 mM iV-hydroxysuccinimide (NHS, Fluka) and 3 πiM 1-ethyl -3 - [3Φ- (dimethylamino) propyl] carbodiimide (EDC, Sigma) in 20 mM HEPES buffer (pH 7.5) .13 Further purification was carried out by ultrafiltration through low-adsorption hydrophilic 30 000 NMWL cutoff membranes (regenerated cellulose, Amicon) . Enzymatic binding was carried out by incubation of the functionalized nanoparticles (40 g cm"3) in PBS buffer, pH 7.5 overnight at room temperature with protein solution (0.1 mg/ml in PBS) . Au-TA-ANTA-Co2+-protein nanoparticles were separated from unbound enzyme molecules by ultrafiltration through low-adsorption hydrophilic 100 000 NMWL cutoff membranes (Amicon) . Identification of bound proteins was performed by in situ trypsin digestion and ESI-Q-TOF MS/MS mapping (M. Ferrer et al . , Nature 445, 91 (2007)) that provides improved mass measurement accuracy for peptide sequencing and enables unambiguous protein identification. ESI-Q-TOF MS/MS analyses were performed at the Sequencing Core Facility of the Autonomous University of Madrid. For each experiment, up to three binding experiments were prepared and analyzed. EXAMPLE 11 :
PCR amplification of genes encoding hypothetical proteins from P. putida KT2440 and metagenomic libraries.
P. putida KT2440 and metagenomic hypothetical proteins were amplified by PCR from genomic and metagenomic DNA using the set of primers detailed in Table 4. Cycling parameters were 2 min at 95°C followed by 25 cycles at 950C for 30 s, 660C for 30 s, and 72°C for 20-140s (see specific elongation temperature for each protein inTable 4) , and ending with 10 min at 72°C. KOL-I, -2 and -7 and VUL-9 proteins were amplified by PCR from the corresponding metagenomic DNA library using the set of primers detailed in Table 4. Cycling parameters were 5 min at 95°C followed by 25 cycles at 95°C for 1 min, 55°C for 1 min, and 72°C for 1 min, and ending with 7 min at 720C. PCR products were ligated in pGEMT plasmid (Promega) .
EXAMPLE 12 :
Gene cloning, expression and purification. All proteins characterized in this study were cloned into pET-41 Ek/LIC vector (Novagen) and expressed with an N-terminal fusion to 6xHis tag, according to manufacturer's instructions and plasmids were subsequently isolated and introduced into E. coli ORIGAMI (DE3) pLysS expression host. Full-length of gene coding for proteins were amplified from the P. putida genome by polymerase chain reaction (PCR) , whereas full-length of proteins from libraries were amplified with degenerated primers based on the Q-TOF peptide obtained (Table 4) . Proteins were expressed in Escherichia coli strain ORIGAMI (DE3)pLysS (Novagen) . Cultures were grown overnight in Luria-Bertani medium containing 100 mg/ml ampicillin and 50 mg/ml kanamycin, then diluted 1:100 in fresh medium. Cells were grown at 370C to a final OD6oo of 0.5, induced with 1 rtiM isopropyl- -D-thiogalactopyranoside (IPTG) and incubated at 37°C for an additional 4 h. Cell pellets were collected by centrifugation at 4 1C for 20 min at 8,00Og. Pellets were then suspended in 25 ml prechilled lysis buffer (Complete EDTA-free protease inhibitor tablet (Roche) , 150 mM NaCl, 1 mM dithiothreitol , 50 mM Hepes, pH 7.0 , 5 mM imidazole) and lysed by sonication on ice for 3 min with 30 s intervals. Cell lysates were centrifuged once more at 4°C for 20 min at 30,000 g, and the soluble fractions were retained. Proteins were purified using a 1-ml HisTag
(Novagen) according to the manufacturer's protocols and eluted in 250 mM imidazole and 50 mM H-EPES, pH 7.0. Elutions of 500 1 were collected, pooled and concentrated 100-fold using Microcon YM-3 spin columns (Millipore) . The molarities of all purified proteins were determined by using the corresponding extinction coefficient. Purified proteins were stored at -80 0C until further use.
EXAMPLE 13: Receiver Operating Characteristic (ROC) analysis.
The "receiver operating characteristic" (ROC) analysis is used to evaluate the performance of a binary classifier separating two populations (positive and negative cases) and it is becoming a standard in evaluating and comparing prediction methods (T. Fawcett, Pattern Recogn Lett 27, 861 (2006) ) . This analysis can be applied to classifiers (prediction methods) which associate a numerical score to each case. Ideally the classifier would tend to associate high scores to the positive cases and low scores to the negative ones (or the other way around) . The analysis is performed by sorting all the cases (positives and negatives) by their associated scores. This sorted list is then cut at different score thresholds and for each cut the true and false positive rates (TPR and FPR) are calculated as
TPR=TP/ (TP+FN) FPR= 1- (TN/ (TN+FP) )
Where, TP: "true positives" - cases predicted as positives (above the threshold for that particular cut) which are in fact positives (correct predictions); FN: "false negatives" - cases predicted as negatives (below the threshold) which are actually positives (wrong predictions) ; TN: "true negatives"; FP: "false positives". "TP/ (TP+FN) is also known as "sensitivity" and gives an idea of the fraction of positives recovered at this particular cut of the list (note that TP+FN is the total number of positive cases) . "TN/ (TN+FP) " is also known as "specificity".
The ROC plot is constructed by plotting TPR against FPR for the different cuts of the list. In such a representation, a random method (a classifier without discriminative power which spreads positives and negatives uniformly across the sorted list of scores) will produce a diagonal line from (0,0) to (1,1) . Methods with some discriminative power will generate curves above this line. The higher the curve (closer to the (0,1) corner) the better the method. A method with a perfect discriminative power (which puts all the positives together at the top of the list, associated to the highest scores) would be represented by a single point at (0,1) . A parameter based in this representation which quantifies the global performance of a method in the AUC ("area under curve") . The random method commented above will produce an AUC value of 0.50, while discriminative methods will produce AUC values between 0.50 and 1.00 (perfect discrimination) . In this study case, we used this analysis for evaluating the ability of our array to discriminate compounds which are actually metabolized by P. putida from those which are not. The score is the fluorescence intensity, under the idea that there will be a positive relationship between the intensity in the array and the compound being metabolized in P putida. We assume that compounds metabolized by P. putida are those which act as substrates in one or more chemical reactions in the metabolism of P. putida as reconstructed from KEGG (cf . above) for that organism. We took as P. putida reactions those for which the EC code or the KEGG orthologs code (ko) are associated to a P. putida K2440 gene ("PPU" in KEGG nomenclature) .
EXAMPLE 14:
Calculation of Z-scores for comparing samples in terms of functional classes. The z-score (Zi) for a given intensity value (Ii) is calculated as:
Figure imgf000153_0001
Where 7 and σ are the average and standard deviation of the all the intensity values in the array respectively. A Zi value of 0 means that the intensity is right in the average. A positive value means that the intensity is higher than the average, and the other way around for negative values. For each KEGG functional class for which more than 1676 compounds are in the array, we calculate the average Zi value of all the compounds belonging to that class [Z1) . A high Z1 value indicates that this class of compounds is highly metabolized in that particular sample (array) . Comparing the Z1 values for a given class in two arrays (samples) it is possible to known which metabolic activities are "emphasized" or "repressed" from one condition to the other. To quantify that, for each class we calculate the difference of its Z1 values in the two samples
(AZ1=Z12-Z11 ) .
It is important to note that the results in terms of which classes are over/under expressed are exactly the same using Zi or Ii values since, by definition, they are correlative (see equation above) . We used Zi values simply because they are easier to interpret in terms of relative intensities.
EXAMPLE 15:
Hydrogenase activity and IR measurements. The oxidation of H2 [H2 uptake) was followed spectrophotometrically due to the reduction of methyl viologen (MV) as described by De Lacey et al . , J Biol Anorg Chem 9, 636 (2004) :
H2 2e" + 2H+ +2BV2+ 2BV +
Buffers: The buffers used for the activity assay were: 1 mM MV in Tris-HCl 20 mM buffer pH 8.1 and sodium dithionite 10 or 100 mM in Tris-HCl 20 mM buffer pH 8.1.
Sample preparation: 0.2 mg/mL L'A62 protein in buffer Tris- HCl 20 mM pH 8.1. To this solution 1 μL of dithionite 10 mM solution is added. The IR spectra was measured as described by De Lacey et al . using a protein solution of 12 mM in Tris-HCl 50 mM pH 8.1. EXAMPLE 16 :
Construction rRNA gene clone libraries and clone sequencing.
PCR amplification was performed with 0.1 ng DNA template. 16S rRNA genes were amplified using the Eubacteria-specific forward primer F27 (51- AGAGTTTGATCMTGGCTCAG-3 ' ) in case of KOL and L1A and a universal F530 primer (5'-
TCCGTGCCAGCAGCCGCCG-3 ' ) for VUL library, in all cases in the combination with the universal reverse primer R1492 (5'- CGGYTACCTTGTTACGACTT-3 ' ) . Amplification was done in 20 μl reaction volume with recombinant Taq DNA Polymerase (Invitrogen, Gemany) and original reagents, according to the basic PCR protocol, with an annealing temperature of 450C (VUL) and 500C C (L1A and KOL), for 30 cycles. PCR amplicons were purified by electrophoresis on 0.8% agarose gels, followed by isolation from excised bands using a QIAEX II Gel Extraction Kit (Qiagen, Germany) . The purified PCR products were ligated into plasmid vector pCRII-TOPO (TOPO TA Cloning kit, Invitrogen, Germany) with subsequent transformation into electrocompetent cells of E. coli (TOP 10) (Invitrogen, Germany) . After blue/white screening, randomly picked clones were resuspended in PCR- lysis solution A without proteinase K (67 mM Tris-Cl (pH 8.8) ; 16 mM NH4SO4; 5 M - mercaptoethanol ; 6.7 mM MgCl 2; 6.7 M EDTA (pH 8.0) (Sambrook and Russel, 2002) and heated at 95C C for 5 min. The lysate (lμl) was used as DNA template for PCR amplification using primers M13F (5' -GACGTTGTAAAACGACGGCCAG- 3') and M13R ( 5 ' -GAGGAAACAGCTATGACCATG- 3 ' ) . After verification on the agarose gel, PCR products were purified with MinElute 96 UF PCR purification kit (Qiagen, Germany) and sequenced with M13 and M13R primers according to the protocol for BigDye Terminator vl .1 Cycle Sequencing Kit from Applied Biosysterns (USA) .
EXAMPLE 17:
Dose-response curves determined with E. coli β-galactosidase (β-Gal) .
To prove that the present array can discern active and non- active proteins and in parallel to determine the sensitivity of the system, we determined the molecule dose-response behaviour of active and inactive -Gal and vice versa. 5- Bromo-4-chloro-3-indolyl-D-galactopyranoside (X-GaI) modified with Cy3 as described in SYNTHESIS EXAMPLE 1, was used as substrate. Figure 4 shows the X-Gal-associated pixel intensity from the scanned slides plotted against the amount of X-GaI. As shown, 30 min incubation with a solution of only 5 ng pure β-Gal ml"1 at 200C was sufficient to ensure
50% of maximum fluorescence (F50) when 0.25 nl of a solution containing 0.12 pmol ml"1 substrate was spotted (signal to noise (S/N) ratio above 71) , while inactive protein was unable to release the Cy3 dye. Further, using 2.52 pmol X- Gal-Cy3 ml"1 50% of maximum fluorescence was reached above 1.86 ng β-Gal ml"1 (signal saturation above 95 ng ml"1) . According to this data, micro-array analysis were further performed by spotting 0.25 nl of substrate solutions at concentration of 2.52 pmol ml"1 and by arraying the slides with at least 0.10 mg protein lysate ml"1 to ensure detection of all proteins in the extract (it should be noted that enzyme concentrations as low as 1.5 ng ml"1 were sufficient to ensure appropriate detection with a S/N 10) . EXAMPLE 18 :
Characteristics of microbial communities examined.
In order to assess the utility of the array for the analysis of complex microbial communities as represented in metagenomic libraries, we obtained samples from three habitats with distinct physico-chemical characteristics and therefore distinct microbial communities and metabolic characteristics. The general characteristics of the three habitats are as follows: (i) acidic (pH 1.0-3) sulfur- and iron-rich (from 3 to more than 500 mg/1) sediments of a hydrothermal pool (25-750C) of Porto Di Levante, Vulcano Island (Italy) (H) oil-polluted, cold (I0C) coastal seawater sampled near Kolguev Island, Barents Sea, Russia, and (Hi) the seawater-brine interface of the deep hypersaline anoxic brine lake of the L'Atalante Basin,
Eastern Mediterranean Sea (140C) . All samples were used to produce enrichments cultures to obtain higher biomass levels for the subsequent analyses. The Vulcano Island sediment was introduced into an acidic (pH 1.7) ferrous iron- and sulfate-rich liquid medium and incubated for 4 weeks at 45°C to produce enrichment VOL; the Koluev Island coastal water was enriched with crude oil and incubated for 4 weeks at 40C to produce enrichment KOL; and the seawater : brine interface sample from the L'Atalante Basin was supplemented with glucose and yeast extract and incubated anaerobically for 6 months at 140C, to produce enrichment L' A. Thus: the microbial communities obtained for analysis represent communities from very distinct, rather extreme habitats: a low energy, low nutrient, heavy metal-rich habitat (VOL)7 a nutrient and energy-rich, organic pollutant -contaminated habitat (KOL) , and a hypersaline, anaerobic environment, inoculated with a sample taken also from a high pressure habitat but which was subsequently maintained at atmospheric pressure, so should contain facultative barophiles (L'A) .
EXAMPLE 19: General pan -reactome considerations.
As shown in Figure 6, the VUL reactome consisted of 807 compounds, the KOL reactome consisted of 1493 compounds, and the L'A reactome 2386. The restricted metabolic activity of the VUL sample was not unexpected, since the diversity of the community is low, the biomass concentration is low, and the prevailing physico-chemical conditions highly selective of a restricted metabolism. Similarly, the reactome of KOL was also not unexpected, since the excess carbon in the hydrocarbon-based enrichment leads to high cell densities and much recycling of cellular carbon in all its diverse forms. At first sight, it might seem that the extremely diverse metabolic profile of the L'A metagenome library is surprising, given the highly restricted diversity of the original community. However, it has been shown that a wide range of physico-chemical conditions prevail in the extremely steep chemoclines of the seawater :hypersaline brine interfaces of the brine lakes and this might select for organisms expressing a broader range of metabolic activities. In addition, it should be kept in mind that, on one hand, the oligotrophic environment selects for organisms expressing a wide range of nutrient scavenging systems constitutively at low levels, and in addition, anaerobic metabolism and salt and pressure tolerance systems not specified or expressed by the other two communities, and, on the other, the E. coli cellular environment may result in expression of a range of aerobic metabolism systems encoded, but not necessarily expressed under natural conditions, by the community organisms. Nevertheless, the exceptional richness of the metabolic profile of the L'A library is impressive .
EXAMPLE 20: The micro-array served as experimental platform to identify gene functions.
The methodology presented here provides a new window to study the functional composition of single cells and microbial communities without apparent need of sequence information as well as to identify many uncharacterized gene-coding enzymes. This has been shown by combining the array concept with high-throughput mass spectrometry peptide sequencing using metabolite-containing nanoparticles . To further prove this hypothesis we extent this analysis not only for P. putida extracts but also for the metagenome- derived extracts to analyse the possibility of mining protein diversity.
To test this, we randomly select nine SMs exhibiting positive signals (fluorescence values up to 35512) in the micro-array: four for P. putida lysates ( cis-2 -hydroxypenta- 2 , 4-dienoate, γ-carboxymuconolactone, 3-hydroxyanthranilate and dimethylallyl diphosphate) and five for KOL, VUL and L'A lysates (undecane, (S) -4 , 5 -dihydroxypentan-2 , 3-dione, 2- bromo-1-chloropropane, phosphatidylinositol-4 , 5-bisphosphate and methyl viologen) . To identify the proteins responsible for their transformation the corresponding Cy3 derivatives were synthesized, immobilized in a gold-magnetic nano- particle, and further incubated with P. putida or library lysates (Figure 2, right) . After 30 min at 200C incubation, the gold particles were separated by either magnetic attachment or centrifugation (5000 g x 15 min) and the attached proteins were identified by trypsin digestion followed by Q-TOF sequencing. Using peptide sequence fragments, degenerated oligonucleotides were designed, the corresponding genes were amplified using (meta) genomic DNA, cloned into the pET30 Ek/LIC expression vector and the proteins purified with a 6 x His tag. Analysis of fluorescence emission when different amounts of pure protein were incubated with different concentration of substrates and vice versa revealed that the obtained results matched the reactome data (Table 3) : Cy3 fluorescence emission increased when increasing the amount of both protein and substrate while inactive proteins do not (Figure 7) .
P. putida proteins: Sequence analysis revealed the identity of proteins acting against cis-2-hydroxypenta-2 , 4-dienoate, γ-carboxymuconolactone, 3-hydroxyanthranilate and dimethylallyl diphosphate - all of them correspond to the hypothetical proteins with no assigned function annotated PP_1394, PP_1752, PP_2949 and PP_1642 (Table 4) . However, the experimental analyses provided here suggest that these enzymes are accordingly new 2 -keto-4-pentenoate hydratase, 3 -carboxy- cis, cis-muconate cycloisomerase, 3- hydroxyanthranilate 3 , 4-dioxygenase and isopentenyl- diphosphate delta-isomerase (see Table 4) . This has also been shown by examining the activity of the pure proteins against standard substrates (data not shown) . The correlation of this identity with genomic context is as follows : here we observed that surrounding compounds are also metabolized by P. putida lysates, thus suggesting the presence of new metabolic pathways. A case of interest is the ability of protein PP_1394 to transform the conversion of cis-2 -hydroxypenta- 2 , 4-dienoate to cis-2 -hydroxypenta- 2, 4-dienoate as a part of the biphenyl degradation pathway. This pathway is not annotated in KEGG for P. putida KT2440 strain (cf. above), in spite of the fact that strains Fl, GBl and W619 clearly possess some genes responsible for p- cymene and 4-chlorobiphenyl degradation (see http://www.genome.jp/kegg/) . In contrast, array hits were found for the entire set of metabolites ranging from p- cymene to 2-hydroxy-6-oxo-7-methylocta-2 , 4-dienoate as well as from 4-chlorobiphenyl to cis-2 , 3-dihydro-2 , 3 -dihydroxy- 4 ' -chlorobiphenyl (fluorescence values up to 6931) (Figure 7) and further analysis of nanoparticle proteome analysis have also revealed the identity of proteins doing those transformations. These data suggest that the lysate of KT2440 contains enzymes that are able to metabolize those intermediates, even though genome information per se does not provide any evidence for that. This suggests in turn that many proteins may potentially enable, yet unknown, important catabolic activities expanding our knowledge on microbial metabolism of this bacterium.
Metagenomic proteins: Sequence analysis revealed that all of metagenomic proteins acting against undecane, (S) -4,5- dihydroxypentan-2 , 3 -dione, 2-bromo-l-chloropropane, phosphatidylinositol-4 , 5-bisphosphate and methyl viologen exhibited a high degree of similarity to predicted hypothetical proteins with no function assigned (Table 4), except L'A62, a 162 -amino acid polypeptide with a predicted molecular mass of 18,068 Da along with estimated pi of 4.55, that exhibited high similarity to a predicted [NiFe] hydrogenase from Carboxythermus hydrogenoformans (7e~54) . Data suggest these enzymes are new alkane hydroxylase, S- ribosylhomocysteine lyase, haloalkane dehalogenase, phosphatidylinositol-bisphosphatase and hydrogenase. To prove that assigned function are correct we select and preliminary characterized one of the most promising enzyme candidates, the L'A62 protein and reaffirmed this was indeed the case. A FTIR (Fourier Transform Infrared) spectrum of protein 62 was recorded at a final concentration of 8 M (Figure 7) . The bands that appear in the 2150-1900 cm"1 region are typical of the 1 carbonyl and 2 cyanide ligands of the active site of standard NiFe-hydrogenases (J. C. Fontecilla-Camps et al . , Chem Rev 107, 4273 (2007)) . The band of frequency value of 1947 cm"1 and the group of bands between 2080 and 2095 cm"1 correspond to the carbonyl ligand and the cyanide ligands respectively of this type of hydrogenases in the "unready" and "ready" oxidized states (A. De Lacey et al . , Biochem Biophys Acta 832, 69 (1985)) . The band at 1936 cm"1 can be assigned to the carbonyl ligand of irreversibly inactivated enzyme, whereas the bands at 2060 and 2073 cm"1 can be assigned to the cyanide ligands of the same state. Further, the H2-uptake activity of protein 62 was measured in a spectrophotometer using methyl viologen as electron acceptor (Figure 7, inset) . The protein isolated under aerobic conditions had the typical lag-phase of several minutes in the activity profile of standard NiFe- hydrogenases in the "unready" oxidized state (V. M. Fernandez et al . , Biochim Biophys Acta 832, 69 (1985)) . Incubation under H2 of the protein during several hours led to disappearing of the lag-phase and an increase of the maximum activity. This activation process is also a functional characteristic signature of standard NiFe- hydrogenases. Remarkably, the structural and functional data measured suggest an active site very similar to that of standard NiFe-hydrogenases, although the overall protein structure is unique up to date for this type enzymes (just 1 subunit of very small size, an amino acid sequence with no motifs for iron-sulfur clusters nor with the typical Ll or L2 signatures) (P.M. Vignais, B. BiIloud, Chem Rev 107, 4206 (2007) ) .
Table 1. Full description of synthetic methods used in the present study to synthesized all small molecules used for array imprinting
K)
Figure imgf000164_0001
Os
Figure imgf000165_0001
σ
Figure imgf000166_0001
\
Figure imgf000166_0002
Ul
Figure imgf000167_0001
Os
Figure imgf000169_0001
Figure imgf000170_0001
Figure imgf000171_0001
O
Figure imgf000172_0001
Figure imgf000173_0001
K>
Figure imgf000174_0001
Figure imgf000175_0001
Figure imgf000176_0001
Figure imgf000177_0001
Figure imgf000178_0001
Figure imgf000179_0001
OO
Figure imgf000180_0001
Figure imgf000181_0001
OO O
Figure imgf000182_0001
OO
Figure imgf000183_0001
OO K)
Figure imgf000184_0001
OO
Figure imgf000185_0001
OO 4-
Figure imgf000186_0001
OO Ul
Figure imgf000187_0001
OO
Figure imgf000188_0001
90
Figure imgf000189_0001
S
Figure imgf000190_0001
OO
Figure imgf000191_0001
O
Figure imgf000192_0001
VO
Figure imgf000193_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000194_0001
Figure imgf000195_0001
VO
Figure imgf000196_0001
Figure imgf000197_0001
Figure imgf000198_0001
Figure imgf000199_0001
Figure imgf000200_0001
VO
VO
Figure imgf000201_0001
K>
O O
Figure imgf000202_0001
K>
O
Figure imgf000203_0001
K>
O K)
Figure imgf000204_0001
κ>
O
Figure imgf000205_0001
K>
O
Figure imgf000206_0001
K>
O
Figure imgf000207_0001
κ>
O
Figure imgf000208_0001
K>
O
Figure imgf000209_0001
κ>
O 90
Figure imgf000210_0001
K>
O
Figure imgf000211_0001
κ>
O
Figure imgf000212_0001
Figure imgf000213_0001
κ>
K)
Figure imgf000214_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000215_0001
Figure imgf000216_0001
κ>
Ul
Figure imgf000217_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000218_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000219_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000220_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000221_0001
κ>
K)
O
Figure imgf000222_0001
κ>
K)
Figure imgf000223_0001
κ>
K) κ>
Figure imgf000224_0001
κ>
K)
Figure imgf000225_0001
κ>
K)
Figure imgf000226_0001
κ>
K) Ul
Figure imgf000227_0001
κ>
K)
Figure imgf000228_0001
Figure imgf000229_0001
κ>
K)
Figure imgf000230_0001
K> K)
Figure imgf000231_0001
κ>
O
Figure imgf000232_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000233_0001
κ>
K)
Figure imgf000234_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000235_0001
Figure imgf000236_0001
κ>
Ul
Figure imgf000237_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000238_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000239_0001
K)
W
OO
Figure imgf000240_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000241_0001
κ>
O
Figure imgf000242_0001
Figure imgf000243_0001
κ>
K)
Figure imgf000244_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000245_0001
Figure imgf000246_0001
κ>
'Jl
Figure imgf000247_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000248_0001
κ>
κ>
Figure imgf000250_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000251_0001
K) 'Jl
O
Figure imgf000252_0001
Figure imgf000253_0001
κ>
K>
Figure imgf000254_0001
κ>
'Jl
Figure imgf000255_0001
Ol
Figure imgf000256_0001
κ>
Ul
Figure imgf000257_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000258_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000259_0001
κ>
90
Figure imgf000260_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000261_0001
κ> o
Figure imgf000262_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000263_0001
κ>
K)
Figure imgf000264_0001
K)
Figure imgf000265_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000266_0001
κ>
ON Ul
Figure imgf000267_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000268_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000269_0001
OO
Figure imgf000270_0001
K>
Figure imgf000271_0001
κ>
O
Figure imgf000272_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000273_0001
κ>
K)
Figure imgf000274_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000275_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000276_0001
κ>
Ul
Figure imgf000277_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000278_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000279_0001
κ>
90
Figure imgf000280_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000281_0001
κ>
OO O
Figure imgf000282_0001
κ>
OO
Figure imgf000283_0001
K>
90 κ>
Figure imgf000284_0001
K>
90
Figure imgf000285_0001
K>
90
Figure imgf000286_0001
KJ
OC Ul
Figure imgf000287_0001
κ>
OO
Figure imgf000288_0001
K>
90
Figure imgf000289_0001
κ>
OO 90
Figure imgf000290_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000291_0001
K>
O
Figure imgf000292_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000293_0001
κ> κ>
Figure imgf000294_0001
Figure imgf000295_0001
K>
Figure imgf000296_0001
K>
Figure imgf000297_0001
Figure imgf000298_0001
Figure imgf000299_0001
κ>
N° Substrate N" Substrate Chemical Structure γ-Nonalactone 16 1,2,3-Oxadiazole
2 ε -Caprolactone 17 1,2,3-Triazine v-Triazole
3 10-Oxodecanoate 18 2,4-Butanetriol
4 1 -Bromodecane 19 (R)-1 ,
5 2-Bromodecane 20 1,2,4-Dioxazole
21 1,3>4-Oxadiazine
Figure imgf000300_0001
Substrate Chemical Structure N0 Substrate Chemical Structure
1 ,2-Didecanoyl-β-D- 1 , 1-Dibromopenti ane galactosyl-glycerol 42
Figure imgf000301_0001
Decane-l,2-diol
Dodecane- 1 ,2-diol
1 ,2,4-Triazole
1 ,2-Dipropionyl-3-β-D- galactosyl-sn-glycerol
l,2-Dibutyryl-3-β-D- galactosyl-sn-glycerol
1,2-Dihydroxy-1 ,2- 2- dihydronaphthalene
1,2-Butanediol
Figure imgf000301_0003
1 ,2-
Figure imgf000301_0004
l,2-Diacyl-3-O-(alpha-
D-glucopyranosyl(l->2)-
O-alpha-D- 1 ,2-Diazole glucopyranosyl)sn-
Figure imgf000301_0005
glycerol
Figure imgf000301_0002
N° Substrate Chemical Structure N° Substrate Chemical Structure
Hexacosane-1 ,2-diol
64
Figure imgf000302_0001
Figure imgf000302_0002
1 ,2-Didodecanoyl-sn-
54 65 1,2-Hexadecanodiol glycerol
Figure imgf000302_0003
Figure imgf000302_0004
<-
55 1,2-Oxazine
6 l ,2-Dioctanoyl-3-β-D- galactosyl-sn-glycerol
57 6-Deoxyerythronolide
Figure imgf000302_0005
Figure imgf000302_0006
Substrate N° Substrate
1 ,2-Dibutyryl-sn- β, Dithiazine glycerol
Propane- 1 ,2-diol-l- 1 ,2,5-Oxadiazine phosphate 88
Propane- 1,2-diol
89 1 ,3,5-Oxadithiane
Thiadiazine (R)-Propane- 1 ,2-diol 90
Figure imgf000303_0001
Figure imgf000303_0002
(S)-Propane- 1,2-diol
1 ,2-bis-O-Sinapoyl-?-D- glucoside
1 ,2-Tetracosanodiol
Figure imgf000303_0003
Figure imgf000303_0004
Substrate Substrate
1 ,2-Dihexanoyl-sn- 1,3-Dithiane glycerol
Figure imgf000304_0002
Deoxyuπdine
1,3-Dichloropentane
1,3-Dichlorobenzene
1 ,3-DidecanoyI-sn- glycerol
1,3-Dimethylbenzene
1,7-Dimethyluπc acid
1,3-Diolein
1,3,2-Dioxazole
(R)-2-Methylmalate
1,3,5-Tπthiane
Figure imgf000304_0001
1 ,2-Dipalmitoyl-3- myπstoylglycerol
1 ,3-Dioctadecanoyl-sn- glycerol
Figure imgf000304_0004
Figure imgf000304_0003
N" Substrate Chemical Structu re N° Substrate
1,5-Anhydro-D-
125 l ,4-Dichloro-2-butene mannitol
D-Erythrose 4- 126 phosphate 1 ,5-Anhydro-D-glucitol
Figure imgf000305_0002
127 1 ,4-Dichlorobutane
128 1 ,3-Dichloropropane
129 1,4-Diraethylbenzene
130 1 ,4-Dioxane
131 1,4-Dithiane
132 Maltose
133 Maltotπose
134 Maltotetraose
135 Maltopentaose
136 Maltohexaose
Figure imgf000305_0001
137 Maltoheptaose
Figure imgf000305_0004
Figure imgf000305_0003
1 ,5-Anhydro-D-fructose
138 152 1,8-Dichlorooctane
Figure imgf000305_0005
Figure imgf000306_0001
Figure imgf000307_0002
1-Dodecanoyl-sn- glycerol 3-phosphate 198 1-Indanone
186 2-Heptanol 199 1R-Indenol
187 1-Heptanol 200 1-Methoxynaphtalene
Figure imgf000307_0003
188 1-Hexacosanol onododecanoylglycer
Figure imgf000307_0004
189 anoylglyc
Figure imgf000307_0001
Figure imgf000307_0005
Figure imgf000307_0006
Figure imgf000308_0001
Figure imgf000309_0001
N"
258
259
Figure imgf000310_0001
Figure imgf000310_0002
N° Substrate
2,5-Didehydro-D- gluconate
. 2,5-Dihydroxyphenyl acetate
Figure imgf000311_0002
Figure imgf000311_0001
Figure imgf000311_0003
N" Substrate
2-Amino-4-hydroxy-6- hydroxymethyl-7,8- dihydropteridine diphosphate
2-Amino-4-hydroxy-6- 310 hydroxymethyl-7,8- dihydropteridine
2-Amino-7,8-dihydro-4- 31 ] hydroxy-6-
(diphosphooxymethyl)pt eridine
2-Aceto-2-
312 hydroxybutanoate
(S)-2-Aceto-2-
313 hydroxybutanoate
314
315
316
317
318
319
320
Figure imgf000312_0001
Figure imgf000312_0002
Figure imgf000313_0001
Figure imgf000314_0001
N0 Substrate N° Substrate l-chloro-2-
387 2-Heptadecanol 401 ethenylbenzene
,oo 2-Heptadecanoyl-
388 glycerol Pyran-2-one
389 2-Hexacosanol 403 2H-Pyran
390 L-Argininosuccinate p-Tolualdehyde
391 2-Hexadecanol 405 2-Hydroxybiphenyl
Figure imgf000315_0001
392 2-Hexanoyl-glycerol 406
393 2-Hexanol 407
Figure imgf000315_0003
N-Methylimidazolidine-
394 (R)-2-Hydroxyglutarate 4Qg 2,4-dione
2,4-Dichlorobenzoyl-
409 2-Indanone
396 2H-Imidazole 410 2-Isopropylmaleate
Benzoyl acetyl-CoA
397 2-Hydroxymalonate 411
2-Hydroxy muconate
398 2H-Pyrrole semialdehyde
2-Keto-3-deoxy-
. 2-Hydroxyhexadecanal
413 gluconate
Figure imgf000315_0002
Figure imgf000315_0004
Figure imgf000315_0005
N° Substrate
2-Keto-3-methylbutyπc
415 acid
416 2-Oxoisovalerate
4-Methylthio-2-
417 oxobutanoate
Figure imgf000316_0001
Figure imgf000316_0003
428 cis-2-Methylaconitate 442 2-Nitronaphthalene
Figure imgf000316_0002
Substrate
1 -Methyls- nitrobenzene
2-Methylserine
2-Octaprenyl-3-methyl- 5-hydroxy-6-methoxy- 1 ,4-benzoquinone
2-Octaprenyl-6- methoxyphenol
2-Nonadecanol
2-Nonadecanoyl- glycerol
1 -Nonadecanoyl-sn- glycero-phosphocholine
Figure imgf000317_0001
2-Octaprenyl-3-methyl- 2-Nonanoyl-glycerol 464 6-methoxy- 1 ,4- benzoquinol
2-Octaprenyl-6- 2-Nonanol 465 methoxyphenol
2-Nonaprenyl-6- 466 2-Oxooctadecanoate hydroxyphenol
2-Octaprenylphenol 2-Nonaprenylphenol 467
3-Phenylbutan-l-ol 2-Oxobutanoate 468
2-Phospho-4-(cytidine
5'-diphospho)-2-C- 2-Octadecanoyl-glycerol 469 methyl-D-erythritol T
2-Octadecanol 470 2-Pentanol
Figure imgf000317_0002
Figure imgf000317_0003
N° Substrate N0 Substrate
D-Glycerate 2- 2-Tetradecanoyl- phosphate 486 glycerol
472 2-Propyl-glycerol 487 2-Tetracosanol
473 2-Phosphoglycolate **88 2-Tetradecanol
2-Methyl-4,5-dihydro-
2-Pyrone-4,6-
474 489 1,3-thiazole dicarboxylate
2-Octaprenyl-6- 475 methoxy-1,4- 2-Undecanol benzoquinone
Figure imgf000318_0001
l-Chloro-2-[l-(4-
476 Propionaldehyde 491 chlorophenyl)ethenyl]be nzene
477 2-Propen-l-ol 492 L-Dicysteine
4,5-Dihydro-lH- 478 pyrazole 493 3,4,5-Tπchlorophenol
3,4,5-Tπhydroxy-3,7-
479 2-Pyrone 494 dimethoxyflavone
.__ 2,3-Dihydro-l H-pyrrole
495 3,4-Dichloroaniline
Figure imgf000318_0003
481 2S-Flavanone
482 2S-Flavan-4-ol
(lR,6R)-2-Succinyl-6- hydroxy-2,4-
483 cyclohexadiene-1- ld carboxylate
Figure imgf000318_0004
2-S-isocapryloyl-3R- 3,4-Dihydroxy-trans-
484 hydroxymethyl-9- cinnamate butyrolactone
4g5 2-Octaprenyl-6- 3,4-Dihydroxybenzoate hydroxyphenol
Figure imgf000318_0005
Figure imgf000318_0002
Figure imgf000319_0001
31
Figure imgf000320_0001
Figure imgf000321_0001
569 3-β-Hydroxysterol 580 3-Methylbutan-2-ol hexanoate
Figure imgf000321_0002
Figure imgf000321_0003
Substrate (S)-3-Methyl-2- oxopenlanoate
3-Methoxy-5,7,3',4'- tetrahydroxyflavone
3-Oxodecanoyl-CoA
3-Nitrobenzoic acid
3-Nitrobenzyl alcohol
2,4,6-Trinitrotoluene
Figure imgf000322_0001
_-. 3-Oxobutyryl-CoA
4-Nitroanilide
600
3-Oxododecanoyl-
601 CoA
Figure imgf000322_0002
602 3-Oxohexanoyl-CoA
603 3-Oxohexadecanoyl-CoA
3-Oxooctadecanoyl- 604 CoA
Figure imgf000322_0003
Figure imgf000322_0004
N° Substrate Chemical Structure N° Substrate Chemical Structure
605 3-OxohexacosyI-CoA
Figure imgf000323_0001
Figure imgf000323_0002
N0 Substrate Chemical Structure N0 Substrate
e
l-
Figure imgf000324_0002
phosphate
642 4-Dimethylaminophenol 655 4-Ethyl phenol
4-Carboxy-2- l-Fluoro-4- hydroxyhexa-2,4-
643 656 methylbenzene dienedioate
Figure imgf000324_0001
Figure imgf000324_0003
Figure imgf000325_0001
Figure imgf000326_0001
Figure imgf000326_0002
Figure imgf000327_0001
Figure imgf000328_0001
Chemical Structure
Figure imgf000329_0001
5-Hydroxy-L- 8-Amino-7- 766 tryptophan 778 oxononanoate
Adenosine 5'-
1 -Deaza-5-azapurine
767 779 phosphosulfate
Figure imgf000329_0003
768 1 -Deazapurine CQ* 780 3-Acetoacetyl-CoA
769 6-Phospho-D-gluconate
770 7H-pyrrolo[2,3- d]pyrimidine
Xanthen-9-one
771
772 Hydroxyfuranocoumarin
__- Uridine 5'-triphosphate
Figure imgf000329_0004
774 1,2-Anthracenediol 786 N-Acety':D- glucosamine
Figure imgf000329_0005
Figure imgf000329_0002
N" Substrate Chemical Structure N" Substrate
I ft I ft 2-Hydroxy-3-
787 Acetoacetate 799 oxoadipate
Figure imgf000330_0001
Figure imgf000330_0002
N° Substrate Chemical Structure
811 Acrolein
Figure imgf000331_0001
812 O-Acetyl-L-serine
Figure imgf000331_0003
Figure imgf000331_0002
813 Adenosine 823 ADP
N-Acetyl-D- 814 glucosamine 1- g24 ADP-L-glycero-D- manno-heptose
Figure imgf000331_0004
phosphate
Figure imgf000331_0005
Figure imgf000331_0006
N° Substrate Chemical Structure Substrate
Undecane 831 843 S-2-Acetolactate
Figure imgf000332_0001
832 844 2-Ketoelutaric acid
833
Figure imgf000332_0002
845 N-Acetyl-beta-alanine
S-Adenosyl-L-
834 846 L-Alanine homocysteine
Figure imgf000332_0003
2-Amino-4-hydroxy-6- (erythro-1 ,2,3-
835 847 D-Alanyl-D-lactate trihydroxypropyl)dihyd
Figure imgf000332_0004
ropteridine triphosphate
Figure imgf000332_0005
Figure imgf000332_0006
N" Substrate Chemical Structure N° Substrate
855 Allose 867 Acetyl-maltose
Figure imgf000333_0001
856 Allophanate XX. „,„ S-Adenosyl-L- threonine
Figure imgf000333_0002
S-Adenosyl-L- K t
857 869 methionine .' V "*«*/"
Figure imgf000333_0004
Figure imgf000333_0003
Figure imgf000333_0005
N0 Substrate Chemical Structure N° Substrate Chemical Structure
Figure imgf000334_0001
Figure imgf000335_0001
Figure imgf000335_0002
N" Substrate
930 ATP
931 Azetidine
932 Aziridine
l-(5'-Phosphoribosyl)-5-
933 amino-4- imidazolecarboxamide
934 γ-Butyrobetainyl-CoA
Figure imgf000336_0001
N0 Substrate Chemical Structure N° Substrate Chemical Structure
956 Benzocyclobutene
Figure imgf000337_0001
969 Bromobenzene-2,3-oxide
Figure imgf000337_0002
Figure imgf000337_0003
Figure imgf000338_0001
Figure imgf000339_0001
Figure imgf000340_0001
Figure imgf000341_0001
Figure imgf000342_0001
Figure imgf000343_0001
1115 Creatine
1116 Ethylglycocyamine
1117 3-Chlorocatechol
1118 CTP
2-Chloro-cis,cis-
1119 muconate
1120 Cytosine
1121 Coronafacic acid
1122 Crotono-betaine
1123 3,5-Dichlorocatechol
1124 Coronatine
Figure imgf000343_0002
Figure imgf000344_0001
Diethyl-2-methyl-3-
1144 Cy cloundecane 1157 oxosuccinate
Figure imgf000344_0002
... S8 D-4-Hydroxyphenyl- d HN-
1145 L-Cysteine glycine methyl ester O~0H
trans-Cyclohexane- 1 ,2-
1146 1159 L-Cystathionine
Figure imgf000344_0004
1147 Decanoic acid 1160 Deoxy adenosine r ϊ
D-Galactono-1,5-
1148 Cyclopentanone
Figure imgf000344_0003
1161 lactone
Figure imgf000344_0005
6, 6,7-Dimethyl-8-(l-D-
Figure imgf000344_0006
πbityl)lumazine
1150 L-Cystine 1163 Deoχy-5-
Figure imgf000344_0007
methylcytidylate N° Substrate Chemical Structure N° Substrate Chemical Structure
Figure imgf000345_0001
Figure imgf000346_0001
roxyacetone
1199 Octadecanal
Figure imgf000346_0003
1213 Dihyd phosphate
Figure imgf000346_0002
Figure imgf000346_0004
Figure imgf000347_0001
Figure imgf000348_0001
Figure imgf000349_0001
Figure imgf000349_0002
Figure imgf000350_0001
Figure imgf000351_0001
Figure imgf000352_0001
Figure imgf000353_0001
41-O-beta-D-Glucosyl-
1383 cis-p-coumarate
Figure imgf000353_0002
GlutathionyH ,2-
1384 Famesyl diphosphate 1397 dihydronaphthalene
D-Glucono-1,5-
1385 D-Fructose 1398 lactate
1386 Fructosamine 1399 Furazan-3,4-diol
Figure imgf000353_0003
Figure imgf000353_0004
1387 D-Fructuronate
1388 Farnesal
1389 L-Fucose 1-phosphate
1390 Fumarylacetoacetate
Figure imgf000353_0005
Figure imgf000354_0001
Figure imgf000355_0001
Figure imgf000356_0001
Figure imgf000357_0001
Figure imgf000358_0001
Heptadecanoyldolich ol
Figure imgf000358_0003
Hydroxyacetone
1518 1531 Heptadecanoic acid phosphate
Figure imgf000358_0002
Figure imgf000358_0004
Figure imgf000358_0005
N0 Substrate Chemical Structure N0 Substrate Chemical Structure
1534
1535
1536
1537
1538
1539
1540
1541
1542
1543
1544
1545
1546
Figure imgf000359_0001
Figure imgf000360_0001
Figure imgf000361_0001
N° Substrate Chemical Structure N" Substrate Chemical Structure
. 3-(Imidazol-4-yl)-2- oxopropyl phosphate
Figure imgf000362_0001
Methyl 3-
1621 hydroxybenzoate
1622 Indoline
1623 2,3-Benzopyrrole
1624 myo-Inositol
1625 Indole-3-pyruvate
1626 Inosine
Figure imgf000362_0002
Figure imgf000363_0001
Figure imgf000364_0001
Figure imgf000365_0001
Figure imgf000366_0001
1729 3-Methylmuconolactone 1743 Isomaltopentaose Too big
1730 Malathion 1744 Isomaltohexaose Too big
Figure imgf000366_0002
Figure imgf000366_0003
OH
Figure imgf000367_0001
Figure imgf000368_0001
Figure imgf000369_0001
Figure imgf000370_0001
Figure imgf000371_0001
(3R)-3-Isoprenyl-6-
1867 N-Dodecanoyl-glycine 1880 oxoheptanoyl-CoA
1868 N-Decanoyl-glycine 1881 N-Hexanoyl-glycine
Figure imgf000371_0002
Figure imgf000371_0003
Figure imgf000372_0001
(3R)-3-Isopropenyr '
1884 1897 N-Methyltyramine oxoheptanoate
Figure imgf000372_0003
Figure imgf000372_0002
Nicotinate D-
1885 ribonucleotide
1886 Nicotine
Figure imgf000372_0004
1887 Nitroglycerin
1888 N-Methylanthranilate er
1889 D-Glucose
Figure imgf000372_0005
Figure imgf000373_0001
1917 Phenanthrene-3,4-oxide 1930 Octadecane
... 3-Amino-2-oxopropyl 1931 Octadecenoic acid phosphate
Figure imgf000373_0003
1919 N-Succinyl-Ala-Ala- Too big 1932 9-Octadecynoic acid AIa p-nitroanilide
N-Succinyl-Ala-Ala-
1920 Phe-7-amido-4-methyl Too big 1933 2-Butenoic acid coumaπn
Figure imgf000373_0002
Figure imgf000374_0001
Figure imgf000375_0001
1969 Oxalureate
Figure imgf000375_0002
Figure imgf000375_0003
Figure imgf000376_0001
1992 2005 Pectin Too big
1993 2006 Pentadecanoic acid
1994 2007 p-Cymene
Figure imgf000376_0002
1995
Figure imgf000376_0003
2008 Pentyl butyrate
Figure imgf000376_0004
N0 Substrate
2012 2-Aminobenzoyl-CoA
2013 Pentyl pentanoate
2014 Pentanoic acid
2015 Phosphoenolpyruvate
2016 Pentadecane
201_ 5-Methylhexa-2,4- dienoyl-CoA
.... cis-2-Oxohept-3-ene"
1 ,7-dioate
2019 /j-Pentane
2020 Perdeuterobenzene
2021 Perillyl aldehyde
2022 Pentacen
2023 Perillyl alcohol
2024 Ethanolamine phosphate
Figure imgf000377_0001
Figure imgf000378_0001
N° Substrate Chemical Structure N" Substrate Chemical Structure
Figure imgf000379_0001
Figure imgf000380_0001
N" Substrate Chemical Structure N" Substrate Chemical Structure
Figure imgf000381_0001
N0 Substrate Chemical Structure N0 Substrate Chemical Structure
Figure imgf000382_0001
Figure imgf000383_0001
Figure imgf000385_0001
2238 D-Sorbitol 2251 S-Formylglutathione
Figure imgf000385_0003
Figure imgf000385_0002
Figure imgf000386_0001
N" Substrate Chemical Structure N° Substrate Chemical Structure
Figure imgf000387_0001
Figure imgf000388_0001
Figure imgf000389_0001
2345 THF-L-glutamate 2358
2346 Thymidine 2359
Figure imgf000389_0002
2360
Figure imgf000389_0003
Figure imgf000390_0001
D-myo-Inositol 1,4,5-
2371 2384 Citronellyl-CoA trisphosphate
2372 1-Bromohexane 2385 Glyceryl tridecanoate
2373 1-Chlorohexane 2386 GXϊ∞r1X
Figure imgf000390_0002
tridodecanoate
Figure imgf000390_0003
Figure imgf000391_0001
Figure imgf000392_0001
diaminopimeloyl -D- alanyl-D-alanine
UDP -N -Acetyl -D-
2419 glucosamine
Figure imgf000392_0002
Figure imgf000392_0003
Figure imgf000393_0001
N° Substrate Chemical Structure N" Substrate Chemical Structure
2465 Methyl salicylate 2475 Chloroxylenol
Xanthosine 5-'
2466 2476 m-Xylene phosphate
2467 o-Xylene 2477 L-Xylose
2468 Xanthene
2469 o-Xylene
2470 L-Xylulose 1-phosphate
2471 1,3-beta-D-Xylan
2472 L-Xylulose Sphosphate
24?3 D-Xylulose S phosphate
2474 D-Xylose
Figure imgf000394_0001
Table 3. Extensive description of microarray data
Figure imgf000395_0001
Figure imgf000396_0001
Ul
Figure imgf000397_0001
Figure imgf000398_0001
Figure imgf000399_0001
90
Figure imgf000400_0001
Figure imgf000401_0001
O O
Figure imgf000402_0001
Figure imgf000403_0001
4-
O
Figure imgf000404_0001
O
Figure imgf000405_0001
Figure imgf000406_0001
4- O Ul
Figure imgf000407_0001
O
Figure imgf000408_0001
4-
O
Figure imgf000409_0001
O 90
Figure imgf000410_0001
4-
O
Figure imgf000411_0001
Figure imgf000412_0001
Figure imgf000413_0001
Figure imgf000414_0001
Figure imgf000415_0001
Figure imgf000416_0001
Figure imgf000417_0001
Figure imgf000418_0001
4-
Figure imgf000419_0001
4-
Figure imgf000420_0001
Figure imgf000421_0001
κ>
O
Figure imgf000422_0001
4- K)
Figure imgf000423_0001
K> κ>
Figure imgf000424_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000425_0001
4- K)
4-
Figure imgf000426_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000427_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000428_0001
K>
Figure imgf000429_0001
4- K)
Figure imgf000430_0001
K>
Figure imgf000431_0001
4- W
O
Figure imgf000432_0001
4-
Figure imgf000433_0001
4- W K)
Figure imgf000434_0001
Figure imgf000435_0001
W
Figure imgf000436_0001
4- W Ul
Figure imgf000437_0001
Figure imgf000438_0001
Figure imgf000439_0001
S
Figure imgf000440_0001
S
Figure imgf000441_0001
Figure imgf000442_0001
Figure imgf000443_0001
Figure imgf000444_0001
4- 4-
Figure imgf000445_0001
Figure imgf000446_0001
Figure imgf000447_0001
Figure imgf000448_0001
4- 4-
Figure imgf000449_0001
£
Figure imgf000450_0001
Figure imgf000451_0001
O
Figure imgf000452_0001
4-
Figure imgf000453_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000454_0001
Ul
Figure imgf000455_0001
4- 4-
Figure imgf000456_0001
Ul Ul
Figure imgf000457_0001
4-
Figure imgf000458_0001
Figure imgf000459_0001
4-
Figure imgf000460_0001
Figure imgf000461_0001
4- o
Figure imgf000462_0001
4-
Figure imgf000463_0001
Os κ>
Figure imgf000464_0001
Figure imgf000465_0001
Figure imgf000466_0001
Ul
Figure imgf000467_0001
Figure imgf000468_0001
Os
Figure imgf000469_0001
Os OO
Figure imgf000470_0001
Os
Figure imgf000471_0001
O
Figure imgf000472_0001
4-
Figure imgf000473_0001
K>
Figure imgf000474_0001
Figure imgf000475_0001
Figure imgf000476_0001
Ul
Figure imgf000477_0001
Figure imgf000478_0001
4-
Figure imgf000479_0001
OO
Figure imgf000480_0001
Figure imgf000481_0001
4-
OO O
Figure imgf000482_0001
Figure imgf000483_0001
OO K)
Figure imgf000484_0001
90
Figure imgf000485_0001
Figure imgf000486_0001
4- OO Ul
Figure imgf000487_0001
OO
Figure imgf000488_0001
90
Figure imgf000489_0001
90 OO
Figure imgf000490_0001
4-
90
Figure imgf000491_0001
O
Figure imgf000492_0001
VO
Figure imgf000493_0001
Figure imgf000494_0001
Figure imgf000495_0001
4- 4-
Figure imgf000496_0001
4- Ul
Figure imgf000497_0001
Figure imgf000498_0001
4-
Figure imgf000499_0001
OO
Figure imgf000500_0001
4-
Figure imgf000501_0001
Figure imgf000502_0001
Ul
O
Figure imgf000503_0001
Ul
O K)
Figure imgf000504_0001
Ul
O
Figure imgf000505_0001
Ul
O
Figure imgf000506_0001
O Ul
Figure imgf000507_0001
(Jl
O
Figure imgf000508_0001
O
Figure imgf000509_0001
O
Figure imgf000510_0001
O
Figure imgf000511_0001
O
Figure imgf000512_0001
Ul
Figure imgf000513_0001
K)
Figure imgf000514_0001
'Jv
Figure imgf000515_0001
4-
Figure imgf000516_0001
'M Ul
Figure imgf000517_0001
Ul
Figure imgf000518_0001
Ul
Figure imgf000519_0001
90
Figure imgf000520_0001
Figure imgf000521_0001
'Jl κ>
O
Figure imgf000522_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000523_0001
κ>
K)
Figure imgf000524_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000525_0001
4-
Figure imgf000526_0001
κ>
Ul
Figure imgf000527_0001
κ>
Figure imgf000528_0001
Compound in row 243 (2,2-Dichloropropanoic acid) is the control for Pseudomonas putida Experiments
Compound in row 1746 (Methyl-3-bromo-2-methylpropionate) is the control for Metagenomic Experiments
YES* represent molecules which do not match exactly to KEGG but they are named generally in KEGG
NO* represent molecules not found in KEGG and PubChem Databases.
*B= block, C=columna, R=row
Ul K>
table 4. Detailed information of hypothetical proteins identified in the present study through the analysis of KT2440 single cells and VUL, KOL and L'A communities. REBr sequence is also shown.
Figure imgf000530_0001
Ul K>
Figure imgf000531_0001
TGAAGGTGCGCTGATCATCAAGTTCTGGTTCCAC CTGTCCAAGAAGCAGATGAAGGCACGGCTGAAA TCGCTCAAGGACGACCCGCTGCACAGCTGGAAG ATCAGCCCGCTGGATTGGCAGCAGTCGCAAACC TACGACCGTTTCGTGCGCTTTGGCGAGCGCGTG CTGCGCCGCACCAGCCGTGACTATGCGCCATGG CACATCATCGAAGGGGTAGACCCGAATTACCGC AGCCTGGCGGTGGGGCGCATTCTGCTGGAAAG CCTGCAAGCCGCGCTGGCCCACAATCCCAAGGG CAAGCACCAGGGCAACGTGGCTCCATTGGGCCG CAGCATCGACGACCGCAGCCTGCTTGGCGCCCT GGACATGACCTTGCGCCTGGACAAGGCCGACTA TCAGGAACAGTTGATCACCGAACAGGCGCGTCT GGCCGGCCTGCTGCGTGACAAGCGCATGCGCC GGCACGCCCTGGTGGCGGTGTTCGAAGGCAAC GACGCCGCCGGCAAGGGGGGCGCCATCCGCCG CGTGGCGGCGGCGCTGGACCCGCGTCAGTACC GTATCGTACCGATTGCCGCGCCGACCGAAGAAG O AGCGCGCCCAGCCGTACCTGTGGCGGTTCTGG CGGCACATCCCGGCACGCGGCAAGTTCACCATC TTCGACCGTTCCTGGTATGGCCGGGTGCTGGTG GAGCGGGTGGAAGGCπCTGCAGCCCCGCTGA CTGGATGCGTGCCTATAGCGAGATCAACGACTTT GAAGAGCAGTTGGTGGATGCCGGCGTGGTGGT GGTCAAGTTCTGGCTGGCGATCGACCAGCAGAC CCAACTGGAGCGCπCGAAGAGCGTGAGCAGAT TCCGTTCAAACGCTACAAGATCACCGAGGATGA CTGGCGCAACCGCGACAAGTGGGACGAATACTC CCAGGCGGTGGGCGACATGGTCGACCGCACCA GCAGCGAGATTGCCCCTTGGACGCTGGTGGAG GCCAATGACAAGCGCTGGGCGCGGGTGAAGGT GGTGCGCACAATCAACCAGGCGCTTGAGGCGG CGTTTGCCAAGCACAAGAAATAG
PP_2 867 NP_7 PP_2949 F, ATGGAAAAATCAGCAACCGGGTGGATCAACGGT PP_294 3- 949 4509 GACGACGACAAGATGGAAA πCATAGGCGTCGCCATTTTTGCGGGTTCGTTGC 9 hydroxyanth
O
O O
O CS
W
H U Sh
30 IΛ
O
O CS
O
Figure imgf000533_0001
Ul
W
K)
Figure imgf000534_0001
Figure imgf000535_0001
Ul
Figure imgf000536_0001
'M
W Ul
Figure imgf000537_0001

Claims

CLAIMS ;
1. A probe compound for detecting specific enzyme-substrate interactions comprising a transition metal complex and a reactive component of general formula (X) :
His-LHis-Tc-TC-LTC-ic-IC-Lic-His-His formula (X)
wherein His represents a histidine residue, TC represents a test component, IC represents an indicator component, and each of LiHis-TC/ LTC-IC and LiC-His independently represents optional linker components , wherein the reactive component is linked to the transition metal complex by the two histidine residues.
2. The probe compound according to claim 1, wherein the transition metal complex comprises a cobalt or copper atom.
3. The probe compound according to claim 1 or 2, wherein the transition metal complex further comprises a multidentate ligand, preferably comprising nitrotriacetic acid.
4. The probe compound according to one of the preceding claims, wherein the transition metal complex comprises a nitrotriacetic acid cobalt (II) moiety.
5. The probe compound according to one of the preceding claims, wherein the multidentate ligand of the transition metal complex further comprises an anchoring component.
6. The probe compound according to one of the preceding claims, wherein the transition metal complex is a cobalt (II) complex of Nα/Nα-bis- (carboxymethyl) -L-lysine.
7. The probe compound according to one of the preceding claims, wherein the indicator component comprises a dye, preferably a fluorescence dye.
8. The probe compound according to one of the preceding claims, wherein the test component comprises a substrate selected from the group listed in Table 1.
9. The probe compound according to one of the preceding claims, wherein the indicator component comprises a fluorescene dye, preferably a Cy3 dye, and wherein the linker component LTC-ic comprises a quaternary ammine function.
10. A method of preparing a probe compound according to any one of claims 1 to 9, which comprises the steps of:
Preparing a transition metal complex by reacting a salt of a transition metal with a ligand molecule;
Preparing a reactive component by linking a test component to a histidine residue, optionally using a linker component, linking a dye component to a histidine component, optionally using a linker component, and linking the test component to the dye component, optionally using a linker component; and
Linking the reactive component to the transition metal complex by the two histidine residues.
11. An array for detecting enzymes comprising a plurality of different probe compounds according to any one of claims 1 to 9.
12. A method for producing an array according to claim 11, comprising the production of a plurality of different probe compounds according to the method of claim 10, wherein an anchoring component is linked to the ligand of the transition metal complex of the probe compound, and the arrangement of the different probe compounds in an array.
13. An isolation means comprising a nanoparticle and a probe compound according to any one of claims 1 to 9.
14. A method for producing an isolation means according to claim 13, comprising the production of a probe compound according to the method of claim 10, wherein an anchoring component is linked to the ligand of the transition metal complex of the probe compound, and the probe compound is attached to a nanoparticle.
15. A method for detecting enzymes, using the probe compound according to any one of claims 1 to 9, or the array according to claim 11, wherein the probe compound or the array is brought into contact with a sample of an analyte solution comprising enzymes .
16. A method for isolating enzymes, using the isolation means according to claim 15.
PCT/EP2010/001770 2009-03-19 2010-03-19 Probe compound for detecting and isolating enzymes and means and methods using the same WO2010105851A1 (en)

Priority Applications (3)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
EP10715096.3A EP2408927B1 (en) 2009-03-19 2010-03-19 Probe compound for detecting and isolating enzymes and means and methods using the same
US13/257,383 US20120231972A1 (en) 2009-03-19 2010-03-19 Probe Compound for Detecting and Isolating Enzymes and Means and Methods Using the Same
ES10715096.3T ES2449581T3 (en) 2009-03-19 2010-03-19 Probe compound to detect and isolate enzymes, and means and methods to use it

Applications Claiming Priority (4)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US21048209P 2009-03-19 2009-03-19
EP09003977A EP2230312A1 (en) 2009-03-19 2009-03-19 Probe compound for detecting and isolating enzymes and means and methods using the same
EPEP09003977.7 2009-03-19
USUS61/210,482 2009-03-19

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
WO2010105851A1 true WO2010105851A1 (en) 2010-09-23

Family

ID=40852044

Family Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/EP2010/001770 WO2010105851A1 (en) 2009-03-19 2010-03-19 Probe compound for detecting and isolating enzymes and means and methods using the same

Country Status (4)

Country Link
US (1) US20120231972A1 (en)
EP (2) EP2230312A1 (en)
ES (1) ES2449581T3 (en)
WO (1) WO2010105851A1 (en)

Cited By (10)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
CN104098508A (en) * 2013-04-15 2014-10-15 上海凯赛生物技术研发中心有限公司 Preparation method for 2,3,4,5-tetrahydropyridine and derivatives thereof
CN104744526A (en) * 2013-12-31 2015-07-01 深圳先进技术研究院 Chemical synthesis method of lupeose
CN104744542A (en) * 2013-12-31 2015-07-01 深圳先进技术研究院 Selective modification method of cane sugar primary hydroxyl
WO2016209996A1 (en) * 2015-06-23 2016-12-29 University Of Oregon Phosphorus-containing heterocycles and a method for making and using
CN106674135A (en) * 2016-12-29 2017-05-17 新乡制药股份有限公司 Uracil synthesizing method
US10808047B2 (en) 2015-08-21 2020-10-20 G&P Holding, Inc. Silver and copper itaconates and poly itaconates
CN113461620A (en) * 2021-07-20 2021-10-01 河北广兴化工有限公司 Heating synthesis method of uracil
CN113816932A (en) * 2021-10-14 2021-12-21 宁夏优维生物科技有限公司 Synthesis method of keto pantolactone
CN114507127A (en) * 2020-11-17 2022-05-17 中国科学院上海高等研究院 Synthesis method of 2-keto pantoic acid
CN115957343A (en) * 2022-12-05 2023-04-14 大连理工大学 Colloidal particle and preparation method and application of colloidal particle in capsid induced self-assembly

Families Citing this family (111)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US9562837B2 (en) 2006-05-11 2017-02-07 Raindance Technologies, Inc. Systems for handling microfludic droplets
US20080014589A1 (en) 2006-05-11 2008-01-17 Link Darren R Microfluidic devices and methods of use thereof
US8772046B2 (en) 2007-02-06 2014-07-08 Brandeis University Manipulation of fluids and reactions in microfluidic systems
US8592221B2 (en) 2007-04-19 2013-11-26 Brandeis University Manipulation of fluids, fluid components and reactions in microfluidic systems
DK2244741T3 (en) 2008-01-18 2015-05-26 Visen Medical Inc Fluorescent imaging agents
WO2010009365A1 (en) 2008-07-18 2010-01-21 Raindance Technologies, Inc. Droplet libraries
US12038438B2 (en) 2008-07-18 2024-07-16 Bio-Rad Laboratories, Inc. Enzyme quantification
CA2735250A1 (en) * 2008-07-30 2010-02-04 Nippon Steel Kankyo Engineering Co., Ltd. Universal nucleic acid probe set and method for utilization thereof
US8835358B2 (en) 2009-12-15 2014-09-16 Cellular Research, Inc. Digital counting of individual molecules by stochastic attachment of diverse labels
WO2011100604A2 (en) 2010-02-12 2011-08-18 Raindance Technologies, Inc. Digital analyte analysis
US9399797B2 (en) 2010-02-12 2016-07-26 Raindance Technologies, Inc. Digital analyte analysis
JP5871933B2 (en) 2010-09-10 2016-03-01 バイオ−ラッド ラボラトリーズ インコーポレーティッド Detection of RNA interaction region in DNA
US20120208193A1 (en) 2011-02-15 2012-08-16 Bio-Rad Laboratories, Inc. Detecting methylation in a subpopulation of genomic dna
EP3736281A1 (en) 2011-02-18 2020-11-11 Bio-Rad Laboratories, Inc. Compositions and methods for molecular labeling
EP2714970B1 (en) 2011-06-02 2017-04-19 Raindance Technologies, Inc. Enzyme quantification
US8658430B2 (en) 2011-07-20 2014-02-25 Raindance Technologies, Inc. Manipulating droplet size
EP2761032B1 (en) * 2011-09-29 2017-07-19 Luminex Corporation Hydrolysis probes
EP2823303A4 (en) * 2012-02-10 2015-09-30 Raindance Technologies Inc Molecular diagnostic screening assay
CN104364392B (en) 2012-02-27 2018-05-25 赛卢拉研究公司 For the composition and kit of numerator counts
CN104136611B (en) * 2012-02-27 2018-03-27 东丽株式会社 The detection method of nucleic acid
CN102621249B (en) * 2012-04-18 2014-01-08 王益超 Method for synchronously analyzing base, nucleotide, organic acid, fatty acid, amino acid and saccharide metabolic product with multi-step derivation method
JP6280866B2 (en) * 2012-08-03 2018-02-14 Yamakin株式会社 Alloy materials, contact probes and connection terminals
CN113528634A (en) 2012-08-14 2021-10-22 10X基因组学有限公司 Microcapsule compositions and methods
US10400280B2 (en) 2012-08-14 2019-09-03 10X Genomics, Inc. Methods and systems for processing polynucleotides
US10273541B2 (en) 2012-08-14 2019-04-30 10X Genomics, Inc. Methods and systems for processing polynucleotides
US10221442B2 (en) 2012-08-14 2019-03-05 10X Genomics, Inc. Compositions and methods for sample processing
US10323279B2 (en) 2012-08-14 2019-06-18 10X Genomics, Inc. Methods and systems for processing polynucleotides
US10752949B2 (en) 2012-08-14 2020-08-25 10X Genomics, Inc. Methods and systems for processing polynucleotides
US9951386B2 (en) 2014-06-26 2018-04-24 10X Genomics, Inc. Methods and systems for processing polynucleotides
US11591637B2 (en) 2012-08-14 2023-02-28 10X Genomics, Inc. Compositions and methods for sample processing
US9701998B2 (en) 2012-12-14 2017-07-11 10X Genomics, Inc. Methods and systems for processing polynucleotides
EP3567116A1 (en) 2012-12-14 2019-11-13 10X Genomics, Inc. Methods and systems for processing polynucleotides
US10533221B2 (en) 2012-12-14 2020-01-14 10X Genomics, Inc. Methods and systems for processing polynucleotides
KR20200140929A (en) 2013-02-08 2020-12-16 10엑스 제노믹스, 인크. Polynucleotide barcode generation
US20140272959A1 (en) * 2013-03-14 2014-09-18 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Methods of Hybridizing Probes to Genomic DNA
EP3039155B1 (en) * 2013-08-26 2019-10-09 Ontera Inc. Molecule detection using boronic acid substituted probes
KR102536833B1 (en) 2013-08-28 2023-05-26 벡톤 디킨슨 앤드 컴퍼니 Massively parallel single cell analysis
EP3092220B1 (en) * 2013-09-25 2021-01-20 University of Florida Research Foundation, Inc. Vitamin c prodrugs and uses thereof
US11901041B2 (en) 2013-10-04 2024-02-13 Bio-Rad Laboratories, Inc. Digital analysis of nucleic acid modification
US9582877B2 (en) 2013-10-07 2017-02-28 Cellular Research, Inc. Methods and systems for digitally counting features on arrays
CN105765080A (en) * 2013-11-26 2016-07-13 伯乐实验室公司 Methods for detecting nucleic acid proximity
US9944977B2 (en) 2013-12-12 2018-04-17 Raindance Technologies, Inc. Distinguishing rare variations in a nucleic acid sequence from a sample
AU2015243445B2 (en) 2014-04-10 2020-05-28 10X Genomics, Inc. Fluidic devices, systems, and methods for encapsulating and partitioning reagents, and applications of same
CN104098480B (en) * 2014-05-26 2016-01-06 张家港威胜生物医药有限公司 A kind of preparation method of Serine
CN113249435B (en) 2014-06-26 2024-09-03 10X基因组学有限公司 Method for analyzing nucleic acid from single cell or cell population
GB201413718D0 (en) * 2014-08-01 2014-09-17 Olink Ab Method for selecting a target nucleic acid sequence
US9975122B2 (en) 2014-11-05 2018-05-22 10X Genomics, Inc. Instrument systems for integrated sample processing
WO2016114970A1 (en) 2015-01-12 2016-07-21 10X Genomics, Inc. Processes and systems for preparing nucleic acid sequencing libraries and libraries prepared using same
CN107208160B (en) * 2015-01-30 2023-02-17 哈佛学院院长及董事 No microscope imaging
EP3259371B1 (en) 2015-02-19 2020-09-02 Becton, Dickinson and Company High-throughput single-cell analysis combining proteomic and genomic information
US10697000B2 (en) 2015-02-24 2020-06-30 10X Genomics, Inc. Partition processing methods and systems
EP3262192B1 (en) 2015-02-27 2020-09-16 Becton, Dickinson and Company Spatially addressable molecular barcoding
US11535882B2 (en) 2015-03-30 2022-12-27 Becton, Dickinson And Company Methods and compositions for combinatorial barcoding
US20160299129A1 (en) * 2015-04-07 2016-10-13 Xiaolei Qiu Ultra Sensitive and Specific Multiplex Biosensor System Based on Multiple Cooperative Interactions
WO2016172373A1 (en) * 2015-04-23 2016-10-27 Cellular Research, Inc. Methods and compositions for whole transcriptome amplification
WO2016196229A1 (en) 2015-06-01 2016-12-08 Cellular Research, Inc. Methods for rna quantification
US10619186B2 (en) 2015-09-11 2020-04-14 Cellular Research, Inc. Methods and compositions for library normalization
CN114774529A (en) * 2015-11-19 2022-07-22 10X基因组学有限公司 Transformable marking compositions, methods and processes incorporating same
US11371094B2 (en) 2015-11-19 2022-06-28 10X Genomics, Inc. Systems and methods for nucleic acid processing using degenerate nucleotides
WO2017096158A1 (en) 2015-12-04 2017-06-08 10X Genomics, Inc. Methods and compositions for nucleic acid analysis
EP3452614B1 (en) 2016-05-02 2023-06-28 Becton, Dickinson and Company Accurate molecular barcoding
WO2017197338A1 (en) 2016-05-13 2017-11-16 10X Genomics, Inc. Microfluidic systems and methods of use
US10301677B2 (en) 2016-05-25 2019-05-28 Cellular Research, Inc. Normalization of nucleic acid libraries
EP4407625A3 (en) 2016-05-26 2024-10-23 Becton, Dickinson and Company Molecular label counting adjustment methods
US10202641B2 (en) 2016-05-31 2019-02-12 Cellular Research, Inc. Error correction in amplification of samples
US10640763B2 (en) 2016-05-31 2020-05-05 Cellular Research, Inc. Molecular indexing of internal sequences
CN106397379A (en) * 2016-07-01 2017-02-15 齐齐哈尔大学 A method of preparing 2-phenyl-1,4-benzopyrone
CN107782834B (en) * 2016-08-25 2020-02-21 中国科学院大连化学物理研究所 Rapid analysis method for biogenic amine in fish
CN109923213B (en) 2016-09-20 2023-02-28 哈佛学院院长及董事 Molecular verification system
CA3034924A1 (en) 2016-09-26 2018-03-29 Cellular Research, Inc. Measurement of protein expression using reagents with barcoded oligonucleotide sequences
US10815525B2 (en) 2016-12-22 2020-10-27 10X Genomics, Inc. Methods and systems for processing polynucleotides
US10550429B2 (en) 2016-12-22 2020-02-04 10X Genomics, Inc. Methods and systems for processing polynucleotides
US10722880B2 (en) 2017-01-13 2020-07-28 Cellular Research, Inc. Hydrophilic coating of fluidic channels
EP4310183A3 (en) 2017-01-30 2024-02-21 10X Genomics, Inc. Methods and systems for droplet-based single cell barcoding
EP3577232A1 (en) 2017-02-01 2019-12-11 Cellular Research, Inc. Selective amplification using blocking oligonucleotides
JOP20190260A1 (en) 2017-05-02 2019-10-31 Merck Sharp & Dohme Stable formulations of programmed death receptor 1 (pd-1) antibodies and methods of use thereof
WO2018204374A1 (en) 2017-05-02 2018-11-08 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. Formulations of anti-lag3 antibodies and co-formulations of anti-lag3 antibodies and anti-pd-1 antibodies
US20180340169A1 (en) 2017-05-26 2018-11-29 10X Genomics, Inc. Single cell analysis of transposase accessible chromatin
CN109526228B (en) 2017-05-26 2022-11-25 10X基因组学有限公司 Single cell analysis of transposase accessible chromatin
CA3059559A1 (en) 2017-06-05 2018-12-13 Becton, Dickinson And Company Sample indexing for single cells
CN111107873A (en) * 2017-09-05 2020-05-05 默沙东公司 Compounds for reducing the viscosity of biologicals
CN111051523B (en) 2017-11-15 2024-03-19 10X基因组学有限公司 Functionalized gel beads
US10829815B2 (en) 2017-11-17 2020-11-10 10X Genomics, Inc. Methods and systems for associating physical and genetic properties of biological particles
CN111492068A (en) 2017-12-19 2020-08-04 贝克顿迪金森公司 Particles associated with oligonucleotides
WO2019195166A1 (en) 2018-04-06 2019-10-10 10X Genomics, Inc. Systems and methods for quality control in single cell processing
US11365409B2 (en) 2018-05-03 2022-06-21 Becton, Dickinson And Company Molecular barcoding on opposite transcript ends
ES2945191T3 (en) 2018-05-03 2023-06-29 Becton Dickinson Co High-throughput multi-omics sample analysis
CN108558681A (en) * 2018-05-23 2018-09-21 精晶药业股份有限公司 A kind of method for crystallising of tyrasamine
CN108948051A (en) * 2018-08-21 2018-12-07 六盘水师范学院 A kind of preparation method and application of multiple ligand metal complex
WO2020072380A1 (en) 2018-10-01 2020-04-09 Cellular Research, Inc. Determining 5' transcript sequences
WO2020097315A1 (en) 2018-11-08 2020-05-14 Cellular Research, Inc. Whole transcriptome analysis of single cells using random priming
WO2020123384A1 (en) 2018-12-13 2020-06-18 Cellular Research, Inc. Selective extension in single cell whole transcriptome analysis
WO2020150356A1 (en) 2019-01-16 2020-07-23 Becton, Dickinson And Company Polymerase chain reaction normalization through primer titration
WO2020154247A1 (en) 2019-01-23 2020-07-30 Cellular Research, Inc. Oligonucleotides associated with antibodies
WO2020167920A1 (en) 2019-02-14 2020-08-20 Cellular Research, Inc. Hybrid targeted and whole transcriptome amplification
US11965208B2 (en) 2019-04-19 2024-04-23 Becton, Dickinson And Company Methods of associating phenotypical data and single cell sequencing data
CN110183396A (en) * 2019-05-17 2019-08-30 陕西科技大学 A kind of benzothiazoles ionic liquid, preparation method and its application in the synthesis of paraben esters and cinnamate
EP4004231A1 (en) 2019-07-22 2022-06-01 Becton, Dickinson and Company Single cell chromatin immunoprecipitation sequencing assay
US11287422B2 (en) 2019-09-23 2022-03-29 Element Biosciences, Inc. Multivalent binding composition for nucleic acid analysis
WO2021092386A1 (en) 2019-11-08 2021-05-14 Becton Dickinson And Company Using random priming to obtain full-length v(d)j information for immune repertoire sequencing
CN115244184A (en) 2020-01-13 2022-10-25 贝克顿迪金森公司 Methods and compositions for quantifying protein and RNA
WO2021231779A1 (en) 2020-05-14 2021-11-18 Becton, Dickinson And Company Primers for immune repertoire profiling
US11932901B2 (en) 2020-07-13 2024-03-19 Becton, Dickinson And Company Target enrichment using nucleic acid probes for scRNAseq
US20220064719A1 (en) * 2020-08-31 2022-03-03 Applied Materials, Inc. Method of calibration of mfish using slides
CN112094362B (en) * 2020-09-29 2022-04-12 四川大学华西医院 Nicotinamide ribose or mononucleotide analogue-macromolecular carrier conjugate, preparation method and application
CN116635533A (en) 2020-11-20 2023-08-22 贝克顿迪金森公司 Profiling of high and low expressed proteins
CN112961930B (en) * 2021-05-18 2021-08-10 至善时代智能科技(北京)有限公司 Primer group, kit and method for identifying environmental bacteria at genus level
CN114791459B (en) * 2022-03-29 2023-02-14 浙江苏可安药业有限公司 Serum metabolic marker for detecting pulmonary tuberculosis and kit thereof
CN114920891B (en) * 2022-05-16 2023-08-01 嘉兴学院 Magnetic boron-affinity polyion liquid and preparation method and application thereof
CN115043706B (en) * 2022-06-06 2023-05-26 万华化学集团股份有限公司 Method for preparing 1, 3-butanediol
CN117672407B (en) * 2023-12-15 2024-08-16 天智药成科技(重庆)有限公司 Method for predicting metabolic site and metabolic product of compound P450 enzyme based on graph neural network

Citations (6)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO1997028275A1 (en) * 1996-02-05 1997-08-07 Igen International, Inc. Electrochemiluminescence enzyme assay
US20020160526A1 (en) * 1997-04-16 2002-10-31 Abdelhamid Elaissari Process for isolating a target biological material, capture phase, detection phase and reagent
JP2004093478A (en) * 2002-09-03 2004-03-25 Japan Science & Technology Corp Element for electrochemical analysis of physiologically active substance, and analysis method using the same
US20050123932A1 (en) * 2003-12-09 2005-06-09 Mekbib Astatke Nucleic acid-chelating agent conjugates
EP1669760A1 (en) * 2004-12-08 2006-06-14 Kreatech Biotechnology B.V. Labeled transition metal complexes
US20080081329A1 (en) * 2006-09-28 2008-04-03 Elliott C Michael Electrochemical Detection of Substrates

Family Cites Families (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
DK2244741T3 (en) * 2008-01-18 2015-05-26 Visen Medical Inc Fluorescent imaging agents

Patent Citations (6)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
WO1997028275A1 (en) * 1996-02-05 1997-08-07 Igen International, Inc. Electrochemiluminescence enzyme assay
US20020160526A1 (en) * 1997-04-16 2002-10-31 Abdelhamid Elaissari Process for isolating a target biological material, capture phase, detection phase and reagent
JP2004093478A (en) * 2002-09-03 2004-03-25 Japan Science & Technology Corp Element for electrochemical analysis of physiologically active substance, and analysis method using the same
US20050123932A1 (en) * 2003-12-09 2005-06-09 Mekbib Astatke Nucleic acid-chelating agent conjugates
EP1669760A1 (en) * 2004-12-08 2006-06-14 Kreatech Biotechnology B.V. Labeled transition metal complexes
US20080081329A1 (en) * 2006-09-28 2008-04-03 Elliott C Michael Electrochemical Detection of Substrates

Non-Patent Citations (21)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
A. DE LACEY ET AL., BIOCHEM BIOPHYS ACTA, vol. 832, 1985, pages 69
ABAD ET AL., J AM CHEM SOC, vol. 127, 2005, pages 5689
ABAD ET AL., J. AM. CHEM. SOC., vol. 127, 2005, pages 5689
ANGEWANDTE CHEMIE INTERNATIONAL EDITION, vol. 44, 2005, pages 7553 - 7557
BULL. CHEM. SOC. JPN., vol. 54, 1981, pages 1879
C. TSOPELAS ET AL., J NUCL MED, vol. 43, 2002, pages 1377
C.R. CANTOR; I. TINOCO, J. MOL. BIOL., vol. 13, 1965, pages 65
D. REYES-DUARTE ET AL., ANGEW CHEM INT ED ENGL, vol. 44, 2005, pages 7553
DE LACEY ET AL., J BIOL ANORG CHEM, vol. 9, 2004, pages 636
F. MAZZETTI; R. M. LEMMON, J ORG CHEM, vol. 22, 1957, pages 228
F. STEPHEN ET AL., NUCLEIC ACIDS RES, vol. 25, 1997, pages 3389
FERRER ET AL., MOL. MICROBIOL., vol. 53, 2005, pages 167 - 182
J. M. ABAD ET AL., J AM CHEM SOC, vol. 127, 2005, pages 5689
J. SOKOLOWSKA-GAJDA; H.S. FREEMAN, DYES AND PIGM, vol. 14, 1990, pages 35
J.C. FONTECILLA-CAMPS ET AL., CHEM REV, vol. 107, 2007, pages 4273
KOSTIC N M ED - INGLESE JAMES: "TRANSITION-METAL COMPLEXES AS SPECTROSCOPIC PROBES FOR SELECTIVE COVALENT LABELING AND CROSS-LINKING OF PROTEINS", METHODS IN ENZYMOLOGY, ACADEMIC PRESS INC, SAN DIEGO, CA, US, vol. 226, 1 January 1993 (1993-01-01), pages 565 - 576, XP008063637, ISSN: 0076-6879 *
M. FERRER ET AL., NATURE, vol. 445, 2007, pages 91
P.M. VIGNAIS; B. BILLOUD, CHEM REV, vol. 107, 2007, pages 4206
T. FAWCETT, PATTERN RECOGN LETT, vol. 27, 2006, pages 861
V. M. FERNANDEZ ET AL., BIOCHIM BIOPHYS ACTA, vol. 832, 1985, pages 69
Z. WAI ET AL., THE PROCEEDING OF THE 3RD INTERNATIONAL CONFERENCE ON FUNCTIONAL MOLECULES, vol. 167, 2005

Cited By (13)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
CN104098508A (en) * 2013-04-15 2014-10-15 上海凯赛生物技术研发中心有限公司 Preparation method for 2,3,4,5-tetrahydropyridine and derivatives thereof
CN104098508B (en) * 2013-04-15 2016-05-18 上海凯赛生物技术研发中心有限公司 The preparation method of 2,3,4,5-tetrahydropyridine and derivative thereof
CN104744526A (en) * 2013-12-31 2015-07-01 深圳先进技术研究院 Chemical synthesis method of lupeose
CN104744542A (en) * 2013-12-31 2015-07-01 深圳先进技术研究院 Selective modification method of cane sugar primary hydroxyl
US10556920B2 (en) 2015-06-23 2020-02-11 University Of Oregon Phosphorus-containing heterocycles and a method for making and using
WO2016209996A1 (en) * 2015-06-23 2016-12-29 University Of Oregon Phosphorus-containing heterocycles and a method for making and using
US10808047B2 (en) 2015-08-21 2020-10-20 G&P Holding, Inc. Silver and copper itaconates and poly itaconates
CN106674135A (en) * 2016-12-29 2017-05-17 新乡制药股份有限公司 Uracil synthesizing method
CN114507127A (en) * 2020-11-17 2022-05-17 中国科学院上海高等研究院 Synthesis method of 2-keto pantoic acid
CN113461620A (en) * 2021-07-20 2021-10-01 河北广兴化工有限公司 Heating synthesis method of uracil
CN113461620B (en) * 2021-07-20 2022-08-23 河北广兴化工有限公司 Heating synthesis method of uracil
CN113816932A (en) * 2021-10-14 2021-12-21 宁夏优维生物科技有限公司 Synthesis method of keto pantolactone
CN115957343A (en) * 2022-12-05 2023-04-14 大连理工大学 Colloidal particle and preparation method and application of colloidal particle in capsid induced self-assembly

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
ES2449581T3 (en) 2014-03-20
EP2408927B1 (en) 2013-11-27
US20120231972A1 (en) 2012-09-13
EP2408927A1 (en) 2012-01-25
EP2230312A1 (en) 2010-09-22

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
EP2408927B1 (en) Probe compound for detecting and isolating enzymes and means and methods using the same
Cui et al. Functional single-cell approach to probing nitrogen-fixing bacteria in soil communities by resonance Raman spectroscopy with 15N2 labeling
Hatzenpichler et al. In situ visualization of newly synthesized proteins in environmental microbes using amino acid tagging and click chemistry
Srivastava et al. Monitoring approaches for a toxic cyanobacterial bloom
Zhu et al. Applications of functional protein microarrays in basic and clinical research
Smartt et al. Pathogen detection using engineered bacteriophages
Moreira et al. Methods to detect cyanobacteria and their toxins in the environment
EP3681896B1 (en) Function-based probes for environmental microbiome analysis and methods of making and using the same
CN111819288B (en) Immune signal amplification method based on hybridization chain reaction
CN112904017B (en) Detection system based on covalent connection for interaction between known molecules and proteins and identification or verification method thereof
CN108507984B (en) Method for detecting trimethylamine oxide TMAO by enzyme method and application thereof
Gwinn et al. In vitro glucuronidation of Caribbean ciguatoxins in fish: first report of conjugative ciguatoxin metabolites
JP2015508638A (en) Method for quantifying peptide derivative libraries using phage display
Smith et al. Global analysis of protein function using protein microarrays
Chen et al. Applications and opportunities of click chemistry in plant science
Cho et al. A portable and chromogenic enzyme-based sensor for detection of abrin poisoning
Liu et al. Acceptor specificity and inhibition of the bacterial cell‐wall glycosyltransferase MurG
Lohse et al. Target and identify: triazene linker helps identify azidation sites of labelled proteins via click and cleave strategy
US20210395795A1 (en) Compound and a method for identifying a protein using said compound
Chen et al. Chemical Labeling of Protein 4′‐Phosphopantetheinylation
US20020197653A1 (en) System for detecting reporter gene expression
CN114486782B (en) Nanometer enzyme detection reagent for visually detecting chloramphenicol and detection method thereof
Pereira Identification of novel biosynthetic gene clusters and bacterial taxa from a soil microbiome using metagenomic approaches
Sitzer Investigation of protein complexes involved in coenzyme A biosynthesis
Bowman Protein-based analysis and other new and emerging non-nucleic acid based methods for tracing and investigating foodborne pathogens

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
121 Ep: the epo has been informed by wipo that ep was designated in this application

Ref document number: 10715096

Country of ref document: EP

Kind code of ref document: A1

NENP Non-entry into the national phase

Ref country code: DE

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 2010715096

Country of ref document: EP

WWE Wipo information: entry into national phase

Ref document number: 13257383

Country of ref document: US